You are on page 1of 348

Accellos One Warehouse

Powered by RADIO BEACON

Using Web Dispatch


 Accellos Inc.
125 Commerce Valley Drive West, Suite 700
Markham, Ontario, Canada
L3T 7W4

Copyright © Accellos, Inc.


 All rights reserved

This manual is reserved for licensed users of Accellos One Warehouse.


Warehouse. If you are not a licensed user of
 Accellos One Warehouse,
Warehouse, no part of this publication may be reproduced,
reproduced, stored in a retrieval system or
transmitted in any form or by any means electronic, mechanical, recording or otherwise, without the
prior written consent of Accellos, Inc.
The information in this manual is furnished for informational use only, is subject to ch ange without
notice and should not be construed as a commitment of Accellos, Inc. Accellos, Inc. assumes no respon-
sibility or liability for any errors or inaccuracies that may appear in this manual.
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

TABLE OF CONTENTS

ABOUT THIS DOCUMENT


Audience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xi
About Optional Software Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xii
Getting Additional Information and Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Total Support Web Site. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Contacting Radio Beacon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xiv
Document Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . xv

CHAPTER 1
USING THE WEB DISPATCH INTERFACE
Starting Web Dispatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2
About the Web Dispatch Modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4
About the Orders Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
About the Receiving Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5
About the Reports Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6
 Navigating Web Dispatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
Refreshing Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Configuring Screen Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
Understanding the Status and Quick Launch Bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Using the Orders Summary Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Using the Order Details Screens
S creens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
Using Report Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Selecting and Processing Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
Selecting Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Processing Orders from Details Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
Processing Orders from Report Screens . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
Using Pop-up Menu Actions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42
General Procedures for Processing Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
Editing Default Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
Exiting Web Dispatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48

I I I
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CHAPTER 2
PROCESSING SALES ORDERS
About Processing Sales Orders.
Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Understanding Sales Order Actions and Stat uses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Understanding the Packslip Report Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
Understanding Types of Sales Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Additional Sales Order Processing Functions F unctions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Allocating and Re-allocating Sales Orders. O rders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
Understanding and Modifying Sales Order Allocation Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
Understanding Sales Order Allocation Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
Handling Unsuccessfully Allocated Sales Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
Unallocating Sales Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Understanding and Modifying Shipping Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
Understanding and Modifying Shipping Method Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
Understanding and Modifying Label Printing Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
Understanding and Modifying Truck Route Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Understanding and Modifying Shipment Consolidation Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
Understanding and Modifying Carton Check-In Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
Pre-rating Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98
Waving and Re-waving Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
Understanding and Modifying Wave Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
Packing and Holding Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Consolidating Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Understanding Wave Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110
Unwaving Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
Understanding and Modifying the Unwave Option . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Performing Shipping Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112
Performing or Bypassing Carton Scanning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Performing Shipping System Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Suspending Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
Unsuspending Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Cancelling or Expediting Sales Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Understanding and Modifying Sales Order Nuke Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121
Understanding Nuking Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Generating Bills of Lading and Manifests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Adding an Order to a Bill of Lading/Manifest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Viewing, Editing, and Printing an Existing Bill of Lading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128

I V
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

‘Picking’ a Sales Order. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128


Creating Deliveries In RADIO BEACON . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Understanding the Create Delivery Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
Creating a Delivery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Using Clone Picking. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 135
Cancelling Clone Picking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137
Exporting Manifest Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

CHAPTER 3
PROCESSING ASSEMBLY ORDERS
About Processing Assembly Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Understanding Assembly Order Actions and Statuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142
Understanding the Work Order Packslip Report Screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
Understanding Types of Assembly Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
Allocating and Re-allocating Work Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Understanding and Modifying Work Order Replenishment Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Understanding Work Order Allocation Results . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Unallocating Work Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155
Cancelling Work Orders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
Understanding and Modifying Work Order Nuke Options. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

CHAPTER 4
PROCESSING PACKAGING ORDERS
About Processing Packaging Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Understanding Types of Packaging Orders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Understanding Packaging Order Actions and Statuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
Creating Packaging Orders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
Working with the Packaging Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163
Generating the Packaging Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
Understanding the Packaging Order Packslip Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169

V
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CHAPTER 5
PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS
About Processing Purchase Orders.Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171
Understanding Purchase Order Actions and Stat uses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
Understanding the Purchase Order Report Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173
Understanding Types of Purchase Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Additional Purchase Order Processing Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 176
Releasing Purchase Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
Closing Purchase Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178
Cancelling or Expediting Purchase Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179
Understanding and Modifying Delete Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
Creating Container References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 182
Entering RMAs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
‘Receiving’ a Purchase Order in Web Dispatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Creating Transfer Purchase Orders in Web Dispatch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190

CHAPTER 6
USING INCIDENTS
About Incidents. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Creating and Assigning Incidents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
Creating an Incident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
Viewing Incidents You Have Assigned . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195
Viewing and Responding to Incidents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Viewing Incidents Assigned to You . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196
Responding to an Incident . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 197

CHAPTER 7
GENERATING REPORTS
About Reports, Monitors, and Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
About the Standard Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Additional Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207
General Procedures for Generating Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209

V I
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Managing Sales and Shipments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211


Customer Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
Packslip Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Order Consolidation Opportunities Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 215
Shipping Errors Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
Truck Route Report.
Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Uploaded Shipments Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Daily Shipping Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Shipment Lookup Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Manifest Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220
Managing Purchasing and Receiving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221
Vendor Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
Vendor Product List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224
Shortage Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 225
Purchase Order Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226
Receiving Report by PO . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
View Container Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Uploaded Receipts Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Daily Receiving Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Daily Receipts Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
RMA Issued Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
Managing Inventory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Products Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234
Product Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 235
Product Inventory Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
Bin Detail Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Bin Inventory Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Empty Bin Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
License Plate Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Cycle Count Report.
Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
Adjustments Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 241
Short Products Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Rush Products Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 243
Replenishment Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

V I I
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Reserved Stock Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245


Open Warehouse Transits Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246
Picked, Unshipped Inventory Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Daily Sales Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
Top 100 Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 248
Velocity by Bin Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Incremental Slotting Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249
Monitoring Warehouse Activities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Activity Monitor Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Measuring Warehouse Performance.
Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Cycle Count Accuracy Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Activity Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Picker Activity Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Employee Statistics Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
Cycle Time Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 254
Generating Custom Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255
Ad Hoc SQL Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 255

CHAPTER 8
EDITING ORDERS AND WAREHOUSE DATA
Editing Sales, Work, Packaging and Transfer Sales Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
Editing Sales/Work/Transfer/Packaging
Order Information 261
Editing Sales/Work/Transfer/Packaging Order Line Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 262
Editing Purchase Orders and Transfer Purchase O rders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263
Editing Purchase Order Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264
Editing or Deleting Purchase Order Line Details . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 265
Maintaining Products . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 266
Modifying Product Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 267
Adding a New Product . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Maintaining Kits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269
Editing an Existing Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270
Adding a Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 274
Deleting a Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275
Maintaining Packaging Items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Adding a Packaging Item . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Editing an Existing Packaging item . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Deleting a Packaging Item . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281

V I I I
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Maintaining Customers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281


Modifying Customer Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Adding a New Customer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Maintaining Vendors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
Modifying Vendor Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Adding a New Vendor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285

CHAPTER 9
ENTERING ORDERS
Entering Sales Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Creating a Sales Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 288
Adding Lines to a Sales Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Completing a Sales Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Modifying or Deleting a Line in a Sales Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 292
Entering Transfer Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293
Creating a Transfer Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Adding Lines to a Transfer Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 295
Completing a Transfer Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
Modifying or Deleting a Line in a Transfer Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 296
Entering Purchase Orders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
Creating a Purchase Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
Adding Lines to a Purchase Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 298
Completing a Purchase Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299
Entering Packaging Orders. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302

CHAPTER 10
USING ADVANCE REPLENISHMENT
Understanding Advance Replenishment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
Min/Max Replenishment.
Replenishment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 303
Days on Hand Replenishment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 304
Running the Advance Replenishment Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 305
Understanding and Modifying Advance Replenishment Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307

I X
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CHAPTER 11
TROUBLESHOOTING
Using the Log Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 311
Generating the Log Lookup Report. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 312
Generating the Log Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 314
Generating the Errors Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315
Creating a Test Order Database . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 316

INDEX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317

X
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THIS DOCUMENT

This manual provides conceptual information and step-by-step operational procedures for the
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS Web Dispatch application.

It is highly recommended that you read the introductory companion manual, Overview of
 RADIO BEACON WMS  before
 before working with the procedures contained in this manual.

AUDIENCE
This document is intended for the following readers:

• Wareho
arehouse
use supe
superv
rvis
isor
orss or mana
manage
gers,
rs, who use
use the
the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS Web Dispatch
application for daily warehouse operations and management.

• Radio
Radio Beaco
Beacon n Inc.
Inc. partner
partnerss and resel
reseller
lers,
s, and ware
warehou
house
se system
system admi
administ
nistrat
rators
ors or
or IT
managers, who need to understand R ADIO ADIO BEACON WMS functions for the purposes of
system installation, setup, and ongoing configuration.

This manual assumes some familiarity with basic warehousing concepts, but not necessarily
with concepts or terminology that are specific to warehouse management systems (WMS) or to
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS.

X I
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT OPTIONAL SOFTWARE MODULES


R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS is shipped and licensed as a modular product. This means that the
version of R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS that you are using may not include all of the features
described in this document. The R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS documentation set is based on the core
modules, plus the Order Management and Web Web Dispatch modules. Wherever optional features
are discussed that are not included in the core, Order Management, or Web
Web Dispatch modules
of R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS, an icon indicates the relevant module w hich you must purchase to be
able to use this feature. If your system does not include that module, you can easily skip over
the material that does not apply to your implementation. The following table lists the optional
modules that are documented, and the icons that represent each module.

Icon Module
Multi-Location/Site Transfer 
LOC

Multi-Zone
ZONE

Multi-Company/Third-Party Logistics
3PL

Lots/Serials/Expiry
 ATT

Kitting
KIT

Packaging
PACK

Container Receiving
RECV

X I I A B O U T T H I S D O C U M E N T
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Icon Module
Putaway/Slotting/Cube/Weight
 PUT

Advance/Min-Max Replenishment
REPLEN

Web Order Entry


O/E

Integrated Shipping/End-of-Line Settings


SHIP

Returned Materials Authorizations


RMA

Demand Forecasting
FCAST

Vendor Portal and Cross Docking


 VPCD

RFID
RFID

Carousel/Conveyor 
CA/CO

Note: Operations pertaining to the Carousels/Conveyors, the RFID module or the Cross
Docking modules are not documented in this manual.

  X I I I
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GETTING ADDITIONAL INFORMATION AND


SUPPORT
The following manuals contain additional information about R ADIO BEACON components:

Overview of RADIO BEACON WMS 

Using RADIO BEACON Handheld Functions

TOTAL SUPPORT WEB SITE

You can find additional documentation on the Radio Beacon Total Support Web
Web site,
http://002.radiobeacon.com. This site is updated regularly with supplementary detailed
information on specific topics and common issues.

CONTACTING RADIO BEACON

You can contact Radio Beacon Inc. Customer Support by telephone, fax, or e-mail. Be sure to
have ready your company name, the version of R ADIO BEACON WMS you are using and a
concise description of the problem you are experiencing.

Radio Beacon Support

Telephone: 1-(800) 247-9526 Ext. 2

Fax: (416) 486-2169

E-mail: support@radiobeacon.com

X I V A B O U T T H I S D O C U M E N T
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

DOCUMENT CONVENTIONS
The following formatting conventions are used throughout this document:

Convention Explanation
Initial Caps Indicates the name of a R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS function.

Example:
The cartons are sent to the shipping area and, optionally, weighed and
scanned with the Carton Shipping function.
ALL CAPS Indicates a R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS system name, such as a bin location or
an order or carton status.
Example:
The order is in the status of SUSPENDED
S USPENDED and cannot be processed further
until it is released.
Bold text Indicates text that appears in screen options such as buttons, menus, text
 boxes, and so on.
In the Product field, enter the product number.

 monospace
 monospace Indicates text that you must enter exactly as shown.
text
Example:
Enter the IP address or machine name of the server running the Web
Dispatch thread, or enter localhost  if you are running Internet
Explorer on the server machine.
italics Indicates a newly introduced term, emphasis, or a manual title.
Example:
It cannot be further processed until the dispatcher unsuspends it.

> Indicates the start of a procedure.


Example:
> To start picking an order:

X V
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

X V I A B O U T T H I S D O C U M E N T
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

1 USING THE WEB DISPATCH


INTERFACE
This chapter describes how to the start Web Dispatch, how to navigate and interact with its
modules, how to edit default action settings, and how to find relevant information in this
manual:

• “Starting
“Starting Web
Web Dispatch”
Dispatch” on page 2.

• “About the Web


Web Dispatch Modules” on
on page 4 .

• “Navigating
“Navigating Web
Web Dispatch” on page 7.

• “Selecting
“Selecting and Processing
Processing Orders” on page 40
40..

• “Editing
“Editing Default Settings”
Settings” on page
page 46
46..

• “Exiting
“Exiting Web
Web Dispatch”
Dispatch” on page 48
48..

1
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

STARTING WEB DISPATCH


> To log on to Web Dispatch:

1. Star
Startt Inte
Intern
rnet
et Exp
Explo
lore
rerr.

2. In the address
address bar,
bar, enter the url of the Web
Web dispatch
dispatch compone
component
nt using the following
following format:
format:

http://<server IP address or Name>/RbDispatch/

where:
<server IP address or Name>  is the IP address or machine name of the server
running the Web Dispatch component
or,
enter localhost  if you are running Internet Explorer on the same machine that you
installed the Web Dispatch component.

For example,
http://10.142.154.13/RbDispatch/
http://localhost/RbDispatch/

 The R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS login screen is displayed.

2 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. In the User Name field, enter your user ID.

4. In the Password field, enter your password.

If you have no data of your own, you can initially use the following default User Names
and Passwords, which are installed with R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS, until you define your own
Password and Permissions.

User Name Password


HH (none)
Web (none)
inter inter  

There is also a default sa user name that is used to log on to the administrative functions
on Web Dispatch. The administrative functions are not discussed in this manual.

5. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, in
in the
the Language field, select the language you want the interface to display.

6. Click Log In. The Web


Web Dispatch home page is displayed, wi th the navigation bar at the top
of the screen.

S T A R TI NG W E B D IS P AT CH 3
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE WEB DISPATCH MODULES


From the Web Dispatch navigation bar, you can access the following modules by clicking on
the appropriate link:

• Orders —
Orders — See “About the
the Orders Module”
Module” on page 5 .

• Receiving —
Receiving — See “About the Receivin
Receiving
g Module” on page
page 5 .

• Monitor — Use to monitor current processes in the warehouse. See “Monitoring


Wareho
arehouse
use Activities”
Activities” on page 250
250 of
 of Chapter 7, “Generating Reports”.
Reports”.

• Incidents —
Incidents — Use to enter queries or issues
i ssues to be handled by other Web Dispatch users, and
respond to incidents that have been assigned to you. See Chapter 6, “Using Incidents”.
Incidents”.

• Reports —
Reports — See “Abou
“Aboutt the Reports Module”
Module” on page
page 6 .

• Support
Support — Links
Links to the
the Radio
Radio Beac
Beacon
on Total Suppor
Supportt Web
Web site
site..

• Exit — Logs off from Web Dispatch. See “Exitin


“Exiting
g Web
Web Dispatch” on page 48
48 of
 of this
chapter.

The navigation bar is available in each module; to enter a different module, simply click on the
link in the navigation bar.

Note: The modules that you are able to view will depend on your permissions. You may or
may not have access to all of the modules described here.

In general, navigating a module consists of clicking hyperlinks and selecting form elements,
 just as in any Web
Web site on the Internet. The Orders and Receiving modules, however, use an
additional feature, a pop-up menu, which is described later in this chapter.

4 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE ORDERS MODULE

Use the Orders module to do any of the following:

• View and proce


process
ss sales,
sales, work,
work, packag
packaging
ing and transf
transfer
er sales
sales orders.
orders. Descri
Described
bed throu
througho
ghout
ut
Chapter 2, “Processing Sales Orders”,
Orders”, Chapter 3, “Processing Assembly Orders”,
Orders” , and
Chapter 4, “Processing Packaging Orders”.
Orders” .

• Troub
Troublesh
leshoot
oot sales,
sales, work,
work, packag
packaging
ing and transf
transfer
er sales
sales orders
orders.. See
See “About the Reports
Module
Mod ule”” on page
page 6.

• Edit existing sales, transfer sales, work and packaging orders. Described in “Editing Sales,
Work, Packaging and Transfer
Transfer Sales Orders” on page 260
260 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders
and Warehouse Data”.
Data”.

SHIP • Generate and print bills of lading and manifests.


manifests . Described in “Generating Bills of Lading
and Manifests”
Manifests” on page
page 125
125..

ABOUT THE RECEIVING MODULE

Use the Receiving module to do any of the following:

• View and process purchase orders and transfer purchase orders . Described throughout
Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .

• Edit existing purchase orders and transfer purchase orders . Described in “Editing Purchase
Orders and Transfer
Transfer Purchase Orders” on page 263
263 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and
Warehouse Data”.
Data”.

• Troub
rouble
lesh
shoo
oott pur
purch
chas
asee ord
order
ers.
s. See
See “About the Reports Module” below.
Module”  below.

A BO UT T HE W EB D IS PA T CH M OD UL E S 5
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE REPORTS MODULE

You use the Reports module to do any of the following:

• Generate various real-time and historical reports and monitor warehouse processes and
 productivity.
 productivity. Described throughout Chapter 7, “Generating Reports”.
Reports”.

• View lice
license
nse plat
platee relat
related
ed info
inform
rmat
atio
ion.
n. Desc
Describ
ribed
ed in
in Chapter 7, “Generating Reports”.
Reports”.

• View,
iew, process,
process, and
and edit
edit sales,
sales, work,
work, packa
packagin
ging,
g, purch
purchase
ase and
and transfe
transferr orders
orders.. See “About
the Orders
Orders Module”
Module” on page
page 5 and “About the Receiving
Receiving Module”
Module” on page 5 .

• Troubleshoot orders, products, and bins.


bins . Described in Chapter 11, “Troubleshooting”
“Troubleshooting”..

RECV • Create container references for purchase orders.


orders . Described in “Creating Container
References”
Referen ces” on page 182
182 of
 of Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .

REPLEN • Generate advance replenishment requests.


requests . Described in Chapter 6, “Using Advance
Replenishment”..
Replenishment”

O/E • Enter new purchase orders,


orders, sales orders,
orders, and packaging orders. Described in Chapter 9,
“Entering Orders”.
Orders”.

• Manage
Manage sales
sales and
and invent
inventory
ory budg
budgets
ets,, and gener
generate
ate prod
product
uct and
and vendo
vendorr requir
requireme
ements
nts
FCAST reports.
reports. Described in a separate document called “ Demand Forecasting ”. ”.

• Edit or add new vendor , customer , product,


 product, kit,
kit, or packaging item information. Described
in Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and Warehouse Data”.
Data” .

SHIP • Export manifest information for


information  for ATS-shipped
ATS-shipped orders to a text file. Described in “‘Picking’
a Sales Order”
Order” on
on page 128
128 of
 of Chapter 2, “Processing Sales Orders”.
Orders”.

• Edit
Edit and
and pri
print
nt bill
billss of ladin
lading
g and
and man
manif
ifest
ests.
s. See
See “About the Orders
Orders Module”
Module” on page 5.

• Create
Create return
returned
ed materi
materials
als authori
authorizat
zation
ionss (RMA
(RMAs).
s). Describ
Described
ed in “Entering RMAs” on
RMA
 page 186
186 of
 of Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .

• Edit default Web Dispatch settings.


settings. Described in “Exitin
“Exiting
g Web
Web Dispatch” on page
page 48
48 of
 of
this chapter.

6 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

NAVIGATING WEB DISPATCH


The Orders, Receiving, and Reports modules are linked via the following navigational
structure:

Order Picking Inventory Receiving P.O.


Summary Reports Reports Reports Summary
Screen Screen Screen Screen Screen

Purchase
Order Details
Order Details
Screen
Screen

Customer Packslip Purchase Vendor


Report Report Order Report Report
Screen Screen Screen Screen

Customer Product Purchase Vendor


Sales Order Bin Report
Maintenance Report Order Edit Maintenance
Edit Screen Screen
Screen Screen Screen Screen

License Plate
Report
Screen

Order Log Product Log Bin Log Order Log


Screen Screen Screen Screen

• Sales/work/packaging/purchase and transfer order summary  screens—Display summary


data for all or selected orders in the system, and are described in “Using the Orders
Summary Screen
Screens”s” on page 14
14.. From these screens, you link to sales/work/packaging
order and purchase order details screens.

• Sales/work/packaging/purchase and transfer order details  screens—Display details for


selected orders, and allow you to process them, as described in “Using the Order Details
Screens”
Screen s” on page 35
35.. From these screens, you can link to the Packslip (Order) and
Purchase Order Reports screens, as well
wel l as the Customer, Vendor,
Vendor, and Product Reports
screens.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 7
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• Packslip (Sales/Work/Packaging/Transfer
(Sales/Work/Packaging/Transfer Sales Order) and Purchase/Transfer Purchase
Order Report screens—Display
Report  screens—Display detailed information for an individual order and allow you
to process and edit the order, as described in “Using Report
Report Screens”
Screens” on page 38
38.. From
these screens, you can also link to edit and log screens for the selected order.

• Picking,
Picking, Receiving,
Receiving, and Inventory Reports
Inventory Reports screens—Allow you to select an individual
customer, packslip (sales/work/packaging/transfer sales order), purchase/transfer purchase
order, vendor, product, and bin location for which to display a detailed report. More
information about these screens is provided in Chapter 7, “Generating Reports” on
 page 201
201..

• Customer , Vendor, Product,


Product, Bin, License Plate Reports
Plate Reports screens—Display detailed
information for the selected customer, vendor, product, bin, or license plate, and allow you
to process orders listed for that customer, vendor, product, bin, or license plate. From the
respective screens, you can also link to edit/maintenance screens for the selected customer,
vendor, or product. From the Product and Bin Report screens, you can also link to log
screens for the selected product or bin. More information about these screens in Chapter 7,
“Generating
“Genera ting Reports”
Reports” on page 201
201..

• Packslip, Purchase Order, Product and Bin Log screens—Display


Log  screens—Display all log entries for a
selected entity for the previous several months (will vary according to your configuration).
More information on these screens is provided in Chapter 11, “Troubleshooting” on
 page 311
311..

8 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

REFRESHING SCREENS

The Web
Web Dispatch screens do not necessarily automatically refres h as you or warehouse staff
are processing orders. You will need to click the Refresh button regularly to update the
data .

It may take several seconds, or even minutes, for all jobs to complete processing. To ensure
that the displayed data correctly reflects any actions you or other warehouse staff have
 performed, keep refreshing the display.
display. When background jobs are reduced to zero, be sure to
refresh again.

CONFIGURING SCREEN DISPLAYS

Most Web Dispatch screens let you configure the type of information y ou want to display and
the way you want it presented. This is a powerful tool that lets you focus on the data that is
important to you and your warehouse staff.

Any title bar that has the configuration icon can be customized to meet your
requirements. The configuration settings that display are different for each type of screen.
Consider the following example of an orders details screen for waved orders:

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 9
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To configure the screen:


1. Click
Click the config
configure
ure icon . The Form
Form Config
Configura
uration
tion window
window dispay
dispays.
s.

2. Click the open so link to display the Grid Configuration window for sales orders.

3. Modify
Modify the setting
settingss as
as requ
require
ired
d and
and click
click Submit.

FILTERING DATA ON REPORT/DISPLAY


REPORT/DISPLAY SCREENS

You can apply filters to tables or columns displaying the magnifying glass icon. Filters
restrict  the
 the data displayed according to a specific criterion.

1 0 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To filter information for a table in the window display, click the magnifying glass icon on
the tab:

 The Grid Filter window displays.

> To filter information for a specific column in the display, click the magnifying glass icon
for the column:

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 1 1
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The Column Filter window displays. In the example below, we are using a wildcard to look for
host orders that begin with “1000”.

CLEARING FILTERS

Clicking the Clear Filters button clears the filters that were applied to a table or column.

For example, clicking the Clear Filters button clears the filter applied to the Host Orders
column.

UNDERSTANDING THE STATUS AND QUICK LAUNCH BAR 

The bottom of Web Dispatch screen displays a status bar that shows the following information:

Quick Launch Quick links that were customized by the user. Described in “Adding Links to the Quick Launch

bar
Current Web Dispatch User ID.
configuration
tool. Described
in “Adding Links
to the Quick Open incidents. Described in “Understanding Incidents”
Launch Bar”.
Bar”.
. The number of jobs currently in process.

1 2 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADDING LINKS TO THE QUICK LAUNCH BAR 

You can create quick links to Web Dispatch reports/display screens by setting up shortcut
 buttons on the Quick Launch bar.

> To set up a quick link to a report/display screen:

1. Navigat
Navigatee to the repor
report/sc
t/scree
reen
n for which
which you
you want to crea
create
te a quick
quick link.
link.

2. Click the configuratio


configuration
n icon on the Status and Quick Launch
Launch bar.
bar. The Quick Launch
Bar Configuration window displays.

3. Click the “fill from current


current report”
report” icon to enter the current
current report/screen
report/screen under the
Link heading.

4. Click the Visible checkbox for the link to appear as a button on the Quick Launch bar.

5. In the Shortcut field, enter the text that you would like to display on the button.

6. In the Help Text field, enter the text that you would like to display as ‘hover’ help.

7. Click Submit. When you refresh the screen, the report can be accessed by clicking the
 button that displays on the Quick Launch bar.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 1 3
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

USING THE ORDERS SUMMARY SCREENS


When you first link to the Orders
O rders or Receiving module from the navigation bar, the following
summary screen is displayed (the example is from the Orders module).
Form Configuration  Active Filters Displayed.
Refresh button.
Described in “Refreshing Described in
Described in
Screens”
Screen s” on page 9 “Understanding and Using
“Refreshing
Screens” on Filters”
Filters” on page 22
22..
pag
age
e 9. Incidents assigned to this Orders table. Described
Clear All Filters button.
Described in “Understanding user. Described in in “Understanding the
and Using Filters” on “Understanding Incidents” Orders Table” on
page
page 22
22.. on page
page 17
17.. page
pa ge 15
15..

List of recently viewed pages. Described


in “Using the Recent Drop-Down Box” on
page
pa ge 26
26..

Order display criteria. Table layout criteria. Described in “Understanding


Described in and Using Pivot
Pivots”
s” on page 18
18..
“Understanding and Using
Filters”
Filters” on page 22
22..

Status and Quick Launch bar. Described in “Understanding the Status


Status and Quick Launch Bar” on page 12
12..

1 4 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Note: Depending on your configuration and permissions, your display may contain
different, or fewer, elements.

UNDERSTANDING THE ORDERS TABLE

The orders table is populated as follows:

For the Orders module, it is populated based on information contained in sales, work,
 packaging and transfer sales orders that have been downloaded from the host system, or
created in Web Dispatch.

For the Receiving module, it is populated based on information contained in purchase orders
and transfer purchase orders (that have been downloaded from the host system, or created in
Web Dispatch.
Di spatch.

The orders table displays all orders in the system, according to the criteria you select from the
various drop-down boxes on the left of the screen.

Currently selected
Pivot headings
horizontal pivot

Orders
statistics

Process steps for


Process steps
transfer orders

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 1 5
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

You can click on an underlined number to drill down to the order details screen (described
screen (described in
“Using the Order
Order Details Screens”
Screens” on page 35
35)) for the selected group of orders.

The orders table consists of the following elements:

Element Explanation
Pivot The pivot selected from the Pivots drop-down list on the left
side of the summary screen. Pivots are described in more
detail in “Under
“Understandin
standing
g and Using Pivots” on page
page 18
Pivo
Pivott hea
headi
ding
ng colu
column
mnss The
The val
value
uess ava
avail
ilab
able
le for
for the
the sele
select
cted
ed pivo
pivot,
t, acco
accord
rdin
ing
g to
to dat
dataa
contained in the sales order records. By default, the first
column shows all orders in the system, regardless of any
filters used.
# Orders ro
 row Displays the total number of orders per column.
To view details for orders, click on the underlined number
corresponding to the group of orders you wa nt to select, or
click on the number in the All column to view all orders.
# Lines ro
 row Displays the total number of lines in all orders per column.
# Allocated Lines row (for Displays the total number of lines that have been allocated in
sales/work orders only) all orders per column.
# Units ro
 row Displays the total number of units in all orders per column.
Value Gross row (for sales/ Displays the total dollar value of all orders per column. Only
work orders only) displayed if dollar amounts are available in product records
in the database.

Value Fill row (for sales/ Displays the total dollar value of all fillabl e lines in all orders
work orders only)  per column. Only displayed if dollar amounts are available in
 product records in the database.

Estimated Weight row (for Displays the total weight of all orders per column. Only
sales/work orders only) displayed if weights are available in the product records in
the database.

1 6 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Element Explanation
Process Step rows Display orders according to all process steps currently
applied to orders, per column. An overview of process steps
used in the Orders and Receiving modules is provided in
“Understandin
“Under standingg Process Steps”
Steps” on page 26
26..
To view details for orders, click
cl ick on the underlined number
corresponding to the group of orders you want to select, or
click on the number in the All column to view all orders.

UNDERSTANDING INCIDENTS

Incidents are
Incidents are issues or problems that have been assigned to you by another user. When you
have been assigned an incident, it will display in the Orders and Receiving modules summary
screens as soon as you log on, or click the Refresh button (see “Refreshing the Summary
Screen”
Screen” on page
page 34
34).
).

Click the incident number to select an incident


which you want to view or resolve.

Clicking on the incident number links you to the Incidents module, where you can view the
selected incident, and manage incidents that have been assigned to you. Incidents are described
in detail in Chapter 6, “Using Incidents”.
Incidents”.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 1 7
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND USING PIVOTS

 Pivots are
 Pivots are ways of displaying orders by controlling the horizontal/column or the vertical/row
organization of records, so that the data i s organized according to the selected criterion. For
example, selecting a “State” horizontal pivot from the drop-down list would display orders in
columns corresponding to the province or state to which the orders are being shipped.

To activate a horizontal pivot, select an item from the following drop-down box:

The vertical pivots can be activated by selecting an item from the following drop-down box:

You configure whether to display horizontal pivots, vertical pivots, both or none, as described
in “Conf
“Configurin
iguring
g the Orders Summary Screens”
Screens” on page 3232..

There is a default set of pivots, and the ones displayed on your screen are determined by the
information provided in the orders and the way the A pivot will display if the data represented
 by the pivot appears more than once in the orders in the system.

1 8 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Default pivots available in the Orders module are described in the following table.

Pivot Explanation
Ship Code The shipping code used by your host system to specify shipping
options, such as carrier and service.
Ship Via The carrier specified for the orders.
Date Created The date the orders were downloaded or created in R ADIO
  DIO
A
BEACON WMS.
Handle A name associated with a group of orders to help identify them.
Ship Pr
Province The pr
province or
or state to wh
which the or
orders ar
are to
to be
be de
delivered.
Client Name The owner of the products for the orders (used only in multi-
company or 3PL implementations).
3PL implementations).
Custom
tomer Nu
Number The nu
number of
of th
the cu
custo
stomer fo
for th
the or
orders
Back
Back Orde
Orderr Num
Numbe
berr The
The back
back ord
order
er num
numbe
bers
rs app
appli
lied
ed by
by the
the host
host sys
syste
tem
m or R ADIO
ADIO
BEACON WMS for the orders.
Truck Route The truck route to be used for the orders.
Priority The priority level
 priority level assigned to the orders, from 0 to 9, where 0 is
the lowest priority, and 9 is the highest.
Fill Rate The percentage of lines th
that must be available for picking before
the orders can be released.
Cost Centre The customer’s
r’s division or department being billed for the orders.
Batch
atch Refe
Refere
renc
ncee The
The bat
batch
ch refe
refere
renc
ncee num
numbe
berr ass
assig
igne
ned
d by
by the
the host
host syst
system
em to the
the
orders.
Date Ordered The date the orders were created in the host system. If this
information is not available, the date ordered defaults to the Date
Created.
Date Required The date the orders are required to ship.
Date Can
Cancelle
lled The da
date th
the or
orders
ers ar
are to
to be
be ca
cancelled
led if
if th
they ha
have no
not ye
yet be
been
shipped.
 Number of Lines The number of lines in the orders.
 Number of Units The number of units in the orders.
Instruction1 The first special instruction defined for the orders.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 1 9
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Pivot Explanation
Wave The wave numbers assigned
numbers assigned by R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS when the
orders were waved.
waved.
Ship Com
Compl
pleete A “y
“yes/n
s/no” va
value
lue in
indica
icating
ing wh
wheth
ether th
the or
orders mu
must be
be sh
shipped
complete or not.
Ship
Ship Cons
Consol
olid
idat
ated
ed A “yes
“yes/n
/no”
o” valu
valuee indi
indica
cati
ting
ng whet
whethe
herr the
the orde
orders
rs must
must be
consolidated with other orders or not.
Pickup Number The sh
shipment nu
number ap
applied to th
the or
orders.
Store Number The customer ’s store numbers.
User ID The user IDs of the last pickers to pick the orders.
Error Messa
essag
ge Error messag
sages that wer
were gen
generated
ted for the
the orders, if any.
Date Mod
Modifi
ified The date the orders
ers last had an action
ion applied to them, suc
such as
allocating, waving etc.
Ship Country The country to which the orders are to be shipped.
End-of-Line The end-of-line configuration
end-of-line configuration applied to the orders.
Packlane The number of the laser printer on which the packslips for the
orders are printed.
Assembly A “yes/no” value indicating whether the orders are work orders or
not.
Process Step The process step of the orders.
Special1 The first special instruction in the orders.
Order Group The replenishment group assigned
group  assigned to the orders.
OK to Back
Back Orde
Orderr A “ye
“yes/
s/no
no”” val
value
ue indi
indica
cati
ting
ng whet
whethe
herr ite
items
ms that
that are
are shi
shipp
pped
ed shor
shortt
may be back ordered.
Pack & Hold Orders that have been marked as PACK & HOLD during
HOLD during waving.
PO Type The customer ’s PO type for the orders.
Extra1 - Extra5 Extra in
informatio
tion or in
instr
structio
tions de
defined fo
for th
the or
orders.
T48 The half-hour increments (of 48 in each day) in which the orders
were downloaded.
Custo
Custom
m Labe
Labell Typ
Typee The
The typ
typee of
of cus
custo
tom
m pic
pickin
king/s
g/shi
hipp
ppin
ing
g labe
labell req
requir
uired
ed for
for the
the orde
orders
rs..

2 0 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Default pivots available in the Receiving module are described in the following table.

Default Explanation
Pivots
Date
Date Crea
Created
ted The
The dat
datee the
the orde
orders
rs were
were dow
downl
nloa
oaded
ded or crea
created
ted in R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS.

Vendor Number The name


name of the vendor
vendor for the
the orders.
orders.
Recei
Receive
ved
d By
By The
The user
user IDs
IDs of
of the
the most
most rece
recent
nt ware
wareho
hous
usee rec
receiv
eiver
ers.
s.
Rece
Receiv
ived
ed On The
The date
date the
the orde
orders
rs were
were rece
receiv
ived
ed..
Buyer The users who created the orders initially.
Due Dat
Datee The da
date th
the or
orders ar
are du
due to
to ar
arrive
ive in
in th
the wa
warehouse.
Vendo
endorr Nam
Namee The
The nam
namee of
of the
the vend
vendor
or..
 Number of The number of lines in the orders.
Lines
Clie
Client
nt Name
Name The
The owne
ownerr of the
the pro
produ
duct
ctss for
for the
the orde
orders
rs (us
(used
ed onl
only
y in mult
multi-
i-co
comp
mpan
any
y or
3PL implementations).
3PL implementations).
Back
Back Orde
Orderr The
The bac
back
k ord
order
er numb
number
erss app
appli
lied
ed by the
the hos
hostt sys
syste
tem
m or
or R ADIO
ADIO BEACON
WMS for the orders.
Date Modifie
Modified
d The date
date the
the order
orderss last had
had an acti
action
on applie
applied
d to them,
them, such
such as closin
closing,
g,
deleting etc.
Inst
Instru
ruct
ctio
ion1
n1 The
The firs
firstt spec
specia
iall inst
instru
ruct
ctio
ion
n defi
define
ned
d for
for the
the orde
orders
rs..
Extra1 - Extra3
Extra3 Extra information
information or instructi
instructions
ons defined
defined for the orders.
orders.
Handle A name assoc
sociated
ted with
ith a group of orders to help ide
identi
ntify them.
Proc
Proces
esss Ste
Step
p The
The pro
proce
cess
ss step
step of the
the ord
order
ers.
s.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 2 1
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND USING FILTERS

The order summary screen allows you to filter the data displayed in the orders table, by the
using following types of filters:

• filter (custom)

• alert (custom)

• product

• warehouse

• handle

• client name

• location

Each of these is described in the sections following.

 Note that you can combine multiple filters to restrict your displayed data set even more.

In addition, you can filter data by configuring screen as described in “Refreshing Screens” on
 page 9.

Database query statement for all active filters are displayed in the filter status bar.

To clear all the active filters, including alerts, and re-display all orders in the system, click the
Clear All Active Filters button .

2 2 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Filter (Custom)

A filter  is
 is a way of filtering (i.e., restricting) the display of orders according to a predefined
criterion, so that only orders that meet that criterion are displayed. Filters must be configured
for your system, and are determined by the information provided in the orders. For example, in
the figure below, selecting a filter of “UPS Orders” will display only orders that are to be
shipped by UPS.

A default of “All Orders” is usually used, unless otherwise configured. To activate a filter,
select an item from the drop-down box.

Alert (Custom)

An alert , like a filter, is a way of filtering the display of orders in according to a predefined
criterion, so that only orders that meet that criterion are displayed. Alerts must be configured
for your system, and are determined by the information contained the orders. The difference
from filters is that alerts are intended to be used for urgent criteria, such as a priority customer,
or a priority order. They only appear if there are orders in t he system for that alert. The total
number of orders for each alert is shown to the left of that alert.

For example, in the figure below, selecting an alert of “Hot Picks” or “Swee t’s Orders” will
only show records that have been marked by the host system as being hot picks, or orders for
the customer Sweet Thoughts.

Total number of open


orders for this alert.

To activate an alert, simply click on the desired alert. Note, however, that alerts are much more
 process-intensive than filters, and therefore should not be overused.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 2 3
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Product

To display only orders with


wi th a particular product on them,
them , you can use the Product filter. In the
example below, only orders with product number LF211 will be displayed.

To activate a product filter, enter the product number in the field, and click anywhere outside
the field, or press the Tab key.

Warehouse

To display only orders that belong to a particular warehouse, you can use t he Warehouse filter.
The warehouse is a one- or two-digit code that identifies a physical or logical site from which
you may allocate and pick products.

To activate a warehouse filter,


filte r, enter the warehouse number in the field, and click anywhere
outside the field, or press the Tab key.

Tip: You can also set the default warehouse for your own instance of Web Dispatch. For
more information, see “Editin
“Editing
g Default Settings”
Settings” on page 46
46..

Client Name

If your warehouse is a multi-company or third-party logistics operation, you will have an


additional filter, for client name. Depending on the configuration of your user ID, you may or
3PL may not be able to use this filter. If your user ID is configured to restrict you to viewing orders
only for a single client, you will not be able to edit the field.

If your user ID is configured to allow you to view orders for all clients, to
t o activate a client filter
to display only the orders for a specific client, enter the client name (or number) in the field,
and click anywhere outside the field, or press the Tab key.

2 4 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Location

If your system supports multiple locations, you will have an additional filter, for locations.
Depending on the configuration of your user ID, you may or may not be able to use this filter.
LOC If your user ID is configured tot o restrict you to viewing orders only for a single location, you
will not be able to edit the field.

If your user ID is configured to allow you to view orders for all locations, to activate a location
filter to display only the orders for a specific location, enter the location name (or number) in
the field, and click anywhere outside the field, or press the Tab key.

UNDERSTANDING AND USING HANDLES

A handle is
handle is a name, consisting of any alphanumeric text, that is used to identify an order or
group of orders. A handle may be specified in the downloaded orders t hemselves, or you may
add a handle to an order or group of orders in Web Dispatch when you perform any action on
them, such as allocating or waving. Handles help you follow orders throughout processing in
the warehouse, and are especially useful when there are a large number of orders in the system
and it is difficult to distinguish clearly between them.

The Handle field on the order summary screen


scree n lets you enter a handle so that only orders to
which you have applied that handle are displayed. For example, in the following figure, the
handle “unallocaug22” was applied to a group of orders to indicate that they had to be rewaved
 because of an earlier problem. Entering unallocaug22 in the Handle field here will
display only those orders.

To display orders by handle, enter a previously-defined handle, and click anywhere outside the
field, or press the Tab key.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 2 5
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

USING THE RECENT DROP-DOWN BOX

The Recent drop-down box in both Orders and Receiving summary screens lists the most
recently accessed sales order, purchase order, customer, vendor, and product report.

To link directly to the report you want to view, select the packslip, PO, customer, vendor, or
 product number from the list.

UNDERSTANDING PROCESS STEPS

The process steps for sales, work, packaging and purchase orders are summarized in the tables
 below.

Process Steps For Sales Orders

Most of these process steps are discussed in detail in Chapter 2, “Processing Sales Orders”.
Orders”.

Process steps with the “TRANS” prefix apply to transfer sales orders. The warehouse transfer
functionality uses transfer sales orders to move products out of the original warehouse to a
LOC
transit site. For the most part, transfer sales orders are processed identically to regular sales
orders from the perspective of the dispatcher and the warehouse staff. We recommend that you
read “W
“Warehouse/Site
arehouse/Site Transfer” on page 83 83 of
 of the Overview of RADIO BEACON WMS  manual  manual
to understand how transfer sales orders are used as part of the warehouse transfer function.

Process Step Explanation


UNALLOCATED The order has not yet been allocated. If your system is
configured to automatically allocate sales orders on
TRANS UNALLOCATED
UNALLOCATED
download, this status will be skipped.
HELD SHORT Some or all lines in the order require stock that is not
available, and the order was configured to be held until new
TRANS HELD SHORT
stock is received.

2 6 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Process Step Explanation


HELD FOR Some or all lines in the order require stock that is not
REPLENISHMENT available in pickable bins, and the
t he order was configured to be
held until stock in pick bins is replenished.
TRANS HELD FOR
REPLENISHMENT
HELD FORMAT There is inventory in the warehouse to fill this order, but it
cannot be allocated to the order because of an
TRANS HELD FORMAT
FORMAT
incompatibility with the product required for the order.
Examples of wrong formats are wrong packsizes, wrong
attribute data, or storage in zones or warehouses that are
excluded from allocation or replenishment.
WAIT PRE-RATE Stock has been allocated to the order and the order is waiting
to be rated by an external shipping system. This status is only
TRANS WAIT PRE-RATE
displayed if you are using an integrated shipping sys tem, and
it is configured for pre-rating at allocation. It often indicates
a problem in pre-rating.
WAITING - SWOG The order has been fully allocated, but it cannot be released
for picking because it is waiting
wai ting for other orders for the same
TRANS WAITING
WAITING - SWOG
customer and shipping address to be allocated.
PACK & HOLD Some or all lines in the order require stock that is not
available, but the allocated lines
l ines may be picked immediately.
TRANS PACK & HOLD
You must have selected this option when you waved an
waved an
order.
LOCKED A special status that is applied only to packslips from which
a Delivery(ies) has been created and which has remaining
items on the it. Once processing of the Deliveries begins, the
original packslip will be LOCKED, so no further processing
is allowed. The remaining items on the packslip are reported
to the host as unfulfilled.
READY TO WAVE The order has been fully allocated and it is ready to be
released to the warehouse floor.
TRANS READY TO WAVE
WAVED The order has been assigned to a picking wave and
wave and it is ready
to be picked.
TRANS WAVED

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 2 7
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Process Step Explanation


BEING PICKED The order has been opened by a picker and stock is being
 picked.
TRANS BEING PICKED
BEING REPACKED The order has been picked, but it is being repacked.
TRANS BEING REPACKED
REPACKED
READY TO SHIP The order has been completely picked and is ready to be
 processed by shipping functions. This status is only
TRANS READY TO SHIP
displayed if your system is configured for automatic
 background shipping, and an end-of-line configuration is
applied to the order that requires it to be processed in the
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS shipping functions.

RECORD SHIPMENT The order has been completely picked and is being processed
with the Carton Shipping or
Shipping  or Record Shipment shipping
Shipment shipping
TRANS RECORD
functions. This status is only displayed if an end-of-line
SHIPMENT
configuration is applied to the order that requires it to be
 processed in the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS shipping functions.

RATING The order has been completely picked and is being processed
 by an external shipping system. This status is only displayed
TRANS RATING
if an end-of-line configuration is applied to the order that
requires it to be processed and rated by a shipping system.
WAITING BOL# The order has been completely picked and has undergone all
shipping processes, but is waiting for the dispatcher to assign
TRANS WAITING BOL#
a bill of lading number to it. This status is only displayed if
an end-of-line configuration is applied to the order that
requires it to be assigned a bill of lading number.
EXTERNAL The order has been completely picked and has undergone all
shipping processes, but is waiting for an external manual
TRANS EXTERNAL
 process to be performed before it can go out the door.
door. This
status is only displayed if an end-of-line configuration is
applied to the order that requires an external process to be
executed.
 Note: This status is also displayed if an order has been nuked 
and was flagged to be held. For more information, see
“Cancelling
“Cance lling or Expediting
Expediting Sales Orders” on page 120120..

2 8 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Process Step Explanation


SUSPENDED The order has been suspended by the dispatcher, or by a
 problem during allocation. An error message normally
TRANS SUSPENDED
appears indicating the nature of the problem for this status.
READY TO UPLOAD The order has been shipped, and the  pick confirmation is
ready to be uploaded to the host system. Normally, your
TRANS READY TO
system will be configured to automatically upload completed
UPLOAD
sales orders, and this status will not be displayed.
SHIPPED AND UPLOADED The order has been shipped, and the pick confirmation (or
stock move transaction in the case of transfer sales orders)
TRANS SHIPPED AND
has been uploaded to the host system. You
You can only view
UPLOADED
orders in this status from the Reports module. For
information, see “Upload
“Uploaded
ed Shipments Report”
Report” on page 218
218..

Note: Sales orders that are created by the Sales Order By Walking Around function on the
handheld (for information, see “Entering Sales Orders” in
Orders” in Using RADIO BEACON
 Handheld Functions)
Functions ) are immediately placed into RATING, WAITING BOL,
EXTERNAL or READY TO UPLOAD/SHIPPED AND UPLOADED status,
depending on your configuration.

Process Steps For Work Orders


KIT

Most of these process steps are discussed in detail in Chapter 3, “Processing Assembly
Orders”..
Orders”

Process Step Explanation


ASSEMBLY - The order has not yet been allocate d. If your system is configured
UNALLOCATED to automatically allocate work orders on download, this status
will be skipped.
ASSEM
ASSEMBL
BLY
Y-SHOR
-SHORT
T Some
Some or
or all
all lines
lines in the
the kit
kit requ
require
ire sto
stock
ck tha
thatt is not
not avai
availab
lable
le..
ASSEMBLY-WAIT The order has been fully allocated, and is ready for components
REPLEN to be moved from storage bins into a work area, for assembly.
ASSEM
ASSEMBL
BLY
Y-REA
-READY
DY Comp
Compon
onen
entt produ
product
ctss have
have been
been let dow
downn from
from overs
oversto
tock
ck and
and
moved into the work area. The kits are ready to be assembled.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 2 9
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Process Step Explanation


ASSEMBLY-BEING Some of the kits have been built and recorded on the handheld.
BUILT
ASSEMBLY- All of the kits in the order have been assembled, but the kitter has
COMPLETE not yet “finished” the order to release it for upload.
SHIPPED AND The order has been completed, and the adjustments uploaded to
UPLOADED the host system. You can only view orders in this status from the
Reports module. See “Uploa
“Uploaded
ded Shipments
Shipments Report” on pagepage 218
218..

PACK Process Steps For Packaging


Packaging Orders
Most of these process steps are discussed in detail in Chapter 4, “Processing Packaging
Orders”..
Orders”

Process Step Explanation


PKG - READY TO The order was generated from the Packaging Report, and labels
PRINT need to be printed from the handheld.
PKG - WAITING The order is waiting for inventory to be let down from overstock
LETDOWN and moved to the work area for packaging.
PKG - BEI
BEING
NG BUI
BUIL
LT The
The requ
requir
ired
ed inv
inven
ento
tory
ry has
has been
been let down
down fro
from
m ove
overst
rstoc
ock
k and
and
moved into the work area. The inventory is ready to be
 packaged, or the packaging process may be under way.
SHIPPED AND The order has been packaged, and the adjustments uploaded to
UPLOADED the host system. You can only view orders in this status from the
Reports module.See “Packsli
“Packslipp Report”
Report” on page 214
214..

Process Steps For Purchase Orders


Most of these process steps are discussed in detail in Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase Orders
and Returns”.
Returns” .
Process steps with the “TRANS” prefix apply to transfer purchase orders used to move
 products into the destination warehouse when transferring products from one warehouse site to
LOC
another, via a transit site. For the most part, transfer purchase orders are processed identically
to regular purchase orders from the perspective of the dispatcher and the warehouse staff. We
recommend you read “W “Warehouse/Site
arehouse/Site Transfer”
Transfer” on page 8383 of
 of the Overview of RADIO
 BEACON WMS  manual
 manual to understand how transfer purchase orders are used as part of the
warehouse transfer function.

3 0 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Process Step Explanation


REQUISITION Purchase or
orders cr
created vi
via a requisition in
in We
Web Di
Dispatch. Se
See
“ Demand Forecasting ” document.
APPROVED The purchase order was created in Web Dispatch and has not
yet been released to the warehouse floor for receiving. This
O/E status is only displayed if your system is configured to require
PO release.
This process step is not applicable to transfer purchase orders
since only transfer sales orders are created in Web Dispatch.
LOC Transfer purchase orders are created automatically by R ADIO
BEACON WMS when a transfer sales order is uploaded, or
manually on the handheld.
 NOT RECEIVED The purchase order is waiting for product to be received in the
warehouse.
TRANS NOT RECEIVED
BEING RECEIVED A warehouse receiver has opened the purchase order, or has
opened a non-P.O. receipt, and is beginning to receive stock.
TRANS BEING
RECEIVED
READY TO UPLOAD A warehouse receiver has closed the purchase order or non-
P.O. receipt and the receipt confirmation or
confirmation or miscellaneous
TRANSREADY TO
adjustment is ready to be uploaded to the host system.
UPLOAD
 Normally, your
your system will be configured to automatically
upload completed purchase orders, and this status will not be
displayed.
UPLOADED The order has been received, and the receipt confirmation
uploaded to the host system. You can only view orders in this
t his
TRANS UPLOADED
status from the Reports module. For information, see
“Purchase
“Purch ase Order Report”
Report” on page 226
226..

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 3 1
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CONFIGURING THE ORDERS SUMMARY SCREENS

You can customize the display of the Orders and/or Receiving summary screens to suit your
needs.

> To configure the Orders or Receiving summary screen:

1. Click the configuratio


configuration
n icon on the title bar.
bar. The Form Configurat
Configuration
ion window
displays.

2. Clic
Click
k the
the link
link unde
underr the
the controlid heading, or click the link under the header  heading.
 heading.
Either way, the Pivot Grid Configuration window displays.

3 2 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

You can modify the configuration of the Orders and/or Receiving summary screens as follows:

• Enable
Enable/dis
/disabl
ablee the displa
display
y of horizo
horizonta
ntall and/or
and/or verti
vertical
cal pivot
pivots.
s. If enable
enabled,
d, specif
specify
y the
vertical/horizontal pivots that should be by default. Described in “Understanding and
Using Pivots”
Pivots” on page
page 18
18..
• Enable
Enable/Dis
/Disabl
ablee the displa
display
y of alerts
alerts,, filter
filter select
selection
ion boxes,
boxes, and
and incid
incidents
ents.. Describ
Described
ed in
“Alert (Custom)
(Custom)”” on page 2323,, “Filter (Custom
(Custom)” )” on page
page 23
23,, and “Understanding
Incidents”
Incidents” on
on page
page 17
17..
• Specify
Specify defa
default
ult value
valuess that shoul
should
d display
display for
for the prod
product
uct and
and wareho
warehouse
use filte
filters,
rs, and
and for
handles. Described in “Produ
“Product”
ct” on
on page
page 24
24,, “W
“Wareho
arehouse”
use” on page 24
24,, and
“Understandin
“Under standing
g and Using Handles” on pagepage 25
25..
• Enable
Enable/dis
/disabl
ablee selects
selects that
that allow
allow the Web
Web Dispat
Dispatch
ch user
user to filter
filter order
orderss by the summa
summary
ry
table column and/or row. Described in “Using Pivot Selection” below.
Selection” below.

Using Pivot Selection

The Horizontal and Vertical Pivot Selections options in the Form Configuration window let
you display horizontal and vertical selects
vertical  selects.. This is another method of filtering orders, this time
using buttons that appear in pivot columns and rows. These buttons allow the Web Dispatch
user to restrict the display of orders to only those meeting the criterion represented by a
 particular summary table column or row.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 3 3
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

REFRESHING THE SUMMARY SCREEN

The order summary screen does not automatically refresh as you or warehouse staff are
 processing orders. You
You will need to click the Refresh button regularly to update the data .

When you perform an action such as allocating or waving on an order or g roup of orders,
regardless of the screen you use to perform the action, the Order Summary screen always re-
appears automatically, displaying number of background jobs in the status bar:

It may take several seconds, or even minutes, for all jobs to complete processing. To ensure
that the data displayed correctly reflects any actions you or other warehouse staff have
 performed, keep refreshing the display. When
When background jobs are reduced to zero, be sure to
refresh again.

LINKING TO THE ORDER DETAILS SCREENS

To view additional details for groups of orders, in the Orders or Receiving modules, from the
orders summary screen, click on any underlined number in either the # Orders or Process
Step rows.
Click to display
these orders.

The details screen for


screen for the selected orders is displayed, as described i n “Using the Order Details
Screens”
Screens” on
on page
page 35
35..

3 4 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

USING THE ORDER DETAILS SCREENS

When you click on a number of orders in the Orders or Receiving summary screens, you link to
the order details screen, as illustrated below:

Selection check boxes Detail headings

Pop-up menu

The Orders and Receiving details screens contain the following elements:

Element Explanation Described in...


Selection check Click a checkbox to select an order for “Selecting and Processing
 boxes  processing. Orders”
Orders” on page
page 40
40..
 Note: Selection checkboxes also appear in
various reports screens to allow you to
select orders and process them.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 3 5
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Element Explanation Described in...


Detail
Detail headi
headings
ngs Click
Click on a headi
heading
ng to sort
sort order
orderss in the
the
sequence of the selected heading. For
example, click on the Required Date
heading to sort orders by date required.
The headings displayed depend on the
fields that are populated in the orders.
Pop-
Pop-up
up menu
menu Serve
Servess two
two purp
purpose
oses:
s: to selec
selectt and
and desel
deselec
ectt “Selecting and Processing
checkboxes next to orders; and to perform Orders”
Orde rs” on page
page 40
40..
actions on selected orders.

LINKING TO REPORTS SCREENS

From the details screens, you can link to detailed reports screens for orders, vendors and
customers.

Viewing Order Details

To view additional details for an order, in the Orders or Receiving modules respectively, from
the order details screen, click on an underlined number under the Packslip or PO columns.

Click here to view this


order.

The Report screen for


screen for the selected order is displayed, as described in “Using Report Screens”
on pag
pagee 38
38..

3 6 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Viewing Customer Details

To view additional details for a customer, in the Orders module, from the order details screen,
click on an underlined number under the Customer Number  column.
 column.

Click here to view information for


this customer.

The Customer Report screen


Report  screen for the selected customer is displayed, as described in “Customer
Report”
Report” on page 213
213..

Viewing Vendor Details

To view additional details for a vendor, in the in the Receiving module, from the order details
screen module, click on an underlined n umber under the VENDOR NUMBER column.

Click here to view information for


this vendor.

The Vendor Report screen


Report  screen for the selected vendor is displayed, as described in “Vendor
Report”” on page 222
Report 222..

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 3 7
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

USING REPORT SCREENS

When you click on an order number in the sales/work or purchase orders details screens, you
link to the Packslip (sales/work/packaging order) or Purchase Order Report screens.

Log button
Edit button

General order
information

Detailed order information

Line
informatio

Pop-up menu

Tip: You can also access order report screens from the Reports module. For more
information, see “General Procedures for
for Generating Reports”
Reports” on page 209
209 of
 of
Chapter 7, “Generating Reports”.
Reports” .

3 8 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Packslip (sales order) and Purchase Order Report screens contain the following elements:

Element Explanation Described in...


Edit button Click to edit the order. “Editing Sales, Work, Packaging
and Transfer Sales Orders” on
(only available if you have
 page 260
260 and
 and “Editing Purchase
the appropriate
Order Informati
Information”
on” on page 264
264..
 permissions)
SHIP BOL button (Packslip Click to create a bill of “Generating Bills of Lading and
Report screens only) lading for the order. Manifests”
Manifests” on page 125
125..
Log button Click to display the log Chapter 11, “Troubleshooting”
report for the order. on page
page 31
311
1.
(only available if you have
the appropriate
 permissions)
Gene
Genera
rall orde
orderr info
inform
rmati
ation
on Displ
Display
ayss gener
general
al
information, such as
customer/vendor data,
status, and so on.
Line details Show the status of product, “Understanding Sales Order
and bins from which the Line Statuses”
Statuses” on page 57
57 and
 and
 product has been allocated. “Understanding the Purchase
You can also edit order Order Report Screen” on
lines by clicking the Edit  page 173
173..
link under the Edit heading
“Editing Sales/Work/T
Sales/Work/Transfer/
ransfer/
for the line, if you have the
Packaging Order Line Details”
appropriate permissions.
on pag
pagee 26
262
2 and “Editing or
Deleting Purchase Order Line
Details” on page 265
265..
Detaile
Detailed
d orde
orderr info
informa
rmation
tion Display
Displayss spec
special
ial “Understanding Process Flags”
instructions, statistics, on pag
pagee 59
59..
handling codes.

N AV IG AT IN G W EB D IS PA TC H 3 9
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Element Explanation Described in...


Pop-up menu Performs actions on the “Selecting and Processing
current order.
order. Orders” on page
page 40
40..

Shipping/carton Displays carton serial “Understanding Shipping


information (Packslip numbers, track-trace Statuses”
Statuses” on
on page
page 63
63..
Report screens only) numbers, statuses, and
statistics.

Packslip and Purchase Order Report screens also allow you to do the following:

• Access
Access report
report scree
screens
ns for vend
vendors
ors,, custome
customers,
rs, produ
products,
cts, from
from which
which you
you can link
link to othe
otherr
report screens and vendor, customer, and product edit screens. For more information, see
Chapter 7, “Genera
“Generating
ting Reports”
Reports” on page 201201,, and Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and
Wareho
arehouse
use Data” on page 259
259..

• Open your
your e-mai
e-maill client
client progr
program
am with
with a pre-ad
pre-addre
dressed
ssed e-ma
e-mail
il to a custom
customer
er or vend
vendor
or
contact person.

SELECTING AND PROCESSING ORDERS


The following sections provide general procedures for selecting individual orders, or groups of
orders, and process them:

• “Selecting
“Selecting Orders”
Orders” on page
page 41
41..

• “Processing
“Processing Orders
Orders from Details Screens”
Screens” on page 41
41..

• “Processing
“Processing Orders from Report
Report Screens” on page 42
42..

• “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44


44..

4 0 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

SELECTING ORDERS

To process orders in the Details screens in the Orders and Receiving modules, you must select
an order or groups of orders to which you will apply an action. By default, when you access the
details screens, all orders are selected. This means that any actions you apply to them, by right-
clicking anywhere in the screen
sc reen and invoking the pop-up menu, will apply to all orders. To
deselect or reselect specific orders, use the following procedures.

> To select/deselect an order:

Click a check box next to an order to enable or disable it.

> To select/deselect all orders:

Right-click anywhere on the details screen, and from the pop-up menu that appears, choose
On/Off  to
 to toggle between enabling or disabling all check boxes.

> To select/deselect a contiguous group of orders:

1. Click a check
check box next to the first
first order
order of
of the group to enable
enable or disable it.

2. Click a check
check box next to
to the last order
order of the group
group to enable or disable
disable it.

3. Right-click
Right-click anywhere
anywhere on the details
details screen,
screen, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu
menu that
that appears,
appears,
choose Between. All orders between the first and last are selected/deselected.

PROCESSING ORDERS FROM DETAILS SCREENS

To process
process orders once you have selected the m, you right-click anywhere on the details screen
to invoke the pop-up menu, and select an action. An overview of pop-up menu actions is
 provided in “Using Pop-Up
Pop-Up Menu Actions”
Actions” on page
page 42
42..

Note: The actual set of actions available on your pop-up menus will depend on the
 permissions configured for your user ID.

S EL EC TI NG A ND P RO CE SS IN G O RD ER S 4 1
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PROCESSING ORDERS FROM REPORT SCREENS

You can process a single order from a Packslip or Purchase Order Report screen by right-
clicking anywhere on the screen to invoke the pop-up menu, and selecting an action. The
Customer, Bin, and Product reports also allow you to select orders as in the order details
screens (see above), and apply an action to the selected group of orders, as in the following
example (taken from a Product Report screen):

USING POP-UP MENU ACTIONS

The following table summarizes the functions of the Orders module pop-up menu actions, the
types of orders to which the actions apply, and the sections of this manual in which they are
described in more detail.

Action Use to... Described in...


Allocate Allocate and re-allocate stock to “Allocating and Re-allocating Sales
sales, work and transfer sales Orders
Orders”” on page 67
67..
orders, and re-allocate stock to
“Allocating and Re-allocating
Re-all ocating Work
 packaging orders.
Orders”” on page 147
Orders 147..
Unalloc
locate Una
Unallocate and free up stoc
tock from “Unallocating Sales Orders” on
allocated sales, work, transfer  page 88
88..
sales, or packaging orders.
“Unallocating Work Orders” on
 page 155
155..
Wave Release allocated sales and “Waving and Re-waving Orders”
“Waving Orders ” on
transfer sales orders for picking.  page 99
99..

4 2 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Action Use to... Described in...


Unwave Pull waved sales or transfer sales “Unwaving
“Unwaving Orders” on page 11
111
1.
orders back from picking.
Ship Apply shipping options to sales “Understanding and Modifying
orders or transfer sales, or Shipping
Shipping Options”
Options” on page 90
90..
 perform handheld shipping
“Pre-rating
“Pre-rating Orders”
Orders” on page
page 98
98..
functions in Web Dispatch.
“Performing Shipping Actions” on
 page 112
112..
 Nuke Cancel or expedite sales or “Cancelling or Expediting Sales
transfer sales orders, or cancel Orders” on page
page 120
120..
work or packaging orders.
“Cancelling Work Orders” on
 page 156
156..
Suspend Remove sales or transfer sales “Suspending
“Suspending Orders”
Orders” on page 118
118..
orders from processing.
Unsuspend Return su
suspended sa
sales or
or “Unsuspending
“Unsuspending Orders”
Orders” on page 11
119
9.
transfer sales orders to normal
 processing.
Clon
Clonee Picki
Picking
ng Proc
Process
ess iden
identic
tical
al sales
sales orde
orders
rs “Using Clone
Clone Picking”
Picking” on page 135
quickly, based on the picking and
 packing process used on the
original ‘master’ sales order.
Unclone Cancels clone picking. “Cancelling Clone Picking” on
 page 137
Test Order Create a snapshot of your current “Creating a Test Order Database” on
Database sales, work, and packaging order  page 316
316..
data, for support purposes.

S EL EC TI NG A ND P RO CE SS IN G O RD ER S 4 3
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following table summarizes the functions of the Receiving module pop-up menu actions,
and the sections of this manual in which they are described in more detail.

Action Use to... Described in...


Rele
Release
ase Orde
Orderr Relea
Release
se purc
purcha
hase
se orde
orders
rs crea
created
ted “Releasing Purchase Orders” on
in Web Dispatch for receiving.  page 177
177..
O/E This action is only available if
your system is configured to
require PO release
Delete PO
PO Cancel or
or ex
expedite pu
purchase or
or “Cancelling or Expediting Purchase
transfer purchase orders. Orders”” on page 179
Orders 179..
Comp
Comple
lete
te PO Comp
Complelete
te and
and clos
closee rece
receiv
ived
ed “Closing Purchase Orders” on
 purchase or transfer purchase  page 178
178..
orders.
Test PO Create a snapshot of your current “Creating a Test Order Database” on
Database  purchase order data, for support  page 316
316..
 purposes.

GENERAL PROCEDURES FOR PROCESSING ORDERS

> To process orders:

1. Select an
an order
order or group of orders
orders to be processed
processed,, by doing one of
of the following:
following:

• From
From the
the Ord
Order
erss or
or Rec
Receiv
eivin
ing
g deta
detail
ilss scre
screen
ens,
s, select the desired order  or
 or orders (for
 procedures, see “Select
“Selecting
ing Orders”
Orders” on page
page 41
41).
).

• Open the Packs


Packslip
lip (sale
(sales/wo
s/work/
rk/pac
packag
kaging
ing orde
order)
r) Repor
Reportt or Purcha
Purchase
se Order
Order Repor
Reportt
screen for the desired order.

• From
From anothe
anotherr report
report scre
screen,
en, such
such as
as the Custo
Customer
mer Repo
Report,
rt, whic
which
h shows
shows open
open order
orderss
for a given customer, the Product Report, which shows open orders for a given
 product, and the Bin Detail Report, which shows open orders for a given pick bin,
select the desired order or orders (for
orders  (for procedures, see “Selecti
“Selecting
ng Orders”
Orders” on page 41
41).).

4 4 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2. Right-click
Right-click anywhere
anywhere on the screen,
screen, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select the action
action you
you want
to perform. An overview of each action is provided in “Using Pop-Up Menu Actions” on
 page 42
42.. The Settings window for the selected action is displayed.

3. Optionally
Optionally,, modify
modify settings
settings for this order
order or group
group of orders.
orders. Settings
Settings for each
each action
action are
described throughout Chapter 2, “Processing Sales Orders”,
Orders”, Chapter 3, “Processing
Assembly Orders”,
Orders”, and Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .

4. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, in
in the
the Handle field, enter an identifier for the order or group of orders being
 processed.

Tip: It is a good practice to use a common naming convention, including your initials, the
date, and the reason for the handle. For example, a handle you might apply to a group
of orders that you are allocating  would
 would be KMJune6Alloc1 .

5. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Submit (or click  Close
 Close to cancel). The orders summary screen is
automatically displayed, with the number of background jobs (representing the number of
orders being processed) in the status bar.

Click the Refresh button as many times as necessary to completely update the order display.
When all orders have been processed, they should be updated with the appropriate s ettings and/
or statuses, as described throughout Chapter 2, “Processing Sales Orders”,
Orders”, Chapter 3,
“Processing Assembly Orders”,
Orders” , Chapter 4, “Processing Packaging Orders”,
Orders”, and Chapter 5,
“Processing Purchase Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .

S EL EC TI NG A ND P RO CE SS IN G O RD ER S 4 5
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING DEFAULT SETTINGS


The options for the Allocate, Wave, Unwave, Nuke, Delete PO, and Advance Replenishment
actions in the Orders, Receiving, and Reports modules are populated with defaults defined in
your R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS configuration. These options are explained in the following
sections of this manual, which discuss how to edit these settings on-the-fly for specific orders:

• “Understanding and Modifying Sales Order Allocation Options” on page 70


70..

• “Understanding and Modifying Work


Work Order Replenishment Options” on page 149 .

• “Understanding and Modifying Wave Options” on page 101


101..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Unwave Option” on page 112


112..

• “Understanding and Modifying Sales Order Nuke Options” on page 121


121..

• “Understanding and Modifying Work


Work Order Nuke Options” on page
page 157

• “Understanding and Modifying Delete Options” on page 180


180..

• “Understanding and Modifying Advance Replenishment Options” on page 307

However, if your system is not multi-company/client, you can also edit the default settings for
your user ID only, so that the settings you choose a lways appear by default whenever you log
on to Web Dispatch.

4 6 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To edit default action settings:

1. Go to the options
options you
you want
want to set
set as describ
described
ed in the cross-ref
cross-references
erences listed above. For
example, here we will set allocation options.

2. Select or enter
enter the desired values from the
the drop-down
drop-down lists or text fields.
fields. For more
more
information on each option, see the cross-references listed above.

3. When
When done
done,, clic
click
k Save as Default. The defaults you have specified are now displayed on
as the defaults whenever this screen is accessed.

In addition, you can set the default warehouse for


warehouse for your instance of Web Dispatch, so only
orders for that warehouse are ever displayed.

Note: The facility for editing default Web Dispatch settings for an individual user is not
3PL
available if you are using the 3PL edition of RADIO BEACON.

E DI TI NG D EF AU LT S ET TI NG S 4 7
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EXITING WEB DISPATCH


When you are finished a Web Dispatch session, you should log off.

> To log off Web Dispatch:

1. From
From the
the nav
navig
igati
ation
on bar
bar, clic
click
k Exit. The logon screen is displayed.

2. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, close
close your
your Interne
Internett Explore
Explorerr window
window..

4 8 C H A P T E R 1 U S I N G T H E W E B D I S P A T C H I N T E R F A C E
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2 PROCESSING SALES ORDERS

ABOUT PROCESSING SALES ORDERS


You process sales orders by applying actions to
actions to them. These actions take orders through the
 processing cycle described in “Understanding RADIO BEACON WMS Processes” in
Processes” in the
manual Overview of RADIO BEACON WMS . You You may wish to revie w that chapter before
continuing.

You process transfer sales orders in t he same way as regular sales orders, by applying t he same
actions. For the most part, transfer sales orders are processed identically to regular sales orders
from the perspective of the dispatcher and the warehouse staff. The warehouse/site transfer
LOC functionality is described in “W
“Warehouse/Site
arehouse/Site Transfer” in
Transfer” in the Overview of RADIO BEACON
WMS  manual.
 manual.

Note: Unless otherwise indicated, all processing, statuses and actions described in this
LOC
chapter apply to transfer sales orders in the same way as regular sales orders.

The following sections provide conceptual background information on working with sales
orders:

• “Understandin
“Understanding
g Sales Order Actions and Statuses”
Statuses” on page 50
50..

• “Understandin
“Understanding
g the Packslip Report Screen”
Screen” on page 56
56..

• “Understanding Types
Types of Sales Orders” on page 65
65..

• “Additional
“Additional Sales Order Processing
Processing Functions”
Functions” on page 67
67..

4 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING SALES ORDER ACTIONS AND STATUSES

The actions that appear on the


th e pop-up menu in the Orders details and Packslip, Customer, Bin
Detail, and Product report screens are used to process orders and move them through the
warehouse cycle:

• Allocate

• Unallocate

• Realloc
Reallocate
ate Line
Line (avai
(availabl
lablee from
from the
the Prod
Product
uct Report
Report screen
screen only)
only)

• Release
Release (availa
(available
ble from
from the
the Excepti
Exception
on Report
Report screen
screen only)
only)

• Ship

• Wave

• Unwave

• Suspend

• Unsuspend

• Clone Picking

• Unclone

• Nuke

Note: The actions that are actually available to you will depend on your permissions.

5 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following sections provide an overview of the actions that you can apply to sales orders,
the stage in the processing cycle at which you normally perform them, and the sections in this
chapter in which they are described. For an overview of sales order process steps, see
“Understandin
“Under standingg Process Steps” on page 26
26..

Process steps with the “TRANS” prefix apply to transfer sales orders that are used to move
 products out of the original warehouse when transferring products from one warehouse site to
LOC
another, via a transit site. For the most part, transfer sales orders are processed identically to
regular sales orders from the perspective of the dispatcher and the warehouse staff.

ABOUT THE ALLOCATE ACTION

You use the Allocate action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in this Described in...


status...
Allocate stock to sales orders that (TRANS) UNALLOCATED
UNALLOCATED “Allocating and Re-
have not yet been allocated. allocating Sales Orders”
on pa
page
ge 67
67..
Re-allocate orders that were not (TRANS) HELD FOR “Allocating and Re-
allocated successfully, or have REPLENISHMENT allocating Sales Orders”
 been only partially allocated. (TRANS) HELD SHORT on pa
page
ge 67
67..
(TRANS) HELD FORMAT
FORMAT
(TRANS) WAIT PRE-RATE

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 5 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE UNALLOCATE ACTION

You use the Unallocate action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in this Described in...


status...
Unallocate previously (TRANS) READY TO WAVE “Unallocating Sales
allocated sales or work orders (TRANS) HELD FOR Orders”
Orders” on page
page 88
88..
and free up reserved stock. REPLENISHMENT
(TRANS) HELD SHORT
S HORT
(TRANS) HELD FORMAT
FORMAT
(TRANS) WAIT PRE-RATE
(TRANS) WAITING
WAITING - SWOG

ABOUT THE REALLOCATE LINE ACTION

You can use the Reallocate Line action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in this Described in...


status...
Re-allocate one product on a (TRANS) READY TO WAVE, “Allocating and Re-
single or multiple orders. (TRANS) HELD FOR allocating Sales Orders”
REPLENISHMENT, on pa
page
ge 67
67..
(TRANS) HELD SH ORT
(TRANS) HELD FORMAT
FORMAT

ABOUT THE RELEASE ACTION

The Release action, available only from the Exception Report, is used to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Release orders without missing HELD SHOR
SHO RT “Releasing Orders with
 products, to be shipped short. HELD FORMAT Held Lines”
Lines” on page 85

5 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE SHIP ACTION


SHIP
You use the Ship action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in this Described in...


status...
Modify various shipping any,
any, but preferably “Understanding and
options for orders. (TRANS) READY TO WAVE Modifying Shipping
Options”
Options” on page 90
90..
Pre-rate orders by an (TRANS) READY TO WAVE “Pre-rating Orders” on
integrated shipping system.  page 98
98..
Bypass order pre-rating by an (TRANS) WAIT PRE-RATE “Handling Wait Pre-Rate
integrated shipping system. Orders
Orders”” on page 87
87..
Release orders that are held (TRANS) WAITING - SWOG “Handling Waiting -
to be shipped with other SWOG Orders” on
goods.  page 87
87..
Bypass or perform order (TRANS) BEING PICKED, “Performing Shipping
shipping functions. (TRANS) BEING REPACKED,
REPACKED, Actions”
Actions” on page 112
112..
(TRANS) READY TO SHIP,
SHIP,
(TRANS) RATING

ABOUT THE WAVE ACTION

You use the Wave action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in this Described in...


status...
Release allocated orders to the (TRANS) READY TO “Waving and Re-waving
“Waving
warehouse floor, making them WAVE Orders”” on page 99
Orders 99..
available to pickers.
Release partially allocated orders (TRANS)HELD SHORT/ “Packing and Holding
to the floor to be picked and then FOR REPLENISHMENT Orders”” on page 109
Orders 109..
held.
Consolidate multiple orders into a (TRANS) READY TO “Consolidating Orders”
single order.
order. WAVE on pag
pagee 10
109
9.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 5 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE UNWAVE ACTION

You use the Unwave action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in this Described


Described in...
status...
Pull an order back from the (TRANS)WAVED, “Unwaving Orders” on
warehouse floor. (TRANS) BEING PICKED,  page 11
111
1.
(TRANS)PACK
(TRANS)PACK & HOLD

ABOUT THE SUSPEND ACTION

You use the Suspend action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Hold a released order from further any “Suspending Orders” on
 processing until a manual procedure  page 118
118..
has been performed.

ABOUT THE UNSUSPEND ACTION

You use the Unsuspend action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Place a suspended order back into the (TRANS) SUSPENDED “Unsuspending Orders”
main pool of warehouse orders to be on pag
pagee 11
119
9.
 processed as usual.

5 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE NUKE ACTION

You use the Nuke action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Cancel an order and, optionally, delete any “Cancelling or
it from R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS. Expediting Sales
Orders” on page
page 120
120..
Expedite an order by bypassing any “Cancelling or
normal processing steps. Expediting Sales
Orders” on page
page 120
120..

ABOUT THE CLONE PICKING ACTION

You use the Clone Picking action


act ion to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Process identical sales orders quickly, (TRANS) READY TO “Using Clone Picking”
 based on the picking and packing WAVE on pag
pagee 13
135
5.
 process used on the original ‘master’
sales order.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 5 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE UNCLONE ACTION

You use the Unclone action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in this Described in...


status...
Reverse clone picked sales Previously cloned orders in any “Cancelling Clone
orders and return them to status indicating that an order is Picking”” on page 137
Picking 137..
READY TO WAVE status. completely picked, but not yet
uploaded to the host.
(TRANS) READY TO SHIP,
SHIP,
(TRANS) READY TO
UPLOAD,
(TRANS) RATING
(TRANS) EXTENDED

UNDERSTANDING THE PACKSLIP REPORT SCREEN

The Packslip Report screen tells you all the details about an order, and is helpful for monitoring
and troubleshooting a sales order throughout all stages of the warehouse cycle, from initial
allocation, to shipping and upload to the host system.

The following sections describe portions of the report screen that you can use to monitor an
order’s progress:

• “Understandin
“Understanding
g Sales Order Line Statuses”
Statuses” on page 57
57..

• “Understandin
“Understanding
g Process Flags” on page 59
59..

• “Understandin
“Understanding
g Shipping Statuses”
Statuses” on page 63
63..

5 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING SALES ORDER LINE STATUSES

In addition to order  statuses,
 statuses, the lines on sales orders are also marked with statuses, which are
displayed on Packslip Report screens. It may be helpful for troubleshooting purposes to view
the line results, so that you can see the product(s) that may be holding up an order.
order. In the
example below, the order has been held short because of the products ordered in the first two
lines.

Line number  Product ordered for that Line status


line

Line statuses are marked and color-coded as follows:

Status In
Indicator Color Explanation
 Not Alloc Grey The line has not been allocated.
Bin label(s) Green The line has been allocated, from the pick bins indicated.
Bin label(s) Blue Product for this line is not available in pick bins, but is
available in the overstock bins indicated. The line requires
that product be replenished to pick bins.
Short Red Product for this line is not available anywhere in the
warehouse. The line requires that product be received and
replenished to pick bins.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 5 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Status In
Indicator Color Explanation
Wrong Format Red Product for this line is available in the warehouse, but
cannot be allocated to this order due to an incompatibility
incompatibili ty..
Additional information regarding the cause of the
 problem is also indicated (for more information, see
“Handling
“Handl ing Held Format
Format Orders” on page 83 83).
).
Batch Picked Brown The line has been batch picked,
picked, but needs to be packed to
 be completed.
Picked Black The line has been picked.
Shorted Black The line has been shorted by the dispatcher during
allocation, or by a picker.
Build Grey The order is part of a build-to-order work order and the
line is for an assembled item. The order is waiting for the
work order to be processed, and the finished goods to be
 built.

As orders are allocated and picked, the line statuses are updated accordingly:

 Note that, if you have the appropriate


appropriate permissions, you can also directly edit or delete an order
line from
line from this screen, if you need to make changes to the order since it was downloaded, or if
editing the order is necessary for successful allocation. For information on editing orders, see
“Editing Sales/Work/Transfer/Packaging
Sales/Work/Transfer/Packaging Order Line Details” on page 262 262..

5 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING PROCESS FLAGS

In addition to order process steps, process flags


process  flags indicate
 indicate steps that a re required for orders once
they are waved out, according to the end-of-line configuration applied to the carrie r for the
SHIP order, or to the order itself. There are six different end-of-line configurations possible for your
implementation, each of which will specify different actions to be performed automatically at
different points of the picking and shipping process, such as printing labels and other
documents, and so on. They are numbered as follows:

• 0: Default
Default — This
This is the end-
end-of-
of-lin
linee configu
configurat
ration
ion that
that is applied
applied to
to all order
orderss by default
default,, if
no other is specified.

• 1: 1-Cou
1-Courie
rierr — This
This config
configura
uratio
tion
n is usually
usually used
used for
for orders
orders shipp
shipped
ed by cour
couriers
iers that
that
define a shipment as a single shipping carton, such as Fedex or UPS.

• 2: M-Cou
M-Courie
rierr — This
This config
configura
uration
tion is usually
usually used for orde
orders
rs shippe
shipped
d by couri
couriers
ers that
that
define a shipment as being made up of multiple cartons, such as Purolator.

• 3: LTL
LTL Truck
Truck — This configu
configuration
ration is usually
usually used
used for orders
orders shipped
shipped by an LTL
LTL carrier
carrier,,
for which a bill of lading is often required.

• 4: Picku
Pickup
p — This
This config
configura
uration
tion is usual
usually
ly used
used for
for orders
orders that
that are
are picke
picked
d up by
by the
customer.

• 5: Other
Other — This
This conf
configu
igurat
ration
ion can
can be
be used
used for
for shipme
shipments
nts hand
handled
led by
by other
other means
means..

The end-of-line process that is applied to the order is displayed in the End of Line field under
the Handling Codes heading in the Packslip Report screen, once an order has been waved.
You can override or apply an end-of-line configuration on the fly from Web Dispatch during
waving, or by using the Ship action; for more information, see “Understanding and Modifying
Shipping
Shipping Method Options”
Options” on page
page 92
92 and
 and “Understanding and Modifying End-of-Line
Options”” on page 103
Options 103.)
.)

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 5 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Each end-of-line configuration determines whether the following steps are required for an
order, and specifies any follow-on actions that must be performed once the step has been
accomplished:

• An order is batch-picked.
 batch-picked.

• The
The fin
final
al pic
pick
k in
in an
an ord
order
er is com
compl
plet
eted
ed..

• An ord
order
er has
has bee
been
n com
compl
plet
etel
ely
y rep
repac
acke
ked.
d.

• The
The fir
first
st carto
carton
n in
in an
an ord
order
er has
has bee
been
n scan
scanne
ned.
d.

• Any
Any car
carto
ton
n in
in an
an ord
order
er has
has bee
been
n sca
scann
nned
ed..

• The
The las
lastt car
carto
ton
n in
in an
an ord
order
er has
has bee
been
n scan
scanne
ned.
d.

• The
The first
first cart
carton
on in
in an orde
orderr has
has been
been add
added
ed to
to a pall
pallet.
et.

• The
The last
last car
carto
ton
n in an ord
order
er has
has bee
been
n adde
added
d to a pall
pallet.
et.

• An ord
order
er has
has bee
been
n assig
assigne
ned
d a bill
bill of lad
lading
ing numb
number
er..

• Shippin
Shipping
g has
has been
been conf
confirm
irmed
ed by
by an extern
external
al ship
shippin
ping
g system
system,, or by a R ADIO
ADIO BEACON
WMS shipping function.

• An ext
exter
erna
nall proc
proces
esss has
has been
been com
compl
plet
eted
ed..

These milestones are translated into process flags, which are displayed on the order report
screen, with a code of nil, 0, or 1:

6 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

In some cases, the values of the process flags also determine the process  steps that
 steps that the order
will pass through, and the point at which process steps are reached. The following table
explains the relationship between process flag values and process steps. If no process is
required for that step, that process step indicated will never be displayed for the order.

Process Flag Value Explanation Triggers this


process step...
Is Started 0 The order has not yet begun to be
 picked.
1 The order has been opened for BEING PICKED
 picking.
Batch Picked 0/null The order has not yet been picked.
1 The order has been batch picked or all
 picked.
All Picked 0/null The order is not yet completely
 picked.
1 The last pick is complete.
All Repacked 0/null The order must be repacked, but the BEING
repacking is not complete. REPACKED
1 No process is required when the order
is repacked, or the repacking is
complete.
First Scan 0/null A carton in the order must be RECORD
 processed in the Carton Shipping or
Shipping  or SHIPMENT
Record Shipment functions
Shipment functions on the
handheld, but a carton has not yet
 been scanned.
1 No carton scanning is required for the
order, or the first carton in the order
has been scanned.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 6 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Process Flag Value Explanation Triggers this


process step...
Last Scan null Each carton in the order must be RECORD
scanned in the Carton Shipping or SHIPMENT
Record Shipment functions in the
handheld, but all the cartons have not
yet been scanned.
1 Each carton in the order does not need
to be scanned, or the scanning is
complete.
Ship Checkin 0 The order must be scanned in the RATING (if a
Carton Shipping function. shipping system is
notified)
1 The order does not need to be
scanned, or the scanning is complete.
External 0 An external process is required for the EXTERNAL
order, but is not yet complete.
1 No external process is required, or is
complete
BOL 0/nil The order must be assigned a bill of WAITING BOL#
lading number, but the number has not
yet been assigned.
1 A bill of lading number has been
assigned to the order, or the order d oes
not require a bill of lading.
Packslip 0 A packslip has not yet been printed for
the order.
1 A packslip has been printed.

6 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Process Flag Value Explanation Triggers this


process step...
Shipped 0 Shipping must be confirmed by the
shipping system, or a R ADIO
ADIO BEACON
WMS shipping function, but shipping
has not yet been confirmed.
1 Shipping does not need to be
confirmed by the shipping system or a
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS shipping
function, or shipping has been
confirmed.

UNDERSTANDING SHIPPING STATUSES

When an order is waved, carton information for the order appears at t he bottom of the Packslip
Report screen:

Carton status Carton Track-trace


number  number 

As orders are picked, the carton display is updated with additional information, and carton
statuses are updated according to
t o the processes required by the order ’s end-of-line
configuration:

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 6 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following table explains the meaning of the carton statuses.

Status Explanation
PRE-
PRE-RA
RATI
TING
NG The
The car
carto
ton
n is
is wai
waiti
ting
ng to be pre-
pre-ra
rate
ted
d by
by an
an int
integ
egra
rate
ted
d shi
shipp
ppin
ing
g sys
syste
tem,
m,
or there is an error in pre-rating.
PRE-
PRE-RA
RATE
TED
D The
The cart
carton
on has
has bee
been n rate
rated
d by the
the shi
shipp
ppin
ing
g syst
system
em,, and
and ship
shippi
ping
ng cost
costs,
s,
and the carrier (if rate shopping was requested for the order) have
 been provided to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS. No information is retained
 by the shipping system.
PICKING The or
order ha
has be
been op
opened fo
for pi
picking, bu
but th
the ca
carton ha
has no
not ye
yet be
been
used.
EMPTY The order has been picked but the carton was not used.
SCAN
SCAN/S
/SHI
HIP
P The
The ord
order
er has been
been pick
picked
ed,, and
and the
the car
carto
ton
n is
is req
requ
uired
ired to be scan
scann
ned in
one of the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS shipping functions.

SCANNED
NED The carton
ton has been sca
scanned in the Carton Ship
Shipp
ping or Record
Shipment handheld functions (or with the Mark as Checked In option
in the Ship action in Web Dispatch; see “Performing Shipping System
Functions”
Functi ons” on page 115
115).
).
RATING or The carton is waiting to be rated (and manifested, if required) by an
RATING/ integrated shipping system.
MANIFESTING
RATEDSHIP/ The carton has been rated (and manifested, if necessary) by the
MANIFESTED shipping system, and shipping costs and the carrier (if rate shopping
was requested for the order) have been provided to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON
WMS. The carton/order information is retained on the shipping
system.
SHIPPED All shipping processes have been completed for the carton.
UNSH
UNSHIIPPED
PPED The
The ord
order
er has
has bee
been
n pic
picke
ked
d and
and mark
marked
ed as ship
shipp
ped,
ed, but
but the
the car
carto
ton
n was
was
not required to undergo any shipping processes.
CANCE
NCELLING The ca
carton
ton is
is be
being
ing ca
cancelled by R ADIO BEACON WMS.
CANC
CANCEL
ELLE
LED
D The
The car
carto
ton
n has
has been
been canc
cancel
elle
led
d on
on the
the ship
shippi
ping
ng syst
system
em..
ERROR The shipping system has encountered an error in attempting to rate the
carton, such as missing weights for the shipment.

6 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING TYPES OF SALES ORDERS

Because not all sales orders are processed in the same way, it is helpful to recognize the
different types of sales orders that are supported by R ADIO BEACON WMS and managed in
Web Dispatch. These include:

• Sales
Sales orde
orders
rs are
are issued
issued by the host
host system
system and downlo
downloade
aded
d to
to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS.
These may follow any numbering convention determined by your setup, but typically they
include the customer number, order number, back order number, customer store number,
customer department number, client number, and warehouse number. They will show
customer information and ship-to information in the Packslip Report. Unless your system
is configured for automatic allocation and/or waving, you must allocate and wave these
orders, and you can apply all actions to them.

• Trans
Transfer
fer sales
sales order
orderss are issued
issued by the
the host
host or create
created
d in Web
Web Dispatc
Dispatch h order
order entry
entry for
for
transferring products from one warehouse site to another via a transit site, using the
warehouse transfer function Transfer sales ordersorders are used to ‘pick’ the items that will be
LOC
transferred out of the warehouse. Transfer sales orders are, for the most part, processed
identically to regular sales orders from the perspective of the dispatcher and the warehouse
staff. These orders are easy to distinguish in Web Dispatch by the TRANS prefix for all
 process steps.

• Back
Back orders
orders autom
automati
atical
cally
ly create
created
d by the
the host
host system.
system. Thes
Thesee will foll
follow
ow the numb
numberin
ering
g
convention determined by the host system.
s ystem. You
You process these orders in the same way as
regular sales orders.

• Back
Back orde
orders
rs tha
thatt are
are auto
automa
matitical
cally
ly crea
created
ted by R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS for previous sales
orders that were picked/shipped short. These are numbered in the same way as the original
orders from which they are generated, with the extension -n where n indicates the number
of the back order (e.g. 1, 2, etc.). You process these orders in the same way as regular sales
orders.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 6 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• Sales
Sales order
orderss manua
manually
lly entere
entered
d by
by a hand
handheld
held user throug
throughh the
the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON Sales Order
 by Walking
Walking Around function or by a third-party application. Depending on your
configuration, these are automatically numbered in sequence, with 8 digits, starting with
00000001, or they may be numbered by the user at order entry. Since these orders can only
 be created for inventory that is known to be available, they are automatically allocated by
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON and do not need to be waved. Again, depending on your configuration,
they may never appear in Web Dispatch, or they may be treated as already-picked orders,
and will show up in the status of RATING, EXTERNAL or WAITING BOL. You can
therefore use only the actions that apply to orders in these statuses, such as Ship or Nuke.

• Sales
Sales orders
orders enter
entered
ed throu
through
gh the
the Web
Web Dispat
Dispatch
ch Order
Order Entry
Entry functio
function.
n. These
These are
are
O/E automatically numbered in sequence, with 10 digits, starting with 0000000001, or they
may be numbered by the user at a t order entry. You
You process these orders in the same way as
regular sales orders.

• Build-t
Build-to-o
o-orde
rderr assemb
assembly
ly order
orderss issued
issued by
by the host
host system
system and
and downl
download
oaded
ed into
into R ADIO
ADIO
BEACON as sales orders. Also known as “explode-on-download”, or “kit-on-the-fly”, these
are build-to-order assembly orders which are treated by R ADIO
ADIO BEACON as regular sales
orders. While the customer may have ordered the items as “finished goods”, the
components are simply picked as regular products. The only difference between these
orders and regular sales orders is that the Packslip Report will show the finished good as a
line item in addition to the component products. You
You process these orders in the same wa y
as regular sales orders.

• Build-t
Build-to-o
o-orde
rderr assemb
assembly
ly order
orderss issued
issued by
by the host
host system
system and
and downl
download
oadeded into
into R ADIO
ADIO
KIT BEACON as two separate orders: an assembly order, and a sales order. Usually these order
 pairs are prefixed with some kind of code to indicate that they are part of a work order,
such as “ASM”. The assembly order is numbered the same as its corresponding sales
order, but with the extension .001 (for information on these types of assembly orders, see
“Understanding Types
Types of Assembly Orders” on page 146 146).
). Significantly
Significantl y, however,
although the sales orders that accompany the work orders will appear in Web Dispatch as
UNALLOCATED
UNALLOCATED initially, you do not need to allocate the sales orders. RAD IO BEACON
will automatically move them from UNALLOCATED
UNALLOCATED status into an already-picked status,
as determined by their end-of-line settings, as soon as the kitting process for the work
orders is complete. The shipping information for the cartons into which the finished goods
were packed by the kitters is indicated when the kitting process is complete.

6 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• Creati
Creating
ng a deliver
delivery
y, effects
effects two
two types
types of packs
packslips
lips—a
—a new ‘deliv
‘delivery
ery’’ packslip
packslip,, and the
the
‘original’ packslip, which is defined as the packslip from which items were selected for
the delivery. For more information see, “Creating Deliveries In RADIO BEACON” on
 page 130
130..

ADDITIONAL SALES ORDER PROCESSING FUNCTIONS

Additional functions that are available in Web Dispatch for processing sales orders include:

• Creati
Creating
ng and
and printi
printing
ng bills
bills of ladi
lading
ng and/o
and/orr manife
manifests.
sts. For
For infor
informat
mation
ion,, see “Generating
Bills of Lading
Lading and Manifests”
Manifests” on page 125
125..

• Exporting
Exporting manifest
manifest informati
information
on to a text
text file that can
can be
be e-mailed
e-mailed to ATS,
ATS, a Canadian
Canadian LTL
LTL
carrier. For more information, see “‘Pick
“‘Picking’
ing’ a Sales Order”
Order” on page 128
128..

• Viewing
iewing a list
list of any
any orders
orders that
that have
have not
not been
been success
successful
fully
ly alloca
allocated
ted,, and choo
choosin
sing
g to
release the orders without the HELD SHORT or HELD FORMAT lines. For more
information, see“Releas
see“Releasing
ing Orders with Held Lines”
Lines” on page 85
85..

• “Pickin
“Picking”
g” a sales
sales order
order from
from Web
Web Dispa
Dispatch
tch.. For
For infor
informat
mation
ion,, see
see “‘Picking’ a Sales Order”
on pag
pagee 128
128..

• Creatin
Creating
g a single
single deliv
delivery
ery to
to a custome
customerr from
from variou
variouss lines
lines of multip
multiple
le sales
sales order
orders.
s. For
For
more information, see “Creati
“Creating
ng Deliveries
Deliveries In RADIO BEACON”
BEACON” on page 130 130..

ALLOCATING AND RE-ALLOCATING SALES


ORDERS
If your warehouse uses manual allocation, you can allocate any sales orders displayed with the
status UNALLOCATED. You You may have business rules in your warehouse that determine when
orders should be allocated, and in what sequence, such as orders that belong to an “Alert”
category, orders for a particular customer, date required, etc. Or you may simply allocate all
orders as soon as they are downloaded and are displayed in Web Dispatch.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 6 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

If background allocation is not enabled in your implementation, you will need to manually re-
allocate orders that are in any of the following statuses: HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT,
HELD SHORT, HELD FORMAT.

If your system is configured for background allocation, you may not have to run the initial
allocation or any re-allocation. However, you may need to h andle orders that cannot be
successfully allocated automatically. If this is the case, see “Understanding Sales Order
Allocation
Allocat ion Results”
Results” on page
page 78
78 and
 and “Handling Unsuccessfully Allocated Sales Orders” on
 page 80
80..

You will also need to manually re-allocate any


a ny orders for which you want to change the default
allocation options, or assign new replenishment groups.
groups . Note that you can also use the
Reallocate Line action to simply allocate a single line on a sales order, or group of sales orders,
from the Product Report screen only.

When a sales order is allocated, the following occurs:

• Stock
Stock is reser
reserved
ved from
from pick
pick bins
bins for
for the requ
require
ired
d produc
products
ts (if they
they are availa
available
ble).
).

• Order
Order and
and lin
linee stat
statuse
usess are
are upda
updated
ted,, as des
descr
crib
ibed
ed in
in “Understanding Sales Order
Allocation
Allocation Results”
Results” on page
page 78
78..

• If the system
system is
is configu
configured
red to prin
printt these,
these, letdown
letdown ticke
tickets
ts are print
printed
ed for prod
products
ucts on
on orders
orders
held for replenishment.

• If a fully
fully integ
integrat
rated
ed shipp
shipping
ing syst
system
em is used,
used, and
and pre-r
pre-ratin
ating
g is confi
configur
gured
ed for
for your
your
SHIP implementation, orders are pre-rated and shipping costs, and selected carrier information
(if rate shopping is
shopping is enabled for the order), are passed back to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS.

In general, the process for allocating sales orders consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to (re-)allocate. For procedures for selecting orders, see
“General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44..

6 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

KIT Note: It is best not to group sales orders and work orders together in the same allocation
 batch. For information on allocating work orders, see “Allocating and Re-allocating
Work Orders”
Orders” on page 147
147..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Allocate to allocate the entire order, or Reallocate Line (if available), to re-allocate only
the selected product. The Allocation Settings window is displayed.

3. Option
ionally
lly, modify allocation options for
options  for the order(s) you are (re-)allocating. More
information about these options is provided in “Understanding and Modifying Sales Order
Allocation
Allocation Options”
Options” on page
page 70
70..

4. Perfo
Perform
rm the
the (re
(re-)
-)al
alloc
locat
atio
ion,
n, and
and refresh the display in
display in the Orders summary screen. For
 procedures, see “Genera
“Generall Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

5. Check the results of


results of the (re-)allocation, as described in “Understanding Sales Order
Allocation
Allocation Results”
Results” on page
page 78
78..

6. For orders
orders that are not moved into READY
READY TO WAWAVE status,
status, identify
identify an approp
appropriate
riate
method for handling them, as described in “Handling Unsuccessfully Allocated Sales
Orders”
Ord ers” on page
page 80
80..

7. If ne
neces
cessar
sary, unallocate previously
unallocate previously allocated orders. For procedures, see “Unallocating
Sales Orders”
Orders” on page
page 88
88..

8. If necessary
necessary,, re-allocat
re-allocatee orders
orders as many
many times
times as is
is necessary
necessary to place them into
into the
READY TO WAVE status.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 6 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING SALES ORDER ALLOCATION


OPTIONS

When you use the Allocate action, the Allocation Settings window is displayed.

The options in this screen are populated w ith default values that have been configured for your
implementation. However, you can modify any of the default s ettings for particular orders or
groups of orders, if necessary. All the options available in this screen are discussed in the
following sections:

• “Understanding and Modifying Sales Order Allocation Method Options” on page 71


71..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Location Allocation Option” on page 73


73..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Zones Allocation Options” on page 73


73..

• “Understanding and Modifying Attribute and Expiry Allocation Options” on page 74


74..

• “Understanding and Modifying Shorts Options” on page


page 75
75..

• “Understanding and Modifying Replenishment Options” on page


page 76
76..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Zone Sequence Option” on page 78


78..

7 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING SALES ORDER ALLOCATION


METHOD OPTIONS

The action of allocating causes R ADIO


ADIO BEACON WMS to search the warehouse’s inventory and
match it against the items (products) on the order. By default, R ADIO BEACON WMS allocates
 product in the following sequence:

1. In orde
orderr of packsi
packsize,
ze, from
from larg
largest
est to
to smalle
smallest;
st;

2. In order
order of
of date
date receiv
received,
ed, from
from olde
oldest
st to most
most recen
recentt (FIFO);
(FIFO);
ZONE
3. From zone
zone to zone in
in ascending
ascending alphabetical
alphabetical order (if multiple
multiple zones are used);
used);

4. From
From bin to bin
bin in ascen
ascendin
ding
g alphan
alphanumer
umerical
ical sequen
sequence.
ce.

However, your system may be configured to use a different default method of allocation, such
as strict receipt dates (packsizes are ignored), or strict packsizes (receipt dates are ignored).
Finally, your system will be configured to use FIFO or LIFO by default, and to allocate larger
or smaller packsizes first; however, you can override the latter defaults for individual orders.
The various options for optimizing the allocation process for specific orders are summarized in
the following table.

Option Use to...


Stock Method Specify one of the following allocation methods:
FIFO (First In First Out) — Stock will be allocated in sequence by the
date it was received, with oldest stock allocated first.
LIFO (Last In Last Out) — Stock will be allocated in sequence by the
date it was received, with newest stock allocated first.
Deplete Smaller If not enough stock is available in the most efficient standard
Packsize  packsizes, enable this option to allow smaller packsizes to be allocated
instead.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 7 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Allocate To Specify the quantity to allocate. The host system can download two
values to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS:

• “Quanti
“Quantity
ty Orde
Ordered
red”” – the ordere
ordered
d quan
quantity
tity is the
the amou
amount
nt that the
customer actually ordered.

• “Quantity to
to pi
pick” –  the
 the quantity to pick is how many the host
system would like (or expects) R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS to pick.
Typically, this is the quantity that R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS allocates.

In some situations a host system requests R ADIO


ADIO BEACON WMS to
 pick what it believes R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS has in stock when the
order was downloaded to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON. Since additional stock may
 be received in the meantime, selecting the “Quantity Ordered” instead
allows R ADIO
ADIO BEACON to allocate the amount that the customer
actually wants, thus avoiding a back order situation.
If some of the items have been picked previously and this is now the
 backorder, then selecting the “Quantity Ordered” could result in too
many items being picked.
Therefore, when you allocate in R ADIO
ADIO BEACON, you should specify
the quantity to allocate.
Quantity Ordered — Allocate the amount that the customer ordered.

Quantity to Pick —Allocate the quantity that the host system has


specified. If you know that this is a back order, select this option to
 prevent extra quantities being allocated.
Reserve Minimum If a product has a minimum quantity defined in the database that must
 be maintained in the warehouse, enable this option to prevent stock
from being allocated from the reserved quantity.
Fair Share If you are allocating a group of orders destined to several stores for the
same customer, and not enough inventory is available to fill the lines
on all the orders, enable this option to allocate the avail able stock to all
of the orders on a pro-rated basis. That is, the quantity allocated to
each order will be calculated as a percentage of the total quantity that
each order requires.

7 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Fifty Rule If a maximum percentage that may be allocated from a D-N-R bin is
specified in your system configuration, enable this option to prevent
any stock that exceeds this percentage from being all ocated from a bin.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE LOCATION ALLOCATION


OPTION

If your system supports multiple physical lo cations, you can use the Location option to specify
from which location(s) stock should be allocated.

Location If R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS is managing multiple locations, specify the
LOC  physical location(s) from which stock may be allocated and
replenished, and the order(s) shipped. If the field is left blank, all
locations will be included.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE ZONES ALLOCATION OPTIONS

ZONE If your system supports multiple zones, you can specify the zones which should be included
and/or excluded from sales order allocation.

Include Zones Specify zones from which product may be allocated, by entering
each desired zone, or leave blank to include all zones. For example,
entering ABC will result in R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS searching only
zones A, B, and C for available product. Product may exist outside
of those defined zones, but R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS will not include
those areas in its search for products. The allocation will proceed in
alphabetical zone sequence, regardless of the order of letters you
specify, unless you also select the By Zone Sequence option (see
“Understanding and Modifying the Zone Sequence Option” on
 page 78
78).
).
Exclude Zones Specify zones from which product must not be allocated.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 7 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING ATTRIBUTE AND EXPIRY


ALLOCATION OPTIONS

If your warehouse uses expiry dates, lots, or other non-unique attributes, sales orders may
 ATT
 ATT specify how products with attribute numbers, or specific expiry dates, should be handled. If the
orders do not specify this information, or if you want to override the settings included in the
orders, you can use the following options to control how products with these attributes should
 be allocated.

Option Use to...


Attribute and Expiry Specify whether products with different non-unique attribute
Allocation values, expiry dates, and/or multiple packsizes can be mixed in
the same order. Select one of the following options:
Download Value — Use the settings specified in each order.

Single Attribute Expiry — Products with different attribute


values, expiry dates, or packsizes can not be mixed in an order.
Multi Attribute/Expiry — Products with different attribute values
and/or expiry dates can be mixed in an order, but only a single
 packsize may be picked for an order.
order.
Multi-Attribute, Unit-Split —
 — Products with different attribute
values, expiry dates, and/or packsizes may be mixed in an order.
# Days to Expiry Exclude products from being allocated that will expire within a
certain number of days. Enter the minimum number of days
 before the expiry date. For example, if you enter 365, this will
 prevent any products that expire in less than 365 days from being
allocated to the order(s). 0 indicates that no minimum applies and
that products with any expiry date can be included for allocation.

7 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING SHORTS OPTIONS

If all lines in a sales order or group of sales orders cannot be filled because the necessary stock
is not available anywhere in the warehouse — that is, the orders are short 
are  short  —
 — you can select one
of several ways of handling these orders:

Option Use to...


100% Fill Leave the order unallocated. The order will remain in
UNALLOCATED status and no stock will be reserved for fillable
lines.
Hold for Shorts Reserve stock for fillable lines, and hold the order until missing items
are received and moved into bins in the warehouse. Stock will be
allocated for fillable lines, and the order will be given the status
HELD SHORT.
Auto Short Non- Release the order for picking and shipping, without any non-stock
Stocks items, such as promotional materials, that are not available. Stock will
 be allocated for fillable lines, and the order will be given the status
READY TO WAVE.
Auto Short All Release the order for picking and shipping, without the missing items.
Stock will be allocated for fillable lines, non-fillable lines will be
 shorted , and the order will be given the status READY TO WA WAVE.
Pickers will not be directed to pick short products. Depending on your
configuration, your host system or R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS will
automatically issue a back order for missing items, or your host
system will cancel the short lines in the order will be cancelled.
 Note: You
You cannot “short” orders that contain the Ship Complete flag
set to “Y” (see under Handling Codes in the Packslip Report screen).
Assume Infinite Release the order for picking and shipping, and allow the pickers to
Stock short picks if necessary. Stock will be allocated from pick bins for
fillable lines, short stock will be allocated from the system location
INFINITE, and the t he order will be given the status READY TO WAWAVE.
Pickers will not be directed to pick the products allocated from the
INFINITE location, but will have to manually handle those line items.
 Note: Only use this option if R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS is not managing
your inventory.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 7 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING REPLENISHMENT OPTIONS

When R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS attempts to allocate a sales order, it will reserve the stock for as
many lines on the order as possible. If all lines cannot be filled because the necessary stock is
not in pick bins in the requested packsizes (in the zones that you have included for allocation),
 but product is available elsewhere in the warehouse to fill these lines, you
you can select one of two
ways of handling these orders:

Option Use to...


Hold for Reserve stock for fillable lines, and hold the order until missing
Replenishment stock is replenished to the appropriate pick bins, in the
appropriate packsizes. Fillable lines will be allocated, the order
will be given the s tatus HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT,
REPLEN ISHMENT, and a
replenishment request will be issued for the required stock. If
your system is configured to print letdown tickets, they will
automatically be printed.
Short if not Ready Release the order for picking and shipping, without the items that
could have been replenished. Fillable lines will be allocated, non-
fillable lines will be shorted and the order will be placed into
READY TO WA WAVE status. Pickers
Pi ckers will not be directed to pick
missing products.
 Note: If you select this option, you must also select the Auto
Short or Assume Infinite Stock option for short orders (see
“Understanding and Modifying Shorts Options” on page page 75
75).
).
Other Shorts options are incompatible and will cause the order to
 be HELD FORMAT
FORMAT.

7 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

If you choose to hold sales orders for replenishment, you can also specify the following
options:

Option Use to...


Include Zones for SO Specify zones (separate zones for sales order and for kitt ing) from
ZONE which product may be replenished, by entering each desired zone,
or leave blank to include all zones. For example, entering ABC
will result in R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS searching only zones A, B,
and C for available product. Product may exist outside of those
defined zones, but R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS will not include those
areas in its search for products. The allocation will proceed in
alphabetical zone sequence, regardless of the order of letters you
specify, unless you also select the By Zone Sequence option (see
“Understanding and Modifying the Zone Sequence Option” on
 page 78
78).
).
Replenishment Group Assign a name to the group of replenishment requests that will be
issued for this group of orders. This name appears in t he Letdown
Stock replenishment function on the handheld (for information,
see “Letting Down Stock” in
Stock” in Using RADIO BEACON Handheld
 Functions).
 Functions). By using a meaningful name, you can indicate to
replenishers the urgency or priority of the replenishment request,
or a destination to which the stock should be brought. For
example, assigning a date or time stamp to the replenishment
group could indicate the appropriate sequence in which
warehouse staff should replenish stock.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 7 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE ZONE SEQUENCE OPTION

For allocation and replenishment, you can use the following option to control exactly how
 product is allocated from zone to zone by using the following option:

Option Use to...


By Zone Sequence Allocate and replenish from zone to zone in exact sequence you
ZONE specify in the Include Zone and Include Zones for
Replenishment fields. For example, if you specify ACB as
include zones, and you select this option, the allocation and
replenishment will use this sequence, rather than the normal ABC
alphabetical sequence.

UNDERSTANDING SALES ORDER ALLOCATION RESULTS

When you are returned to the Orders summary screen, and have refreshed it, the orders you
have attempted to allocate will show their new statuses.

The following table summarizes the possible allocation results for sales orders.

Status Explanation
READ
READY
Y TO
TO WA
WAVE The
The ord
order
er(s
(s)) hav
havee eit
eithe
herr bee
been
n com
compl
plete
etely
ly fille
filled
d fro
fromm pro
produ
duct
ct in
 pickable bins, or have been allowed to be shipped short. They are
now ready to be waved in Web Dispatch (or
Dispatch (or by pickers if allowed,
from the handheld); for procedures for waving in Web Dispatch,
see “W
“Waving
aving and Re-waving Orders” on page 99 99..
Orders marked READ Y TO WAVE WAVE with a wave number of 990
indicate that they have been successfully allocated, but are
waiting for other orders that have been assigned the same
consolidation number to be allocated. S uch orders cannot be pre-
rated or waved in the normal fashion until all orders with the
same consolidation number have been successfully allocated. If
you need to release these orders for picking, you need to unwave
them (see “Unwavi
“Unwavingng Orders” on page 11
1111) and then re-wave
them.

7 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Status Explanation
HELD FOR The order(s) contain lines that require products that are not
REPLENISHMENT available in pick bins in the packsizes required, in the zones you
specified during allocation. Lines that can be filled are allocated
and stock is reserved for them; however, for lines that require
 product from elsewhere in the warehouse, staff must first
replenish the required products, or you must take alternative
measures for the order(s). If your system is configured to do so,
letdown tickets are automatically printed. For more information
on handling orders in this status, see “Handling Short Orders” on
 page 81
81..
HELD SH
SHORT
ORT The or
order(s) contai
tain lin
linees th
that re
require pr
products th
that ar
are cu
currently
unavailable. Lines that can be filled are allocated and stock is
reserved for them; however, for lines that require unavailable
 product, stock must be received into inventory, or you must take
alternate measures. For more information on handling orders in
this status, see “Handli
“Handling
ng Short Orders”
Orders” on page 81
81..
UNAL
UNALLO
LOCA
CATE
TED
D The
The ord
order
er(s
(s)) con
conta
tain
in line
liness tha
thatt req
requi
uire
re prod
produc
ucts
ts that
that are
are cur
curre
rent
ntly
ly
unavailable, and 100% fill was selected during the allocation. No
lines are allocated and no stock is reserved for the order(s). For
lines that require unavailable product, stock must be received into
inventory before the order(s) can be successfully allocated.
WAITI
AITING
NG - SW
SWOG
OG The
The orde
order(
r(s)
s) has
has bee
been
n mark
marked
ed to
to be ship
shippe
ped
d with
with oth
other
er goo
goods
ds..
Lines that can be filled are allocated and stock is reserved for
them. However, other orders for the same customer and shipping
address that are not marked to be shipped with other goods must
 be successfully allocated before the order can be marked READY
TO WA
WAVE. For more information on handling orders in i n this
status, see “Handling Waiting
Waiting - SWOG Orders” on page 87 87..
SUSPENDED There is so
some pr
problem in
in th
the or
order(s) th
that ne
needs fu
further
investigation. For more information on handling orders in this
status, see “Handli
“Handling
ng Orders with Errors”
Errors” on page 8282..

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 7 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Status Explanation
HELD
HELD FORM
FORMA
AT The
The ord
order
er((s) con
contain
tain line
liness tha
thatt req
requi
uire
re prod
produc
ucts
ts avai
availa
labl
blee in
in th
the
warehouse; however, the product could not be allocated correctly
due to an incompatibility with the order, allocation, or
replenishment options. For more information on handling orders
in this status, see “Handli
“Handling ng Held Format Orders”
Orders” on page 83 83..
WAIT
AIT - PRE-R
PRE-RA
ATE If a ful
fully
ly integ
integra
rated
ted ship
shippi
ping
ng syste
system
m is
is used
used,, and
and pre-
pre-ra
ratin
ting
g is
is
SHIP required for the order(s), the order is w aiting for the shipping
system to pre-rate it, or there has been an error in pre-rating. For
more information on handling orders in this status, see “Handling
Orderss with Errors”
Order Errors” on page
page 82
82..

HANDLING UNSUCCESSFULLY ALLOCATED SALES ORDERS

If an order or group of orders is al located successfully, the orders appear in Web Dispatch with
the status of READY TO WA WAVE, and can be rel eased for picking. If an order appears with any
other status, the allocation has not been successful, and you and/or other warehouse staff need
to rectify the situation in a way that will allow the order to be re-allocated successfully
(regardless of whether you perform the re-allocation manually or the system does it
automatically). The following sections discuss how to handle the different types of orders that
cannot be fully allocated:

• “Handling
“Handling Short Orders”
Orders” on page
page 81
81..

• “Handling
“Handling Orders with Errors”
Errors” on page 82
82..

• “Handling
“Handling Held Format Orders”
Orders” on page 83
83..

• “Releasing
“Releasing Orders with Held
Held Lines” on page 85

• “Handling Wait
Wait Pre-Rate Orders” on page 87
87..

• “Handling Waiting
Waiting - SWOG Orders” on page 87
87..

8 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

HANDLING SHORT ORDERS

For orders that are held because some lines contain unavailable products — orders in
UNALLOCATED,
UNALLOCATED, HELD FOR F OR REPLENISHMENT, HELD SHORT — there a re several
options for handling these:

• Wait until
until produc
products
ts have
have been repleni
replenishe
shed
d or receive
received.
d. For order
orderss held for
for replenis
replenishme
hment,
nt,
this is probably the most efficient method for handling these orders, as replenishing can
often be performed, and the products made available for picking, in the same day. For
orders held short that are not urgent or of high priority, and you know that new stock is to
arrive shortly, this is also a reasonable approach.

If you need to manually re-allocate such orders, you may wish to run various inventory or
receiving reports to check for inventory updates that affect these orders. For held
hel d for
replenishment orders, you can run the Replenishment Report (for
Report  (for information, see
“Replenishmen
“Reple nishmentt Report” on page 244
244)) that shows all outstanding replenishment requests;
once these have been cleared, you will know that the products for the held orders have
 been replenished.

For held short orders, reports that may be useful to you include the Rush Items Report,
Short Products Report and Product Inventory Report may be useful. For information on all
of these, see Chapter 7, “Genera
“Generating
ting Reports”
Reports” on page 201
201..

• Release
Release an
an order
order as a “Pack
“Pack & Hold
Hold”” order
order.. This opti
option
on may
may be used
used for
for very
very large
large order
orderss
for which you want to begin the picking process and reserve the stock by physically
removing it from the bins. For more information on this option, see “Packing and Holding
Orders” on page
page 109
109..

• Release
Release stoc
stock
k by unalloc
unallocatin
atingg other
other orders.
orders. For
For order
orderss held short
short that
that are urgen
urgent,
t, you
you may
wish to free up stock from lower
l ower priority orders by unallocating them.
unallocating them. For more
information on unallocating orders, see “Unallo
“Unallocating
cating Sales
Sales Orders” on page 8888..

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 8 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• For order
orderss held short
short and
and held for
for reple
replenish
nishmen
ment,t, releas
releasee the order
order(s)
(s) witho
without
ut the
the missing
missing
 products or components, if this is an acceptable option for your customers. To do this,
manually re-allocate the order(s), and select the Short if Not Ready option for orders held
for replenishment, and the Auto Short All option for orders held short. This will “pre-
short” the missing
missi ng lines, and plac e the order(s) in READY TO WAVE WAVE status. When the
orders are waved, pickers will simply not be directed to pick the missing lines. Depending
on your configuration, back orders may automatically be generated for the missing
 products.

You can also release the orders without the HELD SHORT lines using the Exception
report. For information, see, “Releas
“Releasing
ing Orders with Held Lines”
Lines” on page 85
85..

Note: You cannot short orders that contain the Ship Complete flag set to “Y” (see under
Handling Codes in the Packslip Report screen).

• For
For orde
orders
rs held
held shor
shortt onl
onlyy, if
if R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS is not tracking the inventory, release
the order to pickers, and allow the pickers to manually find the missing stock in the
warehouse, or use another manual procedure for handling the order. To do this, manually
re-allocate the order, and select the Short if Not Ready and Assume Infinite Stock
options. This will allocate the short lines from a virtual location called INFINITE and
 place the order in READY TO WA WAVE status. When the order is waved, pickers will simply
not be directed to pick the
t he missing lines. You may also want to print pick tic kets or pre-
 packslips when waving such orders, so that pickers will know which items have been
allocated from the INFINITE location (see “Understanding and Modifying Wave Label
Printing
Printing Options”
Options” on page 105 105 for
 for more information on these label types).

HANDLING ORDERS WITH ERRORS

An order marked SUSPENDED indicates that there is something amiss with the order itself,
such as a negative quantity ordered. The error that caused the order to be suspended is often
noted in the Packslip Report. To handle these orders, you must first edit the field(s) in
field(s) in the order
that caused the problem (for information, see “Editing Sales, Work, Packaging and Transfer
Sales Orders”
Orders” on
on page 260
260),
), unsuspend them
unsuspend them (for more information, see “Unsuspending
Orders”” on page
Orders page 11
119
9), and if necessary,
nece ssary, re-allocate them manually.

8 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

HANDLING HELD FORMAT ORDERS

The status of HELD FORMAT indicates that there is stock somewhere in the system for
 products required for the order, but that the stock cannot be allocated, for various reasons,
including:

• The on-h
on-hand
and stock
stock is in
in a packsize
packsize that
that does
does not match
match the
the packsiz
packsizee specifi
specified
ed in the
the order
order..

• The on-h
on-hand
and stoc
stock
k is in the
the proces
processs of being
being move
moved
d or reple
replenish
nished
ed and
and is in a tempo
temporar
rary
y
system location, such as TRANSIT or
TRANSIT or REPLENIS,
REPLENIS, where it cannot be accessed until it is
 put away to pick bins.

• If you
you handle
handle expir
expiry-d
y-date
ated
d produc
product,
t, the on-h
on-hand
and stock
stock will
will expire
expire soone
soonerr than allow
allowed
ed by
the order(s).

 ATT • If you
you handle
handle produ
products
cts with
with attribu
attributes
tes such
such as lot or seri
serial
al number
numbers,
s, the on-h
on-hand
and stock
stock uses
uses
attributes that do not match the attributes required in the order.

ZONE • If you
you are using
using multiple
multiple zones,
zones, the
the on-han
on-hand
d stock
stock is in a zone
zone that
that was
was not inclu
included
ded for
for
allocation or replenishment when the allocation was run.

LOC • If you
you are using
using mult
multiple
iple ware
warehou
houses
ses or
or locatio
locations,
ns, the
the on-ha
on-hand
nd stock
stock is
is in the wron
wrong
g
warehouse or location.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 8 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The line details in the Packslip Report show each bin from which the system attempted to
allocate or replenish the wrong format product and the reason the product could not be
successfully allocated.

The type of allocation that was attempted: pick or


replenishment. PICK indicates that the system
The quantity that
tried to allocate the product from a pick bin. REPL
was not able to be
indicates that the system tried to generate a
allocated or
replenishment request from a pick or overstock
replenished.
bin.

The bin from which the The reason for which


system attempted to allocate the allocation or
or replenish the product. replenishment failed.

Once you have identified the nature of the problem, you can do any of the follow ing before the
order is re-allocated:

• Wait until
until produ
products
cts have
have been
been replen
replenishe
ished
d or put away
away to their
their final
final pick
pick bin homes
homes.. If you
need to manually re-allocate such
s uch orders, you may wish to run various inventory reports to
check for inventory updates that affect these orders. You can run the Product Report (for
more information, see “Managi
“Managingng Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving” on page 221 221),
), which shows
all current locations for the product, including TRANSIT, REPLENIS, and other
temporary locations; once the product has been cleared from those l ocations and moved to
 pick bins, the order may be re-allocated.

• Release
Release stock
stock by unall
unalloca
ocatin
ting
g other
other orders.
orders. For
For order
orderss held forma
formatt that are
are urgen
urgent,
t, you
you
may wish to free up stock from lower priority orders, or other orders that were not fully
allocated, by unallocating them.
unallocating them. For more information on unallocating orders, see
“Unallocating
“Unallo cating Sales
Sales Orders” on page 88
88..

8 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• Release
Release the
the order
orderss without
without the
the HELD
HELD FORMA
FORMAT T lines,
lines, using
using the
the Excepti
Exception
on repor
report.
t. For
For
information, see, “Releasi
“Releasing
ng Orders with Held Lines”
Lines” on page 85
85..

• Manual
Manually
ly re-all
re-allocat
ocatee the orders
orders with
with differ
different
ent,, less restri
restrictiv
ctivee allocati
allocation
on option
options.
s. These
These
include:

• Enabling the Deplete Smaller Packsize option, which will allow other packsizes to
 be allocated to fill the order.
ZONE
• Includ
Including
ing additio
additional
nal zones
zones for
for allocat
allocation
ion and/or
and/or replen
replenishm
ishment
ent..

• Edit
Edit the orde
orderr itself,
itself, if
if you have
have the
the permiss
permission
ionss to do so.
so. If the
the order
order has
has specifi
specified
ed
allocation options that are too restrictive, in terms of zones, or packsizes, edit these fields
in the order to make them less restrictive. For example, if the customer will accept
alternate packsizes, simply specify a packsize of 1, and the system may allocate whatever
 packsize it finds to fill the line. To edit order lines, see “Editing Sales/Wo
Sales/Work/Transfer/
rk/Transfer/
Packaging
Packagi ng Order Line Details”
Details” on page 262
262.. i

RELEASING ORDERS WITH HELD LINES

At any time, you can run an Exception report that displays all lines in sales orders that are in
HELD SHORT and HELD FORMAT FORMAT status (or ASMBL-HELD SHORT for work orders). It
indicates to the dispatcher which lines on orders could not be allocated successfully. From this
report, you can release orders without missing products, to be shipped short.
> To release orders with ‘Held’ lines:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the
the Picking
Picking tab
tab to displ
display
ay the
the Picking
Picking Repo
Reports
rts scre
screen.
en.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 8 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Next to the Exception Report selection click Go.

4. Orders with lines


lines in HELD SHORT
SHORT and HELD FORMAT
FORMAT status
status is displayed.
displayed.

5. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to release with shorted lines. For procedures for selecting
orders, see “Genera
“Generall Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44..

6. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Release.

7. Opti
Optio
onall
nally
y ent
enter
er a Handle, and click Release.

Once the line(s) are released, the order(s) will be updated to HELD RELPLENISH or READY
TO WA
WAVE, depending on the status of the fillable lines
li nes on the order. The lines that were
released in the Exception report are shorted on the order. Depending on your configuration,
 back orders may automatically be generated for the missing products.

8 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

HANDLING WAIT PRE-RATE ORDERS

An order marked WAIT PRE-RATE


PRE-RATE indicates that the shipping system has encountered an
SHIP error in attempting to pre-rate the
t he order. To
To try to identify the problem, you can check your
shipping system, view the Shipping Errors Report (see
Report  (see “Shippi
“Shipping
ng Errors
Errors Report” on page 216
216),
),
or view the log for
log for the order (see “Gener
“Generating
ating the Log Reports”
Reports” on page 314
314).
). Most often, this
error occurs because weights have not been recorded for the products in the order. In this
situation, you can unallocate the
unallocate the orders (see “Unallo
“Unallocating
cating Sales
Sales Orders” on page 88
882),
2), enter
weights for the products in the order by editing the appropriate lines in the order (or, more
 permanently, by editing the products themselves — for more information, see “Maintaining
Products”
Produc ts” on page 266
266),
), and then re-allocate the orders.

Alternatively, you can skip pre-rating by applying the Skip Pre-Rating option from the Ship
Settings window, which will move the order(s) into READY TO WAVE WAVE status automatically,
so that they can be waved immediately. The procedure for skipping pre-rating is described
 below.

> To skip pre-rating for an order or group of orders:

1. Select the order(s) for


order(s)  for which you want to skip pre-rating. For procedures for selecting
orders, see “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select Ship.
The Ship Settings window is displayed.

3. Under the Immediate Action for Orders options, enable Skip Pre-Rating.

4. Click Submit, and refresh the display in


display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444.. When all orders have been
 processed, they should be updated with the status of READY TO WA WAVE.

HANDLING WAITING - SWOG ORDERS

An order marked WAITING


WAITING - SWOG indicates that the order has been marked to be shipped
SHIP with other goods (that is, the ShipwOther  field
 field is set to “Y”; see under Handling Codes in the
Packslip Report screen). Normally, you do not need to take any action for these orders; as soon
as another order for the same customer and shipping address that is not marked to be shipped
with other goods is all ocated, the WAITING
WAITING - SWOG order will wi ll automatically be moved into
READY TO WAVE status.

A LL OC A TI N G A N D R E -A LL OC A TI N G S AL E S O R DE R S 8 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

However, if the order has been waiting too long and no other orders can be allocated for the
customer, you can release the order for waving by applying the Release for Ready-Wave
option from the Ship Settings window. This will reset the ShipwOther  field
 field to “N”, and move
the order(s) into READY TO WA WAVE status, so
s o that they can be waved immediately. The
 procedure for releasing WAITING
WAITING - SWOG orders is described below.

> To release an order or group of orders that were held to be s hipped with other goods:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to release. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the
the screen
screen you are using,
using, and
and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu, select Ship.
The Ship Settings window is displayed.

3. Under the Immediate Action for Orders options, enable Release for Ready-Wave.

4. Click Submit, and refresh the display in


display in the Orders summary screen. For procedures, see
“General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 4444.. When all orders have been
 processed, they should appear in READY TO WA WAVE status.

UNALLOCATING SALES ORDERS


You most typically use the Unallocate action to free up stock from allocated or held orders so
that it can be re-allocated to higher priority orders that were hel d because of missing stock. You
You
may also need to unallocate an order if a customer requests changes to the order since it was
allocated, especially if those changes include cancelling some line items.

You may also unallocate held orders if you need to edit the orders themselves before re-
allocation, or to re-allocate with different options. Although this step is not necessary before re-
allocation of such orders, if you need to re-allocate multiple orders, and want to be sure to
optimize the re-allocation, unallocating all of them first may produce better results.

You can unallocate orders in any of the following status es: READY TO WAVE, HELD FOR
F OR
REPLENISHMENT, HELD SHORT, HELD FORMAT, WAITING - SWOG, WAIT PRE-
RATE.

8 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

When you unallocate orders, the following occurs:

• Stoc
Stock
k tha
thatt was
was res
reser
erve
ved
d is unre
unrese
serv
rved
ed..

• Orders
Orders and lines
lines are
are updated
updated with the status
status UNALL
UNALLOCA
OCATED.
TED.

Note: Unallocating orders that belong to replenishment groups does not clear the
replenishment groups for those orders. If you want to change the replenishment group
for orders, you must apply a new group name to them when you re-allocate.
re-al locate.

Note: Orders with the status of SUSPENDED cannot be unallocated. They must be
unsuspended before they can be processed further; for more information, see
“Unsuspending
“Unsusp ending Orders”
Orders” on page 119
119..

> To unallocate an order or group of sales orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to unallocate. For procedures for selecting orders, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Unallocate. The Unallocate Settings window is displayed.

3. Opti
Optio
onall
nallyy en
enter
ter a Handle, and click Submit, and refresh the display in
display in the Orders
summary screen. For procedures, see “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on
 page 44
44.. When all orders have been processed, they should be updated with the status of
UNALLOCATED.

4. Re-allocate
Re-allocate the
the orders
orders when
when approp
appropriate,
riate, by following
following the instruct
instructions
ions in “Allocating and
Re-allocating
Re-allocating Sales
Sales Orders” on page 67
67..

U NA LL OC AT IN G S AL ES O RD ER S 8 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING SHIPPING


OPTIONS
The default shipping options and actions defined for an order are determ ined by the end-of-line
SHIP configuration specified for the carrier sel ected for the order, or for the order itself. The shipping
options available in Web Dispatch are of two types:

• Options
Options that
that allow
allow you to
to change
change the
the shippin
shipping
g data and
and proce
processes
sses pre-
pre-def
define
ined
d for the
the order
order
before they are picked and processed in shipping; the second consist of actions that
actually serve to process the order by performing specific “shipping” functions on-the-fly.
This set of options is described here.

• Opt
Option
ions ar
are des
desccribe
ibed in
in “Perfor
“Performing
ming Shipping Actions”
Actions” on page 11112
2 . Other options
include pre-rating
include pre-rating,, skipping pre-rating,
pre-rating , and releasing orders held to be shipped with other
goods;
goods; these options are described in “Pre-ra
“Pre-rating
ting Orders”
Orders” on page 98
98,, “Handling Wait Pre-
Rate Orders”
Orders” on page
page 87
87,, and “Handling Waiting
Waiting - SWOG Orders” on page 87 87,,
respectively.

The order shipping options that you can modify include method of shipping, label printing,
truck routes, order consolidation, and carton check-in options defined for orders. If you want to
modify these options, you can do so at any point in an order’s life cycle, although making
changes before the orders are waved out will require fewer additional changes or processes.
When you modify these options, an order is updated with the values you have specified, but the
 process step for the order does not change unless you specify a different end-of-line
configuration, or a different carrier with a different end-of-line configuration defined for it.

9 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To modify shipping options for an order or group of orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s) you want to modify. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select Ship.
The Ship Settings window is displayed.

3. Modi
Modify
fy any
any of
of the
the foll
followi
owing
ng set
settin
tings:
gs:

• To mod
modif
ify
y gen
gener
eral
al ship
shippin
ping
g set
settin
tings
gs,, see
see “Understanding and Modifying Shipping
Method Options
Options”” on page 92
92..

• To mod
modif
ify
y lab
label
el form
format
ats,
s, see
see “Understanding and Modifying Label Printing Options”
on pa
page
ge 93
93..

• To mod
modif
ify
y ord
order
er conso
consolid
lidat
atio
ion
n opt
optio
ions,
ns, see “Understanding and Modifying Shipment
Consolidatio
Consolidationn Options” on page 95
95..

U N DE RS T AN D IN G A ND M OD I FY I NG S H IP P IN G O P TI O NS 9 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• To mod
modif
ify
y tru
truck
ck rout
routee opt
optio
ions
ns,, see
see “Understanding and Modifying Truck Route
Options”” on page 94
Options 94..

• To modify RADIO
   BEACON WMS shipping function options, see “Understanding and
Modifying
Modifying Carton Check-In
Check-In Options”
Options” on page 97
97..

4. Click Submit. The order(s) will be updated with the settings you specified.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING SHIPPING METHOD OPTIONS

You can change the general shipping settings for orders at any time. However, keep in mind
that you may need to change other shipping options as well. If you change a carrier or ship
options once orders have been picked, you may need to have cartons re-rated and manifested.

Option Use to...


Carrier Service Specify or change the carrier or carrier service by which the order
will be shipped. Select the appropriate carrier/service from the
drop-down list. The options available are determined by your
configuration.
Change Payment Specify or change the payment method for the shipment. Select
Method from the following default options:
Prepaid
Bill Recipient (On Account)
Consignee/Collect
Third-Party
Ship Options Specify or change the shipment option used for the order. Select
the appropriate option from the drop-down list. The options
available are determined by your configuration.

9 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


End of Line Apply the settings defined for one of the following end-of-line
configurations to the order (for information, see “Understanding
Process Flags” on page
page 59
59):
):
Default — The settings defined for the default end-of line
configuration.
1-Courier  —
 — The settings defined for shipments sent via couriers
that define a shipment as being made up of a single carton.
M-Courier  —
 — The settings defined for shipments s ent via couriers
that define a shipment as being made up of multiple cartons.
LTL Truck — The settings defined for shipments sent via LTL
LTL
carriers.
Pickup — The settings defined for orders that are picked up at
the warehouse.
Other  —
 — The settings defined for shipments sent via any other
method.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING LABEL PRINTING OPTIONS

Picking/shipping and
Picking/shipping  and carton contents label formats
label formats are normally specified in the settings for the
order’s carrier or in the order itself.
it self. However, you can override the format for picking/shipping
labels, carrier-compliant picking/shipping labels, or carton contents labels to be printed for an
order or group of orders, by using the following options:

Option Use to...


Customer Label Assign the format of the customer-compliant picking/shipping
label(s) to be printed for the orders during waving (listed as the
Customer Label on the Wave Settings window; see
“Understanding and Modifying Wave Options” on page 101 101).
).
Select the appropriate format from the drop-down list. The
options available are determined by your configuration.
 Note: Be sure to set this option before waving the order(s).

U N DE RS T AN D IN G A ND M OD I FY I NG S H IP P IN G O P TI O NS 9 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Carrier Label Assign the format of the carrier-compliant picking/shipping
label(s) to be printed for the orders during waving (listed as the
Customer Label on the Wave Settings window). If, for example,
you have changed the carrier for the order, you will want to select
another carrier-compliant label. Select the appropriate format
from the drop-down list. The options available are determined by
your configuration.
 Note: Be sure to set this option before waving the order(s).
Carton Contents Label Assign the format of the carton contents label(s) printed for the
orders after picking. Select the appropriate format from the drop-
down list. The options available are determined by your
configuration.
 Note: Be sure to set this option before the point at which these
labels are to be printed, as determined by your end-of-line
settings for the order(s).

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING TRUCK ROUTE OPTIONS

If you manage your own fleet of trucks, you can assign a truck
t ruck route and truck stop to orders.
 Normally, these are assigned when the orders are created, but if they have not
not been assigned, or
if you need to modify the settings, you can do so with the following options.

Option Use to...


Truck Route Assign or modify the truck route for an order or group of orders.
Enter the identifier for the truck route in the field.
Truck Stop Assign or modify the truck stop for an order or group of orders.
Enter the identifier for the truck stop in the field.

9 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING SHIPMENT CONSOLIDATION


OPTIONS

Often, you may wish to combine orders that are to be shipped to the same destination by the
same carrier at the same time into a single shipment, to take advantage of reduced shipping
costs. Your integrated shipping system may assign BOL/manifest or consolidation numbers to
such orders, when they are rated
rat ed and manifested. Alternatively, your host system may apply
consolidation numbers to the orders when they are downloaded to R ADIO BEACON WMS.

However, if you want to use Web


Web Dispatch to assign BOL/manifest and consolidation numbers
to orders, you can do so by using the Shipping Controls options in the Ship Settings window.
If an order has an end-of-line configuration applied to it that requires that a bill of lading
number be assigned to it, you must  assign
 assign a number to it, either by using the BOL options on
the Ship action window or by generating a BOL/manifest in
BOL/manifest  in Web Dispatch (to generate a bill of
lading from Web Dispatch, see “Generating Bills of Lading and Manifests” on page 125 125).
).

When you flag orders for consolidation, they are still picked as separate orders, but are treated
as a single shipment by the shipping system, and must be shipped together. To
To search for orders
that may be potentially consolidated, you can run the Order Consolidation Opportunities
Report,
Report, which shows all customers with
wit h multiple outstanding orders (for more information, see
“Order Consolidation Opportunities Report” on page 215 215).
).

Note: You can also consolidate orders by actually combining them into a single order by
using the Consolidate if Possible option when waving. For more information, see
“Consolidatin
“Cons olidating
g Orders” on page 109
109..

You can apply these options at


a t any time before the orders are
ar e to be processed by a shipping
system. However, if you mark orders for consolidation before they are allocated, orders that are
marked as READY TO WA WAVE may be held from waving if any other orders with which they th ey
are to be consolidated cannot be successfully allocated. They will be assigned a wave number
of 990 and can not be waved normally; if you need to wave and pick such orders, you must
unwave the order(s), which will
wil l remove the 990 wave number, before waving the order. For
information, see “Unwav
“Unwaving
ing Orders” on page 11111
1.

U N DE RS T AN D IN G A ND M OD I FY I NG S H IP P IN G O P TI O NS 9 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Note: Be sure to apply these options only to orders with the same ship-to address.

Option Use to...


Assign Next BOL Assign BOL/manifest or shipment consolidation numbers to
Number  orders, by having the system apply the next available number.
The number will consist of your manufacturing ID (or 999999 if
you do not use one) and/or a sequential number. Select from one
of the following options:
Assign BOL — Assigns the next available bill of lading/manifest
(pickup) number in the system to the order(s). If you apply this
option to multiple orders, each will be assigned the same number.
Assign Consolidation — Assigns the next available
consolidation number in the system to the order(s). If you apply
this option to multiple orders, each will be assigned the same
number.
Assign to both — Assigns the next available number to both the
BOL/manifest (pickup) number and the consolidation number.
That is, the BOL and consolidation numbers will be the same. If
you apply this option to multiple orders, each will be a ssigned the
same numbers.
Consolidation Number  Assign a shipment consolidation number to orders, by specifying
the number. If you apply this option to multiple orders, each will
 be assigned the same number. If the orders have not yet been
allocated, successfully allocated orders will be held in READY
TO WA
WAVE status (with
(wit h a wave number of 990), and cannot be
waved until all other orders with the same consolidation number
have been successfully allocated. (To
(To wave and pick such orders
 before all consolidated orders have been allocated, you must
unwave the
unwave the orders to remove the 990 wave number, and then
wave the orders.)
BOL/Manifest Number  Assign a bill of lading/manifest (pickup) number to orders, by
specifying the number. If you apply this option to multiple orders,
each will be assigned the same number.

9 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Probill/Shipment Assign a probill/shipment number to orders, by specifying the
Number number. If you apply this option to multiple orders, each will be
assigned the same number.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING CARTON CHECK-IN OPTIONS

Depending on the type of shipping s ystem your warehouse is using, if i f any, and your
warehouse’s requirements, order shipping cartons may need to be “checked in” by the
handheld Carton Shipping function, which records the weights and carton numbers for all
cartons in an order, and in some cases passes this information to an integrated shipping system;
for more information on these functions, see Chapter 8, “Shipping Orders” in
Orders”  in Using RADIO
 BEACON Handheld Functions.
Functions .

You can apply the following options to orders at any time before the cartons are to be scanned,
that is, in any carton status up until and including SCAN/SHIP (for more information, see
“Understandin
“Under standing
g Shipping Statuses”
Statuses” on page 6363):
):

Option Use to...


Display Hold Message If the cartons are to be checked in via the handheld Carton
Shipping function, alert the user who is scanning them t o hold the
carton, and display an explanatory message. Enter the message
you want to appear. For example, this could tell the user to
 perform a specific action such as “Enclose the Invoice”.
Capture Barcode If the cartons are to be checked in via the handheld Carton
Shipping function, prompt the user to scan an additional barcode.
For example, this can be useful if a shipping label is to be printed
 by a standalone shipping system, and the tracking number on the
label needs to be captured.

U N DE RS T AN D IN G A ND M OD I FY I NG S H IP P IN G O P TI O NS 9 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PRE-RATING ORDERS
Pre-rating allows an integrated shipping system, such as ClipperShip or NeoPost, to provide an
SHIP estimated shipping cost based on the weights of products in orders and, if your system is
configured for rate “shopping”, to determine the cheapest carrier and service for the order. This
information is passed back to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS and any errors, such as a bad address or a
carrier/service that is not available for the destination, are reported, so that you may correct
 problems before orders are even picked.

 Normally, if your system is configured to have an integrated shipping system pre-rate orders,
the pre-rating occurs at allocation. However, you can use the Pre-Rate option from the Ship
Settings window t o have the shipping
s hipping system pre-rate orders in READY TO WA
WAVE status on-
the-fly.

Note: If a group of orders is assigned a consolidation number, either by the host system, or
through the Ship action in Web Dispatch (see “Understanding and Modifying
Shipmentt Consolidation
Shipmen Consolidation Options”
Options” on page 95
95),
), none of the orders can be pre-rated
until all orders have been successfully allocated. If you want to wave and pick these
orders anyway, you will need to assign a shipping carrier and service manually,
through the Ship action—see “Understanding and Modifying Shipping Method
Options”” on page 92
Options 92 for
 for more information.

> To pre-rate an order or group of orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to pre-rate. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the
the screen
screen you are using,
using, and
and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu, select Ship.
The Ship Settings window is displayed.

3. Under the Immediate Action for Orders options, enable Pre-Rate.

9 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. Click Submit, and refresh the display in


display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444.. When all orders have been
 processed, they may appear in WAIT
WAIT PRE-RATE
PRE-RATE status; when the pre-rating is complete,
the orders will be returned to REA DY TO WA WAVE status.

If orders encounter errors in pre-rating, they will be placed into WAIT


WAIT PRE-RATE
PRE-RATE status. For
suggestions on how to handle these, see “Handling WaitWait Pre-Rate Orders” on page 87
87..

WAVING AND RE-WAVING ORDERS


You can wave orders with the status READY TO WA WAVE. You
You can wave orders with the
t he Pack &
Hold option for orders in the following statuses: HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT, HELD
SHORT.

You can also use the Wave action to consolidate orders. Consolidating two orders combines the
line items from multiple orders into a single order so that the all line items can be shipped as a
single shipment.

Finally, for orders that have been split by the host system, but should be linked, you can specify
that linked orders be suspended while they wait for the orders with which they are linked to be
fully allocated.

When orders are waved, the following normally occurs:

• The orde
orders
rs waved
waved togeth
together
er are
are assigne
assigned
d a wave numb
number
er (a four
four-di
-digit
git numbe
numberr startin
starting
g at
1000).

Note: Waving a group of orders together does not necessarily assign them all to the same
wave. You
You can control how orders are grouped i n waves by limiting the wave size; for
more information, see “Understanding and Modifying Workload Options” on
 page 102
102..

W AV IN G A ND R E- WA VI NG O RD ER S 9 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• Picking/shipping labels are
labels are printed for the orders, based on the default label rules set in the
configuration, or by the options you select during waving.

• The numb
numberer of carton
cartonss requir
required
ed to pack
pack each order
order is esti
estimate
mated,
d, and
and a uniq
unique
ue carton
number  (or
 (or “totelabel”) and track-trace number  is
 is generated for each carton.

• A “ big number ” is assigned to all cart


cartons
ons in an order (a one- or two-digit number from 1 to
99), and printed on picking/shipping labels.

• If you
you have
have chosen
chosen to consoli
consolidate
date order
orders,
s, all
all orders
orders in the wave,
wave, exce
except
pt one,
one, are remo
removed
ved
from the system, and the lines from those orders are moved into a single order.

• Orders
Orders are
are upda
updated
ted with the approp
appropriat
riatee statu
status,
s, as
as descr
described
ibed in “Understanding Wave
Results” on page
page 11
110
0.

The general process for waving consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to wave and/or consolidate. For procedures for selecting
orders, see “Genera
“Generall Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Wave. The Wave
Wave Settings window is displayed.

3. Opt
Option
ionally,
ly, modify waving options for
options  for the order(s) you are waving. More i nformation
about these options is provided in “Understanding and Modifying Wave Options” on
 page 101
101..

4. Perf
Perfor
orm
m the
the wavi
waving
ng,, and
and refresh the display in
display in the Orders summary screen. For
 procedures, see “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 4444..

5. Check the results of the waving,


waving , as described in “Understanding Wave Results” on
 page 110
110..

6. If nec
neceessa
ssary, unwave previously
unwave previously waved orders. For procedures, see “Unwaving Orders” on
 page 11
1111.

7. If necessary
necessary,, re-wave
re-wave previously
previously unwaved
unwaved orders
orders to make
make them availabl
availablee for picking
again.

1 0 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING WAVE OPTIONS

When you use the Wave action, the Wave Settings window is displayed.

The options in this screen are populated with default values that have been configured for your
implementation. However, you can modify any of the default settings for particular orders or
groups of orders, if necessary. All the options available in this screen are discussed in the
following sections:

• “Understanding and Modifying Workload Options” on page 102


102..

• “Understanding and Modifying End-of-Line Options” on page 103


103..

• “Understanding and Modifying Wave


Wave Label Printing Options” on page 105
105..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Linked Order Option” on page 108


108..

W AV IN G A ND R E- WA VI NG O RD ER S 1 01
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING WORKLOAD OPTIONS

When you group orders together for waving, you may wish to create predetermined waves wa ves of
orders that will be distributed to individual pickers for picking, depending on the picking styles
used in your warehouse and particular picker characteristics, such as the volume they can
typically handle in a specific time period. Therefore, you can use the following options to
control the workload of a given wave.

Options Use to...


Max # Orders: Limit wave sizes to a specific total number of orders to be given
to pickers. Enter the maximum number of orders to be included in
the same wave. For example, if you are waving 12 orders
together, entering 4 in this field will res ult in three waves of four
orders each. Each wave will be a ssigned a different wave number.
Max # Lines: Limit the wave size to a specific total number of lines to be given
to pickers. Enter the maximum number of lines to be included in
the same wave. For example, entering 12 in this field will result
in waves of orders with no more than a total of twelve lines in
each wave.
 Note: If there are orders in the batch that contain more lines than
the maximum you specify, they will still be waved, but will be
assigned to separate wave numbers.
Max # Units: Limit the wave size to a specific total
t otal number of units to be given
to pickers. Enter the maximum number of units to be included in
the same wave. For example, entering 1500 in this field will
result in waves of orders with no more than a total of 1500 units
in each wave.
 Note: If there are orders in the batch that contain more units than
the maximum you specify, they will still be waved, but will be
assigned to separate wave numbers.

1 0 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING ZONE WAVING OPTIONS

Include Zones Specify the zones in which orders must have picks for them to be
ZONE waved. For example, entering ABC will result in only orders with
 picks in zones A, B, and C being waved. Orders that have picks in
zones A, B, and C, and also have
also have picks outside of those defined
zones, will still be waved; orders that do not have picks inside
those zones will not be waved.
You can use this option to control zone picking styles. For
sequential zone picking styles, you would typically wave a group
of orders in one zone, and assign that wave to one picker, and
then wave a group of orders in a second zone, and assign that
wave to a second picker. For simultaneous zone picking styles,
you would wave orders in both zones together, and simply
distribute the orders for each zone to the appropriate picker, or
enter 99 for the Printer option (see “Understanding and
Modifying Wave
Wave Label Printing Options” on page 105 105)) to have
the labels print to printers in the appropriate zones.
Exclude Zones Specify the zones which must not be included in this wave. For
example, entering B will result in orders with picks in zone B
 being excluded from this wave.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING END-OF-LINE OPTIONS

 Normally, any end-of-line


end-of-line requirements are determined by the end-of-line configuration
selected for the carrier for the order or for the order itself. (For information on these, see
SHIP “Understandin
“Under standingg Process Flags” on page 59 59.)
.) However, you can modify the end-of-line
assignment on-the-fly by using the End of Line option to specify one of the following
configurations listed in the table below (if you leave this field blank, the “Default”
configuration will be used).

W AV IN G A ND R E- WA VI NG O RD ER S 1 03
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Note: If you need to make changes to


t o the end-of-line configuration after an order has been
waved, you can use the Ship action to do so. For more information, see
“Understanding and Modifying Shipping Method Options” on page 92 92..

Option Use to...


End of Line Apply the settings defined for one of the following end-of-line
configurations to the order (for information, see “Understanding
Process Flags” on
on page 59
59):
):
Blank — Keep the end-of-line setting already defined in the
order.
Default — Use the settings defined in the default end-of line
configuration.
1-Courier  —
 — Use the settings defined in the end-of-line
configuration for shipments sent via couriers that define a
shipment as being made up of a single carton.
M-Courier  —
 — Use the settings defined in the end-of-line
configuration for shipments sent via couriers that define a
shipment as being made up of multiple cartons.
LTL Truck — Use the settings defined in the end-of-line
configuration for shipments sent via LTL carriers.
Pickup — Use the settings defined in the end-of-line
configuration for orders that are picked up at the warehouse.
Other  —
 — Use the settings defined in the end-of-line configuration
for shipments sent via any other method.

1 0 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING WAVE LABEL PRINTING OPTIONS

You can modify default label printing settings by using any of the following options:

Option Use to...


Optimize Packing If picking/shipping and/or contents labels are to be printed, select
Carton Type the type of labels that should be printed for all the orders in the
wave:
Blank — Use the carton type already assigned in the orders
themselves.
Carton — Print carton picking/shipping and/or contents labels
for all orders.
Pallet — Print pallet picking/shipping and/or contents labels for
all orders. The track-trace number will include a “1” or “2”.
Truckload — Print truckload picking/shipping and/or contents
labels for all orders. The track-trace number will include a “3”.
Optimize Packing Assign the format of customer picking/shipping labels , if they are
Customer Label to be printed (see below). Note that this setting overrides any
options specified in the Ship Settings window (see
“Understanding and Modifying Label Printing Options” on
 page 93
93).
).
Labels Per Order  Print the following number of picking/shipping labels:
Use Calculated Qty — Print the number of labels defined by the
label rules in your sys tem configuration. (You
(You may need to
consult with your system administrator to determine what these
are.) If you are waving any orders that are to be full case-picked,
 be sure that this option is selected.
Start with 1 Label — Print 1 label for each order in the wave.
More labels can be produced during the picking process as
required.
Labels Print a batch pick label. This label contains no carton
Wave Label information, and is used for batch picking orders.

W AV IN G A ND R E- WA VI NG O RD ER S 1 05
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Labels Print a pre-packslip label for each order in the wave. This label
Pre-Packslip lists all items for an order. You can use these in any situation
where the picker needs to know all the products that were
originally ordered. It can also show the prices of the products on
the order.
Label Print a label that lists all items for an order, and allows pickers to
Pick Ticket write in the quantities picked for each product, for each order in
the wave. This label is usually used to help train pickers learning
to use R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS.

Labels Print a label for each order in the wave, that lists the lines, units,
Packing Planner  and cube of all the products in the
t he order, by product class, to help
 pickers and packers plan the equipment and packaging needed to
 pick and ship the order.
 Note: This label is only populated if product classes are defined
in your database. For more information, consult your system
administrator.
Labels Print a customer picking/shipping label for each order in the
Customer Label wave. Depending on your system configuration, this may print
carrier-specific pick/ship labels, customer-specific pick/ship
labels, or both. You can also modify the format of the labels, by
using the Optimize Packing: Customer Label option described
above.
Labels Print a paper pick ticket on a laser printer, for each order in the
Crystal Pick Ticket wave. This is often used for supermarket picking styles.

1 0 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Sort Slapper Labels When you select Customer Labels and/or Wave
Wave Labels, specify
how you want carton labels sorted when they print:
By Order  —
 — Carton labels are sorted by order number (default).
By Bin — Carton labels are sorted by bin number.

By Pallet — To sort by pallet, you must have a value in the Max


Cube field, which indicates that you wish to palletize orders in
the wave. The By Pallet option should be selected when you
 palletize orders. For more information see, “Understanding and
Modifying
Modify ing Palletizing
Palletizing Options” on page 108
108..

Printer# (99-Scatter) Specify a printer on which picking/shipping labels and other


requested labels are to be printed. Either enter the number of a
single physical printer on which all labels are to be printed (for
information, see “Label and Document Printing” in
Printing”  in the document
Overview of RADIO BEACON WMS ) for this wave, or enter 99
to scatter the printing among all the zones in which there are
 picks in this wave. Note that batch pick labels, however, cannot
 be scattered, as only one label will print per wave; if you use the
99 setting in this field, the batch pick label will print to printer #1.
 Note: This option does not affect Crystal Pick Tickets, which are
 printed on laser printers.

W AV IN G A ND R E- WA VI NG O RD ER S 1 07
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE LINKED ORDER OPTION

Some orders are split into multiple orders when they are downloaded. Although these orders
have the same order number in the host system, they are assigned different packslip numbers in
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS. These orders are known as linked  orders.
 orders. If you want to ensure that
linked orders are picked and shipped together, you can use the following option:

Option Use to...


Wait All Linked Orders Suspend orders that are linked to other orders that have not yet
 been successfully allocated. The orders will be placed into
SUSPENDED status, and cannot be picked until they are
unsuspended. Once the linked orders are successfully allocated,
you will need to manually unsuspend the
unsuspend the SUSPENDED orders
(see “Unsusp
“Unsuspending
ending Orders”
Orders” on page 11
1199 ).

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING PALLETIZING OPTIONS

When you group orders together for waving, you may wish to assemble cartons in the orders
into pallets for shipping or transfers. Palletizing can only be used with full case-picking. You
will need to specify the volume the palle t can handle, and if any of the cartons in the wave need
to be separated from the rest of the cartons that are palletized together.

When you use the palletize function, Wave


Wave (Batch) labels are automatically
automatic ally printed, with pallet
ID. The number of labels printed is:
Total cubage for the wave / maximum cube for each pallet ( Max Cube field).

Options Use to...


Max Cube Enter the maximum cube value, in the unit of measure used in
your warehouse, that can be included in a pallet. When you enter
a value in this field, the palletize function is activated.
Separate Load #1 Enter a zone to exclude from the pallet. Picks from this zone will
 be waved at the end and will not get the pallet labels.
Separate Load #2 Enter an additional zone to exclude from the pallet. Picks from
this zone will be waved at the end and will not get the pallet
labels.
Sort Slapper Labels By Pallet — Select the By Pallet option. The order in which
carton slapper labels will be sorted and printed, is by pallet.

1 0 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PACKING AND HOLDING ORDERS

You can release an order for picking, even if some of the lines
li nes have not been allocated, by
“packing & holding” it. This will pre-short 
will  pre-short  the
 the missing lines, and place the order in PACK &
HOLD status. The pickers will simply not be directed to pick the missing lines, and the order
will remain in BEING PICKED status. Releasing an order for pack & hold may be expedient
for very large-volume or labour-intensive orders, so that picking can begin even before all lines
can be filled.

Typically
Typically you will suspend the order when available items have been picked (see “Suspending
Orders” on page
page 118
118 for
 for information), unsuspend it
unsuspend it for completion when the missing items are
available (for information, see “Unsusp
“Unsuspending
ending Orders”
Orders” on page 119
119),
), re-allocate it to reserve
the stock from the appropriate bins, and continue to process the order in the normal manner.

To release an order for packing and holding, use the following Wave option:

Option Use to...


Pack & Hold Wave an order for picking an order without al l items being
allocated.

CONSOLIDATING ORDERS

You can consolidate multiple orders destined for the same customer and shipping address, so
that the orders are both picked and shipped as a single order.
order. (This process is distinct from
applying consolidation numbers to multiple orders via the shipping options; see
“Understanding and Modifying Shipment Consolidation Options” on page 95 95 for
 for more
information.) When you consolidate orders, all lines on the orders are placed on the lowest-
sequence order, and the other orders are deleted from the system. The consolidated order is
 placed into WA
WAVED status and then picked and shipped as a regular order.

If you wave multiple orders together when consolidating, only orders with the same customer
number and ship-to address will actually be consolidated.

Note: Once you have consolidated orders, the original orders are deleted. You can not
“unconsolidate” an order by unwaving it.

W AV IN G A ND R E- WA VI NG O RD ER S 1 09
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

To consolidate orders, use the following Wave option:

Option Use to...


Consolidate if Possible Consolidate multiple orders for the same customer and ship-to
address into a single order for picking and shipping.

UNDERSTANDING WAVE RESULTS

When you are returned to the Orders summary screen, and have refreshed it, the orders you
have attempted to wave will show their new status. The following table summarizes the
 possible wave results for sales orders.

Status Explanation
WAVED
VED The
The orde
order(
r(s)
s) are
are rea
ready
dy to be pick
picked
ed,, and
and will
will proc
procee
eed
d thro
throug
ugh
h the
the norm
normal
al
 process steps until they are shipped. Wave numbers, big numbers
numbers and
carton numbers are assigned to orders. Picking/shipping and other
additional labels, if requested, are automatically printed.
READY TO The order(s) were marked to be shipped together (consolidated) with other
WAVE orders that have not yet been successfully allocated. Orders with this statu s
are assigned a temporary wave number of 990. You can only wave these
orders by first applying the Unwave action
Unwave action to them (for information, see
 below), and then re-waving them.
PACK & The order(s) are ready to be picked, but will remain in the BEING
HOLD PICKED status until you take further action for the order(s). Wave
numbers, big numbers and carton numbers are assigned to orders. Picking/
shipping and other additional labels, if requested, are automatically
 printed.

1 1 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNWAVING ORDERS
You may need to unwave orders if you need to change shipping options for t he orders, print
additional types of labels, or consolidate orders. You can unwave orders that are in WA
WAVED,
PACK & HOLD or BEING PICKED status, or in READY TO WAVE WAVE status with a wave
number of 990.

When you unwave an order, the following occurs:

• Orders
Orders are returne
returned
d to the status
status they
they occup
occupied
ied befo
before
re bein
being
g unwav
unwaved.
ed.

• The wave
wave numb
number
er and
and carton
carton numb
numbers
ers assig
assigned
ned to the
the order
order may
may be discar
discarded
ded..

> To unwave an order or group of orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to unwave. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Unwave. The Unwave Settings window is displayed.

3. Option
ionally
lly, modify the unwaving option for
option  for the order(s) you are unwaving. More
information about this option is provided in “Understanding and Modifying the Unwave
Option”” on page
Option page 112
112..

4. Perf
Perfor
orm
m the
the unwa
unwave
ve,, and
and refresh the display in
display in the Orders summary screen. For
 procedures, see “Genera
“Generall Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44.. When all orders
have been processed, they should be updated with the stat us which they held prior to being
unwaved.

5. Re-wave the orders when


orders  when appropriate, by following the instructions in “Waving and Re-
waving Orders” on page
page 99
99..

U N W A V I N G O R D E R S 1 1 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE UNWAVE OPTION

When an order is waved, carton numbers are generated for each carton estimate d to be required
for the order. When you unwave an order, you have the option of deleting or saving the carton
labels that were already generated for the order previously. If you delete these carton labels, the
carton numbers may be assigned to cartons in subsequently waved orders. If you do not delete
the carton labels, the carton numbers will not be assigned to other cartons but will remain
reserved for the original order(s). This option will be set by default by your configuration, but
you can modify this default, as follows:

Option Use to...


Delete Unused Labels Delete the carton numbers assigned to the order(s) originally,
origi nally,
so that the label numbers may be used again for other
cartons/orders.

PERFORMING SHIPPING ACTIONS


The Immediate Actions options in the Ship Settings window allow you to manually apply
SHIP  particular actions to orders. These include triggering integrated shipping system processes such
as re-rating, clearing rating errors, and performing R ADIO BEACON WMS carton scanning and
shipment recording functions. You can use these options to apply an actio n that was not
originally defined for the order, to override a process that may be holding up an order, or to
skip a handheld shipping function to expedite the order.

You can only apply these processes at the appropriate points in the order ’s life cycle, which are
indicated in the following sections. When you apply these processes, the following occurs:

• Fille
Filled
d cart
carton
onss are
are upda
update
ted
d with
with the
the rel
relev
evan
antt stat
status
us..

• The orde
orderr may
may be
be move
moved
d into
into the
the nex
nextt proc
proces
esss step
step..

1 1 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The general process for performing shipping actions consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to process. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select Ship.
The Ship Settings window is displayed.

3. Selec
Selectt from
from one
one of the
the follo
followi
wing
ng opti
option
ons:
s:

• To skip
skip pre-r
pre-ratin
ating
g for
for order
orderss in WAIT
WAIT PRE-
PRE-RA
RATE
TE statu
status,
s, see
see “Handling Wait Pre-Rate
Orders”” on page 87
Orders 87..

• To rele
release
ase orde
orders
rs in
in WAI
WAITI
TING
NG - SWO
SWOG
G stat
status
us,, see
see “Handling Waiting - SWOG
Orders”” on page 87
Orders 87..

• To pre-
pre-rate
rate orders
orders in READY
READY TO
TO WA
WAVE status,
status, see “Pre-r
“Pre-rating
ating Orders”
Orders” on page 98
98..

P ER FO RM IN G S HI PP IN G A CT IO NS 1 13
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• To skip
skip carto
carton
n scann
scanning
ing for
for orde
orders
rs in
in BEING
BEING PICKED,
PICKED, READY
READY TOTO SHIP
SHIP or
RATING
RATING status, see “Performing or Bypassing Carton
Carton Scanning” on page 114
114..

• To skip
skip or perfo
perform
rm carto
carton
n check-
check-in
in functi
functions
ons for
for order
orderss in any
any status
status from
from READY
READY
TO SHIP to SHIPPED, see “Performing Shipping System Functions” on page 115 115..

4. Perf
Perfor
orm
m the
the acti
action
on,, and
and refresh the display in
display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures,
see “Gener
“General
al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44.. When all orders have been
 processed, carton and order statuses should be updated as noted in the following sections.

PERFORMING OR BYPASSING CARTON SCANNING

For orders that were required to be checked in with the Carton Shipping function on the
handheld, you can use the following options to force an automatic carton “scanning” while the
order is still being picked, or after the order has been picked:

Option Use to...


Carton Ship Perform carton scanning for orders that were required to be processed with
the Carton Shipping function on the handheld. Any processes that are
required to be performed during Carton Scanning will be executed.
You can apply this option to orders that are in BEING PICKED, READY
TO SHIP or RECORD SHIPMENT status.
Mark as Bypass carton scanning for orders that were required to be processed with
Checked-In the Carton Shipping function on the handheld. The carton(s) will be
treated as already scanned, will skip the SCAN/SHIP status, and be placed
into the next status defined for the order(s).
You can only apply this option to orders that have already
alrea dy been picked and
are in READY TO SHIP or RATING status.

1 1 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PERFORMING SHIPPING SYSTEM FUNCTIONS

You can use several options that perform actions normally handled by the Carton Shipping or
Record Shipment functions on the handheld (for more information on these, see Chapter 8,
“Shipping Orders” in
Orders” in Using RADIO BEACON Handheld Functions):
Functions ):

•  Notify ShipSys:
ShipSys: This action passes carton and shipment information for an order or group
of orders to a shipping system for rating/manifesting, in the same way as the Carton
Shipping function from the handheld. This option can be applied to orders in any status
after they are picked. Described in “Notif
“Notifying
ying the Shipping System”
System” on page 115
115..

• Clear Rating Errors:


Errors : This action clears any shipping errors that have been incurred by
orders on the shipping system, in the same way as the Carton Shipping function. This
option can be applied to orders in RATING status. Described in “Clearing Shipping
Errors”” on page
Errors page 11
116
6.

• Mark as Shipped:
Shipped : This action marks an order as shipped, whether or not the order has
undergone any shipping processes. This option can be applied to orders in READY TO
SHIP, RECORD SHIPMENT, and RATING statuses.

NOTIFYING THE SHIPPING SYSTEM

You can use the following options to process orders that were required to be held until a
manual process is performed on the shipping system, to re-rate orders for which you have
changed the carrier after they were rated initially, or to re-rate orders after errors have been
cleared (see “Clear
“Clearing
ing Shipping
Shipping Errors” on page 11 116
6 ):

Option Use to...


Notify Cause the integrated shipping system to rate (and manifest) the carton(s) in
Shipping the order(s).
System
You can apply this option at any point after an order has been picked, until
even after it has been marked as shipped. To specify the cartons in the
order that should be processed by the shipping system, use the Orders to
Notify Shipping System options, described below. When the cartons are
 processed by the shipping system, the status of the cartons will be updated
to RATING
RATING or RATING/MANIFESTING and the order will be moved into
the next process step, depending on the process flags for the order.

P ER FO RM IN G S HI PP IN G A CT IO NS 1 15
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Include When sending information to the shipping system, include orders/cartons
Unscanned that have not yet been scanned through the Carton Shipping function on
Orders the handheld.
Include When sending information to the shipping system, include orders/cartons
Scanned that have already been scanned through the Carton Shipping function on
Orders the handheld, but that could not be fully processed and marked SHIPPED
(for example, that incurred errors).
Include When sending information to the shipping system, include orders/cartons
Shipped that have already been processed by the shipping system and marked as
Orders SHIPPED.
Ignore Allow orders to be processed by the shipping system outside of the
Required Date shipping “window” defined in your R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS configuration.
For example, if orders may not be processed until two days or less before
they are required, you can use this option to allow the order(s) to be
 processed by the shipping system more than two days before the order is
required.

CLEARING SHIPPING ERRORS

You can use the following option


opti on to bypass rating for the order(s) if the order is held up in
RATING
RATING status, or to clear rating errors and run the  Notify ShipSys option (see “Notifying the
Shipping
Shipping System” onon page 115
115):
):

Option Use to...


Clear Rating Automatically clear rating errors. The action clears the errors encountered
Errors  by any cartons, and updates the cartons’ status to SCANNED.
You can only apply this option to orders that have already
alrea dy been picked and
are in RATING
RATING status.

1 1 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MARKING ORDERS AS SHIPPED

You can use the following options to force the cartons in the order to be marked as shipped,
whether or not they have been processed by shipping functions, or an integrated shipping
system:

Option Use to...


Mark as Bypass R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS handheld shipping functions that were
Shipped required for the order(s), and manually process the cartons. If you use this
option, you can also use the Orders Marked as Shipped options to record
shipment information (see below).
You can only apply this option to orders that have already been picked and
are in READY TO SHIP S HIP,, RECORD SHIPMENT, or RATINGRATING status. This
action will cause the status of the cartons to be updated to SHIPPED, and
will move the order into the next process step, depending on the process
flags for the order.
Shipment If you select the Mark as Shipped option above, manually record the
Number  shipment number for the order.
Cost of If you select the Mark as Shipped option above, manually record the cost
Shipping of shipping for the order.
Date Shipped If you select the Mark as Shipped option above, manually record the date
the order was shipped.
Release for If the order has been successfully marked as shipped, or if you select the
Upload Mark as Shipped option above, this option completes the Mark External
function, if it is required for the order, and releases the order for upload.

P ER FO RM IN G S HI PP IN G A CT IO NS 1 17
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

SUSPENDING ORDERS
While sometimes an order may automatically be suspended by the system due to a problem
with the order, you may also choose to suspend orders from time to time. Suspending an order
leaves it visible in Web Dispatch at whatever point in the process it was in, and holds it so that
no further processing may be applied to it, until you unsuspend it
unsuspend it (see “Unsuspending Orders”
on page
page 11919).
).

You may wish to manually suspend orders for a number of reasons, including a front-office
request that the order be held in the warehouse until an appropriate shipping date; a pack &
hold or other type of order that has been picked for all available lines but is waiting for stock
for other lines to arrive at the warehouse; cases w here pickers find that products that the system
thought were available are actually missing from bins; or any other orders that require some
manual intervention or customer approval before they can be completed. You can suspend
orders in any status.

When orders are suspended, the following occurs:

• The
The ord
order
erss are
are plac
placed
ed into
into the
the statu
statuss SUSPE
SUSPENDE
NDED.
D.

• The orde
orders
rs are
are assi
assign
gned
ed to a wav
wavee num
numbe
berr of
of 999
999..

> To suspend an order or group of orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s) you want to suspend. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Suspend. The Suspend Settings window is displayed.

3. In the Error Message field, enter a comment that indicates the reason you are suspending
the order(s). This message is displayed in the details and Packslip Report screens for the
order(s).

1 1 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. Click Submit, and refresh the display in


display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444.. When all orders have been
 processed, they should be updated with the status of SUSPENDED.

5. Unsuspend the orders when


orders  when appropriate, by following the instructions in “Unsuspending
Orders” on page
page 11
119
9.

UNSUSPENDING
UNSUSPENDING ORDERS
You must unsuspend any orders that are in SUSPENDED status before any further actionacti on can
 be performed on them. You
You will typically unsuspend an order when it is ready for further
 processing because, for example, missing stock has arrived to fill remaining lines.

When you unsuspend orders, the following occurs:

• Orders
Orders that
that were
were waved
waved but
but not
not yet pick
picked
ed are place
placed
d into
into READY
READY TO WA
WAVE status.
status.

• Orders
Orders that
that were
were picked
picked are placed
placed into BEING
BEING PICK
PICKED
ED statu
status.
s.

• The
The 999
999 wav
wave num
numbe
berr is
is cle
clear
ared
ed..

> To unsuspend an order or group of orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s) you want to unsuspend. For procedures for selecting orders, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Unsuspend. The Unsuspend Settings window is displayed.

3. Click Submit, and refresh the display in


display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444.. When all orders have been
 processed, they should be updated with the status they held prior to being suspended.

U N SU S PE N DI NG O RD ER S 1 19
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CANCELLING OR EXPEDITING SALES ORDERS


 Nuking  a
 a sales order is an exceptional way of handling sales orders in Web Dispatch at any
 point. Nuking can actually accomplish two different functions for different circumstances:

• “Nuke
“Nuke and
and delet
delete”—
e”— canc
cancels
els the sales
sales order
order and remove
removess it from
from R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS;
it is used in the case where a customer has ca ncelled an order and it is too late or inefficient
to cancel it from the host system.

• “ Nuke and upload”— actually expedites the sales order by bypassing all of the normal
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS process
 WMS process steps and reporting the quantity of product picked to the
host system. You may want to use this action to process a rush order for a customer; to
 process orders that have been allocated assuming infinite stock; or to expedite any other
orders that can be processed more efficiently by manual handling than by being passed
through the normal allocation, picking, and/or shipping steps.

Note: Your system will have configured the Nuke action to either cancel or upload orders by
default. If you need to handle an order differently, be sure to modify the appropriate
nuking options, as described below.

When you nuke orders, the following occurs:

• Any end-o
end-of-l
f-line
ine proce
processes
sses that
that were
were config
configure
ured
d for the
the order
order, such as
as automati
automaticc documen
documentt
 printing, are cancelled.

• If the
the order
order is not
not dele
deleted,
ted, it is
is assig
assigned
ned a wave
wave numb
number
er of
of 997.
997.

• Dependi
Depending
ng on the
the option
optionss you sele
select,
ct, orde
orders
rs are held
held and
and given
given the
the status
status EXTER
EXTERNAL;
NAL;
shipped and marked READY TO UPLOAD (in most implementations, this status is not
displayed, as pick
as pick confirmations are
confirmations are automatically uploaded to the host system); or deleted
from R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS and removed from the Web Dispatch display.

1 2 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The general process for cancelling or expediting sales orders consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s) you want to cancel or expedite. F or procedures for selecting orders, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywhere
anywhere on the screen
screen you are
are using,
using, and
and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select Nuke.
The Nuke Settings window is displayed.

3. Option
ionally
lly, modify nuking options for the order(s). More information about these options
is provided in “Understanding and Modifying Sales Order Nuke Options” on page 121 121..

4. Perf
Perfor
orm
m the
the nuke
nuke,, and
and refresh the display in
display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures,
see “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44..

5. Check the results of


results of the nuke, as described in “Understanding Nuking Results” on
 page 124
124..

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING SALES ORDER NUKE OPTIONS

When you use the Nuke action, theNuke Settings window is displayed.

The options in this screen will be populated with default values


values that have been configured for
your implementation. However, you can modify any of the default settings for particular orders
or groups of orders, if necessary. All the options available in this screen are discussed in the
following sections:

• “Understanding and Modifying Order Handling Options” on page 122


122..

• “Understanding and Modifying Host System Reporting Options” on page 124


124..

C A NC E LL IN G O R E XP E DI T IN G S AL E S O RD E RS 1 2 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING ORDER HANDLING OPTIONS

You use the Picked Goods and Unpicked Goods options to determine how the order or orders
are to be handled. If you want to completely cancel the order(s), you will normally want to
return any already-picked goods to stock, and cancel and unallocate unpicked goods. If you are
expediting the order(s), you will normally want to mark the already-picked goods as shipped,
and pick and relieve the unpicked goods.

If you are cancelling the order, you will want to release it without a packing slip; if you are
expediting it, you can either hold it until a manual process is executed, such as printing a
 packslip, or ship it without one.

Option Use to...


Ship Mark already-picked goods as shipped. If the Show Qty
Picked option is also selected (see “Understanding and
Modifying
Modify ing Host System Reporting
Reporting Options” on page 124
124),
),
the quantity of goods picked will be uploaded to the host
system.
Return to Stock Return already-picked goods to the bins from which they
originated. The warehouse staff will need to manually move
the stock back into the appropriate pick bins. If the Show Qty
Picked option is also selected (see “Understanding and
Modifying
Modify ing Host System Reporting
Reporting Options” on page 124124),
),
the products will be shown as shorted.
Return to TRANSIT Return already-picked goods to the TRANSIT location.
location. The
warehouse staff will need to use the Direct Move In
Move In function
to move the stock back into the pick bins of their choice. If
the Show Qty Picked option is also selected (see
“Understanding and Modifying Host System Reporting
Options”
Option s” on page 124
124),
), the products will be shown as
shorted.
Return To BIN Return already-picked goods to the bin that you specify. The
warehouse staff will need to manually move the stock back in
the appropriate pick bins. If the Show Qty Picked option is
also selected (see “Understanding and Modifying Host
System Reporting
Reporting Options”
Options” on page 124
124),
), the products will
 be shown as shorted.

1 2 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Cancel & Unallocate Unallocate unpicked goods from the order and make them
available for other orders. If the Show Qty Picked option is
also selected (see “Understanding and Modifying Host
System Reporting
Reporting Options”
Options” on page 124
124),
), the products will
 be shown as shorted.
Pick & Relieve Fill the order by automatically picking the remaining lines,
and depleting the inventory. If the Show Qty Picked option
is also selected (see “Understanding and Modifying Order
Handling
Handlin g Options”
Options” on page
page 122
122),
), the quantity of goods
 picked will be uploaded to the host system.
Hold for Packslip Hold the order for manual processing. The order will be
 placed in the status of EXTERNAL, and will need to be
marked as having gone through the external process before
 being completed. For more information, see “Understanding
 Nuking Results” on page 124
124..
Release Without Cancel or ship the order without a packing slip or any manual
 processing.

C A NC E LL IN G O R E XP E DI T IN G S AL E S O RD E RS 1 2 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING HOST SYSTEM REPORTING


OPTIONS

You use the Report to Host and Backorder  options


 options to determine how the order(s) will be
uploaded to the host system. If you want to completely cancel the order(s), you will normally
want to delete the order(s), and cancel any missing items. If you want to expedite the order(s),
you will normally want to upload a pick confirmation to the host system, and create a back
order for any items not picked.

Option Use to...


Show Qty Picked Pass the actual quantities picked to the host system.
Nuke & Delete Completely remove this order from the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS
system and do not report anything to the host system.
Ok to Backorder  Create a back order for any items that have not been picked.
 Note: Your
Your system must be configured to allow R ADIO
ADIO BEACON
WMS to create back orders for your warehouse.
Cancel Remainder  Cancel any outstanding quantities on the order.

UNDERSTANDING NUKING RESULTS

When you are returned to the Orders summary screen, and have refreshed it, the orders you
have “Nuked” will either have disappeared from the display (if you selected “nuke and
delete”), or will show their new status. The following table summarizes the possible nuking
results for sales orders.

Status Explanation
READY TO The pick confirmation(s) are ready to be uploaded to the hos t system. This
UPLOAD status will only display if you selected “nuke and upload”, and if your
system is not configured to upload pick confirmations automatically
(otherwise, the orders will simply disappear from the display).
EXTERNA
EXTERNAL
L You selecte
selected
d to hold
hold the
the order
order during
during nuking
nuking.. The
The orde
orderr must
must unde
underg
rgo
oa
manual process and be marked as having done so, through the Mark
External function on the handheld. For more information, see “Marking
External Processes Complete” in
Complete” in Using RADIO BEACON Handheld
 Functions.
 Functions.

1 2 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GENERATING BILLS OF LADING AND MANIFESTS


You can generate bills of ladings (BOLs) and manifests
manifest s from Web Dispatch, for orders that will
SHIP  be shipped to customers such as large retailers, that will only receive the goods against these
accompanying documents. Bills of lading list all the orders and customer PO numbers in a
shipment, and summarize groups of products by tare or freight code. Manifests list all of this
information, plus more detailed information, such as the exact store or distribution centre to
which each order in the shipment is destined.

The documents are actually laid out by Crystal Reports template files that must be configured
for your system, but Web Dispatch provides you with an online form to fill out, and
automatically populates the form with basic shipping information.

You can generate a single bill of lading or manifest for each order in a shipment, or add
multiple orders to a single bill of lading or manifest for an entire shipment.

Generally, there are three steps to generating a bill of lading and/or manifest in Web Dispatch:

1. Optionally
Optionally,, if you want to assign
assign a group of orders
orders to the
the same BOL
BOL number,
number, and/or
consolidation number, or if you want to define the numbers t o be applied to an order or
orders, use the Ship action to apply Shipping Controls options to the orders, before they
are waved out. For information, see “Understanding and Modifying Shipment
Consolidation
Conso lidation Options”
Options” on page
page 95
95..

2. Add an order  to
 to a bill of lading, begin to add information to it, and save it. This can be
done any time after the order(s) are fully picked. For procedures, see “Adding an Order to
a Bill of Lading/Mani
Lading/Manifest”
fest” on page
page 126
126..

3. Edit the bill of lading or


lading  or add any remaining information to it , and print
and  print the bill of lading
and/or manifest. This is usually done after a ny shipping processes have been completed for
the order(s). For procedures, see “Viewing, Editing, and Printing an Existing Bill of
Lading”” on page 128
Lading 128..

G EN E RA TI N G B I LL S O F L AD I NG A ND M AN I FE ST S 1 2 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADDING AN ORDER TO A BILL OF LADING/MANIFEST

Even if you have assigned BOL and/or consolidation numbers to orders with the Ship action,
you must still add the order or orders to a bill of lading to actually generate the bill of lading.
When you add a single order to the bill of lading, if multiple orders have been assigned to the
same BOL or consolidation number, they will automatical ly be added to the same bill of lading
as well.

> To add an order or orders to a bill of lading/manifest in R ADIO BEACON WMS:

1. If you want
want to do
do any of the following,
following, use the Ship
Ship action
action at any
any time (prefera
(preferably
bly before
before
the order(s) are waved out), as described in “Understanding and Modifying Shipment
Consolidation
Consoli dation Options”
Options” on page 9595::

• Specify
Specify the BOL
BOL and/o
and/orr conso
consolida
lidatio
tion
n number
number for an
an order
order or
or group
group of
of order
orders.
s.

• Add multipl
multiplee order
orderss to the same BOL and/or
and/or consol
consolida
idation
tion number
number..

2. Open the
the Packslip
Packslip Report
Report for any
any order
order to be added
added to the same
same bill of lading.
lading.

1 2 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. In the Packsli
Packslip
p Repo
Report
rt screen,
screen, click
click the BOL button. The BOL Report screen is displayed,
with the BOL number, your shipping address, the customer’s shipping address, and some
 basic shipment information

4. If this
this data is available,
available, enter a service
service code,
code, shipment,
shipment, freight,
freight, and/or
and/or special
special services
services
information in the relevant fields.

5. To save
save the bill
bill of
of ladin
lading,
g, cli
click
ck Submit. The bill of lading is saved, and all fields are
displayed as uneditable.

6. To edit or
or print
print the bill
bill of lading
lading,, follow
follow the
the proced
procedure
uress in “Viewing, Editing, and Printing
an Existing
Existing Bill of Lading”
Lading” on page 128 128..

G EN E RA TI N G B I LL S O F L AD I NG A ND M AN I FE ST S 1 2 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

VIEWING, EDITING, AND PRINTING AN EXISTING BILL OF LADING

Once an order or orders have been added t o a bill of lading, and tthe
he bill of lading has been
saved, it can be opened for editing and printing from various screens in Web Dispatch.

> To open an existing bill of lading:

1. Do any
any of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• From
From the Packs
Packslip
lip Repo
Report
rt screen
screen of any
any order
order assign
assigned
ed to a sing
single
le bill
bill of ladin
lading,
g, click
click
the BOL button.
• From
From the Miscella
Miscellaneo
neous
us Repo
Reports
rts scre
screen
en in
in the
the Repor
Reports
ts modul
module,
e, next
next to the
the BOL
Report selection, enter the number of the bill of lading you want to view in the BOL#
field, and click Go.
• In the
the Orde
Ordersrs det
detai
ails
ls scr
scree
een,
n, unde
underr the
the Pickup Number  field,
 field, click the number link for
the bill of lading you want to view.
The bill of lading is opened in read-only mode.

2. Do any
any of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To edit
dit the BOL, click
ick Edit BOL. The screen is re-displayed, in editable mode. Edit
the desired fields, and click Submit to save.
• To print
print the bill
bill of lading
lading using
using your
your wareh
warehous
ouse’
e’ss Crystal
Crystal Repo
Reports
rts templ
template
ate for
for a bill
of lading document, click Print BOL. The bill of lading is printed.
• To print
print the
the bill of
of lading
lading using
using your
your wareho
warehouse’
use’ss Crystal
Crystal Repo
Reports
rts temp
template
late for
for a
manifest document, click Print Manifest. The manifest is printed.

‘PICKING’ A SALES ORDER 


The Quick Order Completion facility allows you to “pick” the products for a waved o rder with
Web Dispatch rather than from the handheld. This may be useful in situations where handhelds
are not available. After the
t he order is picked manually, you use Quick Order Completion to
record the products and quantities that were picked. You can also select the numbers of the
cartons into which the products were packed.

1 2 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

You can complete orders in the status of WAVED or BEING PICKED only.

> To complete a sales order:

1. Go to the Reports module.

2. Click
Click the
the Picking
Picking tab
tab to displ
display
ay the
the Picking
Picking Repo
Reports
rts scre
screen.
en.

3. Next to the Quick Order Completion selection, in the Packslip field, enter the order
number and click Go. The Quick Order Completion screen for the order is displayed, with
line and carton information in the middle of the page.

4. Verify that
that the quantity
quantity and carton
carton informa
information
tion is correct
correct for each
each line, and
and make
make any
necessary changes.

‘ PI CK IN G’ A S AL ES O RD ER 1 29
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

5. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, edit
edit the
the Picker  and
 and Ship Via fields, if necessary.

6. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, to print
print additi
additiona
onall carton
carton labe
labels,
ls, in the
the Ship Labels field, enter the number of
labels you want to print.

7. Optionally
Optionally,, to create
create a Bill
Bill of Lading
Lading for
for the order
order,, click the BOL button
button and
and follow
follow the
 procedure in “Adding an Order to a Bill of Lading/Manifest” on page 126 126..

8. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, to edit
edit the sales
sales order
orders,
s, click
click the Edit button.

9. Optionally
Optionally to view a log of the entries
entries and
and activities
activities for this
this sales
sales order,
order, click the
the Log
 button.

10. Click Confirm when you are satisfied that the information you entered is correct.

When you click Confirm, the order is marked as picked and moves into the next process step
determined for the order.

CREATING DELIVERIES IN RADIO BEACON


The create delivery functionality allows you to include partial or complete lines from multiple
sales orders into a single delivery for a specific cus tomer and ship-to address. When you create
a delivery, you do not need to add all lines or all quantities on a selected sales order to the
delivery. Instead, you can create deliveries consisting of only sel ected lines and even partial
quantities from a line.

UNDERSTANDING THE CREATE DELIVERY FUNCTION

You create deliveries from ‘open’ sales


sal es orders for the same customer
cust omer and same ship-to address.
‘Open’ sales orders are UNALLOCATED, which have not been LOCKED (see “Locking
Packslips”
Packslips” on page 132
132 for
 for more information.

1 3 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The Create Delivery function provides flexibili ty in building the delivery, allowing you to:

• crea
create
te mul
multi
tipl
plee deliv
deliver
erie
iess from
from a sin
singl
glee pack
packsli
slip
p

• create
create a deliv
deliver
er from
from multip
multiple
le packsl
packslips
ips (all
(all order
orderss to the same
same custo
customer
mer and
and ship-
ship-to
to
address)

• includ
includee only
only speci
specifica
fically
lly sele
selected
cted lines
lines from
from the
the sales
sales order
order in
in the delive
delivery
ry

• includ
includee partia
partiall quant
quantitie
itiess of sales
sales order
order lines
lines in the delive
delivery
ry..

Creating a delivery results in two types of packslips:

A new delivery packslip—When a delivery is created, a new packslip document for the
specified lines and quantities is created. The new packslip has an ORDER TYPE of
Delivery and includes a link(s) to the original packslip(s) from which items for the
delivery were taken.

The delivery packslip is processed like any other R ADIO


ADIO BEACON picking document,
including allocating, waving, creating a BOL, etc., except the Nuke function. When the
delivery has been completed, the packslip is uploaded to the host.

The original packslip—This is defined as the packslip from which items were selected for
the delivery. The original packslip displays an additional secti on, the  Created Delivery
section, which links to the packslip reports for deliveries that were created from this sales
order.

When you create a delivery (or deliveries) that includes all items from a sales order, the
original packslip is not required. It could be ‘deleted’, but it is maintained in SHIPPED &
UPLOADED status in case the delivery is discarded and the original packslip needs to be
restored. Although the status is SHIPPED & UPLOADED, the packslip has not actually
 been uploaded to the host.

When you create a delivery (or deliveries), but some of the items are left on the original
 packslip, the original packslip remains in the system. In the packslip details , any line that
was included in a delivery, no longer displays in the original order. However, if you
included a partial quantity in a delivery, the original quantity displays in the Ordered QTY
column, while the remaining quantity displays in the Packslip QTY column. When items
remain on the original packslip, the unallocated packslip will moved to LOCKED status
when the delivery is processed. See “Locking Packslips” following.
Packslips” following.

C RE AT IN G D EL IV ER IE S I N R AD IO B EA CO N 1 31
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

LOCKING PACKSLIPS

When a delivery is waved, the remainder portion of orders that have been split for deliveries
 but not allocated are moved to the LOCKED process step. In LOCKED status no actions can
 be performed on packslip.

When the deliveries are uploaded to the host, the LOCKED orders are deleted from R ADIO
BEACON WMS. Eventually the remaining items and quantities are backordered by the host or
 by R ADIO
ADIO BEACON, depending on the configuration.

CREATING A DELIVERY

> To create a delivery:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Pick
Picking
ing tab
tab to disp
display
lay the
the Picking
Picking Repo
Reports
rts scree
screen.
n.

3. Next to the Create a Delivery selection, click Go. The Create a Delivery screen is
displayed

4. In the Delivery Number  field,


 field, enter a number for this delivery.

1 3 2 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

5. In the Customer Number field enter a customer, or optionally click the question mark
 beside the field to display a list of customers with open sales orders. If a cust omer has
more than one ship-to address, the customer number & ship-to address combination will
 be a separate selection.

6. Click
Click the
the cus
custom
tomer
er unde
underr the
the Customer/Ship heading to select that customer and click
Close.

7. From the Available Orders drop-down list, select a sales order containing the line(s) you
want to add to the delivery,
delivery, or select All to include all open sales orders for that customer.
The order details display.

C RE AT IN G D EL IV ER IE S I N R AD IO B EA CO N 1 33
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

8. To select
select lines
lines to add to the
the delivery
delivery,, do one of the
the following
following::

• To selec
selectt all
all line
liness and
and quan
quantiti
tities
es for
for this
this order
order,, click
click Select All.

• To sele
select
ct a par
partia
tiall qua
quant
ntity
ity of a line
line,, in
in the
the Quantity Split field, enter the quantity you
want. To deselect a line, in the Quantity Split field, enter 0. Click Add Selected.

The line item(s) appear in the Selected Items tab.

9. If necessa
necessary
ry,, you can delete
delete any line by clickin
clicking
g the delete
delete icon
icon .

1 3 4 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

10. To add lines from


from another
another sales order
order,, repeat steps
steps 7 to 9.

11. When you have


have finished
finished adding
adding all items to the delivery
delivery,, click  Create
 Create Delivery.

USING CLONE PICKING


Clone picking allows you to process identical sal es orders quickly. Identical sales orders means
that the sales orders must be to the same customer and all details for the sales order (such as the
number of lines, line details, shipping information, etc.) are all the same.

The clone picking process is implemented as follows:

1. A group
group of identical
identical orders
orders is allocated.
allocated. All orders
orders that you want
want to clone pick must
must be
fully allocated.

2. One orde
orderr is proce
processed
ssed using
using any pick
pick and
and pack
pack proce
procedur
dure.
e.

3. From Web
Web Dispatch,
Dispatch, display
display the Orders
Orders details
details screens
screens for sales
sales orders
orders in
in READY TO
WAVE status.

U S I NG C LO N E P IC KI N G 1 3 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to clone pick. For procedures for selecting orders, see
“General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44..

5. Right-click
Right-click anywhere
anywhere on the screen,
screen, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select Clone Picking. The
Clone Settings window is displayed.

6. In the Master Order  field,


 field, enter the order number of the first (original) order processed.

7. Opti
Optio
onall
nally
y, in
in the
the Packslip Printer  field
 field enter the number of the printer for Packing Slips.

8. Opti
Optio
onall
nally
y, in
in the
the Label Printer  field
 field enter the number of the printer for Shipping labels.

9. Opti
Optio
onall
nally
y ent
enter
er a Handle, and click Submit.

The results of the clone picking are as follows:

• RADIO
RADIO BEACON
BEACON gene generat
rates
es one
one label
label per
per carton
carton per
per order
order base
based
d on how
how the
the origin
original
al
order was packed, and automatically packs the same products into the same cartons, in the
same quantities as the original order.

• The orde
orders
rs are
are marked
marked as
as complet
completely
ely picke
picked
d and moves
moves into
into the
the next
next proces
processs step
determined for the master
mas ter order (for example, READY TO SHIP,
SHIP, READY TO UPLOAD,
UPLOA D,
SHIPPED AND UPLOADED

The following orders will be ignored even if selected and if the Clone acti on is applied to them:

• Order
Orderss that
that are
are not
not exa
exact
ctly
ly the
the sam
samee as the
the mast
master
er ord
order 
er 

• Order
Orderss tha
thatt hav
havee alre
alread
ady
y been
been part
partial
ially
ly pick
picked
ed

• Orde
Orders
rs that
that are
are not
not full
fully
y all
alloc
ocat
ated
ed

1 3 6 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CANCELLING CLONE PICKING


As long as cloned sales orders have not been uploaded the host, clone picking can be ‘undone’
and returned to READY TO WAVE status.

To unclone an order or group of orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s) you want to unclone. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Unclone. The Unclone Settings window is displayed.

3. Opti
Optio
onall
nally
y en
enter
ter a Handle, and click Submit. When all orders have been processed, they
should be returned to READY TO WAVE status.

EXPORTING MANIFEST INFORMATION


If you use are using ATS
ATS as an LTL carrier in i n your warehouse, you can export manifest
SHIP information for the day’s shipments to a text file that can be e-mailed
e-maile d to ATS.
ATS. One file is
written for a selected date, to the server directory in which the RFBase executable is stored.
The file is named with the date on which the manifest information was exported in YY/MM/
DD format.

Note: In future, this function will be expanded to support additional LTL carriers.

If you export shipments several times in a single day, all the records will be written to the same
text file.

C AN CE LL IN G C LO NE P IC KI NG 1 37
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To export manifest information to a text file for ATS:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Pick
Picking
ing tab
tab to disp
display
lay the
the Picking
Picking Repo
Reports
rts scree
screen.
n.

3. Next to the Manifest Report selection, click Go. The Manifest Report screen is displa yed.

4. Select the
the ATS
ATS check
check boxes
boxes only.
only. For procedures
procedures for
for selecting
selecting orders,
orders, see “Selecting
Orders”
Ord ers” on page
page 41
41..

5. Right-c
Right-clic
lick,
k, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu
menu that
that appear
appears,
s, select
select Export Manifest ATS. The
Export Manifest settings window appears.

6. In the Date Ship field, enter the date of the shipments which you want to write to the text
file were shipped, in MM/DD/YYYY format, or leave the field blank to select today’s
date. Any shipments that have not yet been exported, up to and including the date you
specified will be included.

7. Click Submit. The shipping information for the orders you selected are exported to a text
file written to the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS installation
installati on directory.

1 3 8 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To view the manifest information you have exported:

1. In the Reports
Reports module,
module, click
click the
the Picking
Picking tab to display
display the
the Picking
Picking Reports
Reports screen.
screen.

2. Next to the Manifest Report selection, click Go. The Manifest Report screen is displayed,
with a list of all manifests created for the previous seven days.

3. Click the
the number
number of the
the manifest
manifest you
you want to view.
view. The manifes
manifestt information
information is displayed,
displayed,
as described in “Manif
“Manifest
est Report”
Report” on page
page 220
220..

E XP OR TI NG M AN IF ES T I NF OR MA TI ON 1 39
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

1 4 0 C H A P T E R 2 P R O C E S S I N G S A L E S O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3 PROCESSING ASSEMBLY
KIT
ORDERS

ABOUT PROCESSING ASSEMBLY ORDERS


Assembly, or work orders are similar to sales orders in that they are viewed in the Orders
module, order details are viewed in the Packslip Report screen, and work orders need to be
allocated. However, although the same pop-up menus and allocation screens appear for work
orders in Web Dispatch, not all of the options actually apply to work orders. This chapter
discuses the different types of work orders, th e actions, options, and statuses that
t hat apply to them,
and special considerations you need to take into account when processing work orders. Before
continuing, you are advised to review the chapter “Understanding RADIO BEACON WMS
Concepts” in
Concepts” in the document Overview of RADIO BEACON WMS .

The following sections provide conceptual background information on working with assembly
orders:

• “Understanding Assembly Order Actions and Statuses”


Statuses” on page 142
142..

• “Understanding the Work


Work Order Packslip Report Screen” on page 143
143..

• “Understanding Types
Types of Assembly Orders” on page 146

1 4 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING ASSEMBLY ORDER ACTIONS AND STATUSES

You can apply the following actions to work orders:

• Allocate

• Unallocate

• Nuke

 Note that the Wave, Unwave, Suspend, Unsuspend, and Ship actions do not apply to work
orders.

Note: The actions that are actually available to you will depend on your permissions.

The following sections provide an overview of these actions, the stage in the processing cycle
at which you normally perform them, and the sections in this chapter in which they are
described. For an overview of work order process st eps, see “Understanding Process Steps” on
 page 26
26..

ABOUT THE ALLOCATE ACTION

You use the Allocate act


action
ion to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Allocate stock to work orders that ASSEMBLY - “Allocating and Re-
have not yet been allocated. UNALLOCATED allocating Work Orders”
on page
page 14
147
7.
Re-allocate orders that were not ASSEMBLY - SHORT “Allocating and Re-
allocated successfully, or have been allocating Work Orders”
only partially allocated. on page
page 14
147
7.

1 4 2 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE UNALLOCATE ACTION

You can use the Unallocate action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Unallocate previously allocated work ASSEMBLY - WAIT “Unallocating Work
orders and free up reserved stock. REPLEN Orders” on page
page 155
155..
ASSEMBLY - READY
ASSEMBLY - SHORT

ABOUT THE NUKE ACTION

You use the Nuke action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Cancel an order and, optionally, delete any “Cancelling Work
it from R ADIO
ADIO BEACON. Orders” on page
page 156
156..

UNDERSTANDING THE WORK ORDER PACKSLIP REPORT SCREEN

The Packslip Report screen tells you all the details about a work order, and is helpful for
monitoring and troubleshooting a work order throughout all stages of the warehouse cycle,
from initial allocation to upload to the host system. The following sections describe portions of
the report screen that you can use to monitor a work order’s progress:

• “Understanding Work
Work Order Line Statuses” on page 144
144..

• “Understanding Work
Work Order Assembly Info” on page 145
145..

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G A SS EM BL Y O RD ER S 1 43
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING WORK ORDER LINE STATUSES

The Packslip Report for the work order shows the finished goods and components and service
items as separate line items. The finished good item will always be shown as the first line item
and will be given the status of Comment, as will service items and co/by-products. The actual
components will be marked with allocation statuses, which can be helpful for troubleshooting
 purposes. In the example below,
below, the order has been held short because of the last component.

Line number  Finished good Components Line status

Line statuses are marked and color-coded as follows:

Status Color Explanation


Indicator
Commen
Commentt Gray
Gray The line is a finishe
finished
d good,
good, a co/by-
co/by-pro
produc
duct,
t, or a service
service item.
item.
Unalloc Black The component has not been allocated.
Bin la
label(s) Blue The component is
is to
to be replenished from the overstock bins
indicated.
Short Red Inventory of this component product is not available anywhere
in the warehouse. The line requires that product be received
 before the order can be allocated.

 Note that if replenishment is required to move component


component products into the work area, the lines
in this section of the report always display the original  bins
 bins from which the products were
replenished, and not their current locations.
l ocations. You
You will know whether or not the component items
have been replenished by examining the Assembly info portion of the screen, as described
 below.

1 4 4 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING WORK ORDER ASSEMBLY INFO

The Assembly Info portion of a work order Packslip Report provides details about the kit
recipe and the progress of the kit-building process. The product quantities shown indicate the
stage that the order has reached in the assembly process: i f the order has been allocated, and the
required quantities are displayed in the In Work Area and Can Pull fields, the kits are ready to
 be built; if these fields do not show the required quantities, the work area needs to be
replenished with inventory from overstock or other bins in the warehouse. In the following
example, the order has been allocated, but the order is awaiting replenishment of the
component items.

Zero quantities here indicate that


component items have not yet been
let down to the work area and that the
kits are not yet ready to be built.

When the components have been replenished, the quantities that have been moved to the work
area are displayed in the In Work Area column:

Quantities indicate
the number of
component products
moved to the work
area.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G A SS EM BL Y O RD ER S 1 45
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

As kitters build kits and use the Pull Kitting function


Kitting function to report quantities built, the CanPull and
Built columns are updated accordingly:

Quantities still Number of


available for kits already
building kits. built.

UNDERSTANDING TYPES OF ASSEMBLY ORDERS

Although they are displayed in the Orders module, and use the same Packslip Report screen,
work orders are distinguishable from sales orders by their statuses, which are prefixed with
“Assembly”, and by the ASSEMBL
ASSEM BLY Y field, which is set to “YES”.

However, because not all work orders are processe d in the same way, it is helpful to recognize
the different types of work orders that are supported by R ADIO BEACON WMS and managed in
Web Dispatch. These include:

• Build-t
Build-to-s
o-stock
tock work
work order
orderss issued
issued by
by the
the host
host system
system and
and down
download
loaded
ed into
into R ADIO
ADIO
BEACON WMS as work orders. These may follow any numbering convention determined
 by your setup, but they are typically prefixed by an identifier that indicates that they are
work orders, such as ASM. They will not contain any customer information or ship-to
information in the Packslip Report. Unless your system is configured for automatic
allocation, you must allocate these orders, and you can apply all relevant actions to them.

• Build-t
Build-to-s
o-stock
tock work
work order
orderss manuall
manually
y entere
entered
d by a handhe
handheld
ld user
user thro
through
ugh the R ADIO
ADIO
BEACON Build Kits function. These are numbered by the user at the order entry. You
You
 process these orders in the same way as regular work orders.

1 4 6 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• Build-
Build-to-
to-ord
order
er work
work order
orderss issued
issued by the
the host
host system
system and
and downl
download
oaded
ed into
into RADIO
RADIO
BEACON as a combined work order and sales order pair. Usually these order pairs are
 prefixed with some kind of code to indicate that they are part of a work order, such as
“ASM”. The assembly order is numbered the same as its corresponding sales order, but
with the extension .001. The work orders will contain customer information and ship-to
information in the Packslip Report. You process these orders in the same way as regular
work orders.

• Build-
Build-to-
to-ord
order
er work
work order
orderss issued
issued by the
the host
host system
system and
and downl
download
oaded
ed into
into RADIO
RADIO
BEACON as sales orders (kit-on-the-fly). These orders are processed as regular sales
orders, as described in “Understanding Types
Types of Sales Orders” on page 65
65..

ALLOCATING AND RE-ALLOCATING WORK


ORDERS
If your warehouse uses manual allocation, you can allocate any work orders with the status
ASSEMBLY
ASSEMBLY-UNALLOCATED,
-UNALLOCATED, at any time. You may have business rules in your warehouse
that determine when orders should be allocated, and in what sequence, such as orders that
 belong to an “Alert” category, build-to-order
build-to-order orders for a particular customer, date required,
etc. Or you may simply allocate
allocat e all orders as soon as they are downloaded and are displayed in
Web Dispatch. If background allocation is not enabled in your implementation, you will need
to manually re-allocate orders that are in ASSEMBLY-SHORT
ASSEMBLY-SHORT status.

If your system is configured for background allocation, you may not have to run the initial
allocation or any re-allocation. However,
How ever, you may need to handle work orders that cannot be
successfully allocated automatically.

When a work order is allocated, the following occurs:

• Stock
Stock is reser
reserved
ved from
from the
the specif
specified
ied work
work area
areass for the
the requi
required
red prod
product
uctss (if they
they are
are
available).

• Orde
Orderr and
and line
line sta
statu
tuses
ses are
are upda
update
ted,
d, as
as desc
descri
ribe
bed
d in “Understanding Work Order
Allocation
Allocat ion Results”
Results” on page 154
154..

A LL OC A TI N G A ND R E -A LL OC A TI N G W OR K O R DE R S 1 4 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• If compo
componen
nentt items
items are not
not in the
the specifi
specified
ed work
work areas,
areas, repl
repleni
enishm
shment
ent requ
requests
ests are
are
generated.

• Each orde
orderr that
that require
requiress repleni
replenishm
shment
ent is assig
assigned
ned to a separ
separate
ate reple
replenish
nishmen
mentt group
group
identified by the work order number.

• Assembly labels are
labels are printed.

In general, the process for allocating work orders consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to (re-)allocate. For procedures for selecting orders, see
“General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44..

Note: It is best not to group sales orders and work orders together in the same allocation
 batch.

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Allocate. The Allocate Settings window is displayed.

3. Opt
Option
ionally,
ly, modify allocation options for
options  for the order(s) you are (re-)allocating. More
information about these options is provided in “Understanding and Modifying Work Order
Replenishment
Replen ishment Options”
Options” on page 149
149..

4. Perfo
Perform
rm the
the (re
(re-)
-)all
alloc
ocat
ation
ion,, and
and refresh the display in
display  in the Orders summary screen. For
 procedures, see “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44..

5. Check the results of


results  of the (re-)allocation, as described in “Understanding Work Order
Allocation
Allocation Results”
Results” on page
page 154
154..

1 4 8 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

6. For work
work orders
orders that
that are held short,
short, identify
identify an appropr
appropriate
iate method
method for handlin
handling
g them.

7. If ne
neces
cessar
sary, unallocate previously
unallocate previously allocated orders. For procedures, see “Unallocating
Work Orders”
Orders” on page 155
155..

8. If necessary
necessary,, re-alloca
re-allocate
te orders
orders as many
many times as is
is necessary
necessary..

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING WORK ORDER REPLENISHMENT


OPTIONS

When you use the Allocate action, the Allocati on Settings window is displayed. The options in
this window are populated with default values that have been configured for your
implementation. However, you can modify any of the default settings for particular orders or
groups of orders, if necessary. Note that these options only affect replenishment, if it is
required. Otherwise, the system will automati cally allocate stock that is already available in the
required work area.

A LL OC A TI N G A ND R E -A LL OC A TI N G W OR K O R DE R S 1 4 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The options that affect replenishment for work orders are discussed in the following sections:

• “Understanding and Modifying Work Order Replenishment Method Options” on


 page 150
150..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Location Replenishment Option” on page 151


151..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Zones Replenishment Options” on page 153


153..

• “Understanding and Modifying Attribute Expiry Replenishment Options” on


on page 152
152..

• “Understanding and Modifying the Assembly Label Printing Option” on page 153

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING WORK ORDER REPLENISHMENT


METHOD OPTIONS

The action of allocating causes R ADIO


ADIO BEACON WMS to search the warehouse’s inventory and
match it against the it ems (products) on the order. By default, R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS allocates
 product in the following sequence:

1. In orde
orderr of packsi
packsize,
ze, from
from larg
largest
est to
to smalle
smallest;
st;

2. In order
order of
of date
date receive
received,
d, from
from oldest
oldest to
to most
most recent
recent (FIFO
(FIFO);
);
ZONE
3. From zone
zone to zone in
in ascending
ascending alphabetical
alphabetical order
order (if multiple
multiple zones are used);
used);

4. From
From bin to
to bin in ascend
ascending
ing alph
alphanu
anumer
merical
ical sequen
sequence.
ce.

However, your system may be configured to use a different default method of allocation, such
as strict receipt dates (packsizes are ignored), or strict packsizes (receipt dates are ignored).
Finally, your system will be configured to use FIFO or LIFO by default, and to allocate
all ocate larger
or smaller packsizes first; however, you can override the latter defaults for individual orders.

1 5 0 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The various options for optimizing the allocation process for specific orders are summarized in
the following table.

Option Use to...


Stock Method Specify one of the following allocation methods:
FIFO (First In First Out) — Stock will be allocated in sequence
 by the date it was received, with oldest stock allocated first.
LIFO (Last In Last Out) — Stock will be allocated in sequence by
the date it was received, with newest stock allocated first.
Deplete Smaller If not enough stock is available in the most efficient standard
Packsize  packsizes, enable this option to allow smaller packsizes to be
allocated instead.
Reserve Minimum If a product has a minimum quantity defined in the database that
must be maintained in the warehouse, enable this option to
 prevent stock from being allocated from the reserved quantity.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE LOCATION REPLENISHMENT


OPTION

LOC If your system supports multiple physical lo cations, you can use the Location option to specify
from which location(s) stock should be allocated.

Option Use to...


Location If R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS is managing multiple locations, specify
the physical location(s) from which stock may be replenished. If
the field is left blank, all locations will be included.

A LL OC A TI N G A ND R E -A LL OC A TI N G W OR K O R DE R S 1 5 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING ATTRIBUTE EXPIRY


REPLENISHMENT OPTIONS

If your warehouse uses expiry dates, lots, or other non-unique attributes, work orders may
 ATT
 ATT specify how products with attribute numbers, or specific expiry dates, should be handled. If the
orders do not specify this information, or if you want to override the settings included in the
orders, you can use the following options to control how products with these attributes should
 be allocated.

Note: Products with unique attributes, such as serial numbers, cannot be allocated to work
orders.

Option Use to...


Attribute and Expiry Specify whether products with different non-unique attribute
Allocation values, expiry dates, and/or multiple packsizes can be mixed in
the same order. Select one of the following options:
Download values — Use the settings specified in each order.

Single Attribute Expiry — Products with different attribute


values, expiry dates, or packsizes can not be mixed in an order.
Multi Attribute/Expiry — Products with different attribute values
and/or expiry dates can be mixed in an order, but only a single
 packsize may be picked for an order.
order.
Multi-Attribute/Unit Split — Products with different attribute
values, expiry dates, and/or packsizes may be mixed in an order.
# Days to Expiry Exclude products from being allocated that will expire within a
certain number of days. Enter the minimum number of days
 before the expiry date. For example, if you enter 365, this will
 prevent any products that expire in less than 365 days from being
allocated to the order(s). 0 indicates that no minimum applies and
that products with any expiry date can be included for allocation.

1 5 2 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE ZONES REPLENISHMENT


OPTIONS

ZONE If your system supports multiple zones, you can specify the zones which should be included
and/or excluded from work order replenishment.

Option Use to...


Include Zones for Specify zones from which product may be replenished for work
Kitting orders, by entering each desired zone, or leave blank to include
all zones. For example, entering ABC will result in R ADIO
BEACON WMS searching only zones A, B, and C for available
 product. Product may exist outside of those defined zones, but
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS will not include those areas in its search
for products. The replenishment will proceed in alphabetical zone
sequence, regardless of the order of l etters you specify, unless
you also select the By Zone Sequence option, described below.
By Zone Sequence Replenish from zone to zone in exact sequence you specify i n the
Include Zones for Kitting fields. For example, if you specify
ACB as include zones, and you select this option, the
replenishment will use this sequence, rather than the normal ABC
alphabetical sequence.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING THE ASSEMBLY LABEL PRINTING


OPTION

You can specify the printer on which assembly labels should


labels should be printed, by using the following
option:

Option Use to...


Printer# Specify a printer on which assembly labels are to be printed. Enter the
number of a single physical printer on which all labels are to be printed
(for information, see “Label and Document Printing” in
Printing”  in Overview of
 RADIO BEACON WMS ) for this group of work orders.

A LL OC A TI N G A ND R E -A LL OC A TI N G W OR K O R DE R S 1 5 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING WORK ORDER ALLOCATION RESULTS

When you are returned to the Orders summary screen, and have refreshed it, the orders you
have attempted to allocate will show their new statuses.

The following table summarizes the possible allocation results for work orders:

Status Explanation
ASSEMBLY - The order(s) have been completely filled from product that is already in
READY the work area defined for the order. Assembly labels are automatically
 printed, so that kitters can begin building the kits.
ASSEMBLY - Component items that are required for the order(s) are not in the required
WAIT work area, but they are available in other bins in the warehouse.
REPLEN Replenishment requests are issued for the component items, and assembly
labels are
labels are automatically printed.
ASSEMBLY - The order(s) contain lines that require products that are currently
SHORT unavailable. Lines that can be filled are allocated, and stock is reserved for
them. However, unlike sales orders, work orders cannot be released as
“shorted”. You
You must either unallocate other orders to free up stock for the
short lines, or simply wait
w ait until the product is received into inventory,
 before re-allocating the order(s).

1 5 4 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNALLOCATING WORK ORDERS


You most typically use the Unallocate action to free up stock from allocated or short work
orders so that it can be re-allocated to higher priority orders that were held because of missing
stock.

You can unallocate orders with any of the following statuses: ASSEMBLY - WAIT
WAIT REPLEN,
ASSEMBLY - SHORT, ASSEMBLY - READY.

When you unallocate orders, the following occurs:

• Stoc
Stock
k tha
thatt was
was res
reser
erve
ved
d is unre
unrese
serv
rved
ed..

• Orders
Orders and
and lines
lines are
are updat
updated
ed with
with the
the status
status ASSEM
ASSEMBL
BLY
Y -UNALLOC
-UNALLOCA
ATED.
TED.

Note: Unallocating READY orders does not rem ove the stock from the work area. However,
that stock can be allocated to other work orders, and even to sales orders.

> To unallocate an order or group of work orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to unallocate. For procedures for selecting orders, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Unallocate. The Unallocate Settings window is displayed.

3. Click Submit, and refresh the display in


display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444.. When all orders have been
 processed, they should be updated with the status of ASSEMBLY -UNALLOCATED.
-UNALLOCATED.

4. Re-allocate
Re-allocate the
the orders
orders when
when approp
appropriate,
riate, by following
following the instruct
instructions
ions in “Allocating and
Re-allocating Work
Work Orders” on page 147
147..

U NA LL OC AT IN G W OR K O RD ER S 1 55
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CANCELLING WORK ORDERS


If you need to cancel a work order, you can use the Nuke action to do so, for work orders in any
status. However, unlike sales orders, work orders cannot be “expedited” by nuking; that is, you
cannot short or automatically pick a work order. If orders are waiting for replenishment from
overstock, the replenishment requests are cleared may be cancelled and the stock unallocated.
However, once component items have been moved to the work area, the Nuke action only
serves to cancel the order; it cannot unallocate or force the component items to be “picked”.

When you Nuke orders, the following occurs:

• If the
the order
order is not
not dele
deleted,
ted, it is
is assig
assigned
ned a wave
wave numb
number
er of
of 997.
997.

• Dependi
Depending
ng on
on the option
optionss you select,
select, orde
orders
rs are
are marked
marked SHIPP
SHIPPED
ED & UPLOAD
UPLOADEDED and
and
removed from the Web Dispatch display; or completely deleted from R ADIO BEACON
WMS and removed from the Web Dispatch display.

The general process for cancelling work orders consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to cancel. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select Nuke.
The Nuke Settings window is displayed.

3. Opt
Option
ionally,
ly, modify nuking options for the order(s). More information about these options
is provided in “Understanding and Modifying Work
Work Order Nuke Options” on page
page 157
157..

4. Perf
Perfor
orm
m the
the nuke
nuke,, and
and refresh the display in
display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures,
see “Gener
“General
al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444..

5. Check the
the results
results of the nuke. The order(s)
order(s) should be removed
removed from
from the Web
Web Dispatch
Dispatch
display.

1 5 6 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING WORK ORDER NUKE OPTIONS

When you use the Nuke action, the Nuke Settings window is displayed. The options in this

window will be populated with default values that have been configured for your
implementation. However, you will need to modify thes e options to handle work orders
appropriately. The options that affect work orders are discussed in the following sections:

• “Understanding and Modifying Order Handling Options”  below.

• “Understanding and Modifying Host System Reporting Options” on page 158


158..

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING ORDER HANDLING OPTIONS

Once kits have been built, you cannot use the Nuke action to “unpick” them. Any kits that have
 been built will remain built, and the component items depleted. Similarly, you cannot “pick”
kits that have not yet been built; you can only leave the component items in the work areas to
 be reallocated to other work orders. Thus, the only options that are valid are as follows:

Option Use to...


Ship Mark already-built kits as built. If the Show Actual Qty option is
also selected (see “Understanding and Modifying Host System
Reporting
Report ing Options”
Options” on page
page 158
158),), the quantity of kits built will be
uploaded to the host system.
Cancel & Unallocate Unallocate the remaining component items from the order and
make them available for other orders.

C AN CE LL IN G W OR K O RD ER S 1 57
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING HOST SYSTEM REPORTING


OPTIONS

You use the Report to Host and Backorder  options


 options to determine how the order(s) will be
uploaded to the host system.

Option Use to...


Show Qty Picked Pass the actual kits built and components depleted to the host
system.
Nuke & Delete Completely remove this order from the R ADIO BEACON
WMS system and do not report anything to the host system.

1 5 8 C H A P T E R 3 P R O C E S S I N G A S S E M B L Y O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4 PROCESSING
PROCESSIN G PACKAGING
PACK
ORDERS

ABOUT PROCESSING PACKAGING ORDERS


Packaging orders are similar to other types of work orders in that they are viewed in the Orders
module, order details are viewed in the Packslip Report screen,
s creen, and so on. However, although
the same pop-up menus and allocation
all ocation screens appear for work orders in Web Dispatch, most
of these options do not actually apply to packaging orders.

One major difference with packaging orders is that you never need to allocate them. R ADIO
BEACON WMS automatically allocates a packaging order once it is created; if there are not
enough units to be allocated to the order, the order cannot be created. This chapter discusses the
different types of packaging orders, the actions, options, and statuses that apply to them, and
special considerations you need to take into account when processing packaging orders. Before
continuing, you are advised to review the chapter “Understanding RADIO BEACON WMS
Processes” in
Processes” in the manual Overview of RADIO BEACON WMS .

The following sections provide conceptual background information on working with


 packaging orders:

• “Understanding Types
Types of Packaging Orders” on page 159
159..

• “Understanding Packaging Order Actions and Statuses” on page 160


160..

UNDERSTANDING TYPES OF PACKAGING ORDERS

Although they are displayed in the Orders module, and use the same Packslip Report screen,
 packaging orders are distinguishable from sales orders by the ASSEMBLY field, which is set
to “YES”, and from other assembly orders by their statuses, which are prefixed with “PKG”.

1 5 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

However, because not all packaging orders are processed in the same way, it is helpful to
recognize the different types of packaging orders that are supported by RADIO BEACON and
managed in Web Dispatch. These are:

• Packagi
Packaging
ng orders
orders create
created
d throug
through
h the Packa
Packagin
ging
g Report
Report or Multi-
Multi-Pac
Pack
k Packagi
Packaging
ng Report
Report..
You create these orders for the packaging candidates that RADIO BEACON identifies as
 being ready to be packaged into formal packsizes, based on various criteria you can
specify, such as the monthly sales velocity, days on hand, replenishment zones, and s o on.
Only the products that meet the criteria you specify, and that are known to have the
required inventory available in overstock, are selected. Procedures for creating packaging
orders from the Packaging reports are provided in “Creating Packaging Orders” on
 page 162
162..

• Packagi
Packagingng orders
orders creat
created
ed throug
throughh the Order
Order Entry
Entry funct
function
ion.. If your
your system
system uses
uses the Order
Order
O/E Entry feature, you can create packaging orders for any product (defined as a packaging
item), in any packsize, in any quantity — provided that the required inventory is actually
available in overstock bins. The Packslip Report for this type of packaging order shows
simply the line item information, without any velocity or days on hand information. The
 process for creating this type of packaging order is described in “Entering Packaging
Orders” on page
page 302
302 of
 of Chapter 9, “Entering Orders”.
Orders” .

UNDERSTANDING PACKAGING ORDER ACTIONS AND STATUSES

You can apply the following actions to packaging orders:

• Package
Package (avai
(availabl
lablee from
from the Packag
Packaging
ing and
and Multi-Pa
Multi-Pack
ck Packag
Packaging
ing repor
reportt screens
screens only)
only)

• Allo
Alloca
cate
te (to real
reallo
loca
cate
te only
only))

• Unallocate

• Nuke

 Note that the Wave, Unwave, Suspend, Unsuspend, and Ship actions do not apply to packaging
packaging
orders.

Note: The actions that are actually available to you will depend on your permissions.

1 6 0 C H A P T E R 4 P R O C E S S I N G P A C K A G I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following sections provide an overview of these actions, the stage in the processing cycle
at which you normally perform them, and the sections in this manual in which they are
described. For an overview of packaging order process steps, see “Understanding Process
Steps”
Steps” on
on page 26
26..

ABOUT THE PACKAGE ACTION

You use the Package action


acti on to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Create packaging orders for  NOT RELEASED “Creating Packaging
candidates identified by the system. Orders” on page
page 162
162..

ABOUT THE ALLOCATE ACTION

You use the Allocate action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Re-allocate packaging orders that PKG - READY TO “Allocating and Re-
were unallocated. The order will move PRINT allocating Work Orders”
 back into the status PKG - READY in Chapter 3,
PKG - BEING BUILT
BUILT
TO PRINT or PKG - BEING BUILT. “Processing Assembly
Orders”.
Orders”. The conditions
and options that apply to
work orders also apply
to packaging orders.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G P AC KA GI NG O RD ER S 1 61
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE UNALLOCATE ACTION

You use the Unallocate action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Unallocate previously allocated PKG - READY TO “Unallocating Work
 packaging orders and free upup reserved PRINT Orders” in
Orders”  in Chapter 3,
stock. You
You should only do this in “Processing Assembly
PKG - BEING BUILT
BUILT
exceptional circumstances. The order Orders”.
Orders”. The conditions
will move into the stat us ASSEMBLY
ASSEMBLY and options that apply to
- UNALLOCATED. work orders also apply
to packaging orders.

ABOUT THE NUKE ACTION

You use the Nuke action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Cancel an order and, optionally, delete any “Cancelling Work
it from RADIO BEACON. Orders” in
Orders”  in Chapter 3,
“Processing Assembly
Orders”.
Orders”. The conditions
and options that apply to
work orders also apply
to packaging orders.

CREATING PACKAGING ORDERS


The first step in creating packaging orders is to generate a Packaging Report. Generating and
using the Packaging Report is described in “W“Working
orking with the Packaging Reports”.
Reports” .

Once you have generated the Packaging Report, you can select the products for which you
actually want to create packaging orders. The process for creating the packaging orders is
described in “Genera
“Generating
ting the Packaging
Packaging Orders” on page 167
167..

1 6 2 C H A P T E R 4 P R O C E S S I N G P A C K A G I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

WORKING WITH THE PACKAGING REPORTS

Each night, the Calculate Demand Requirements function is run in RFBase. This function
examines the sales of every packaging item for the previous month and determines the daily
average number of picks, or velocity,
velocity, per packsize for every product in the warehouse. The data
used to calculate the product/packsize velocity will depend on your configuration. The time
 period of sales data can be one of the following:

• The total
total sales
sales of the
the entire
entire previ
previous
ous month
month.. In this
this case,
case, the veloc
velocity
ity calcu
calculati
lation
on will
will only
actually be updated on the first day of each new month.

• The tota
totall sales
sales of the past
past rollin
rolling
g thirty
thirty days
days.. In this
this case,
case, the velocity
velocity calcula
calculatio
tion
n will be
be
updated every day.

In addition, the sales data may be based on one of the following:

• Actual
Actual packs
packsizes
izes pick
picked.
ed. In
In this
this case,
case, the velo
velocity
city calc
calculat
ulation
ion is
is based
based on the
the packsi
packsizes
zes
which were actually picked and shipped to fulfill sales orders. For example, in a
warehouse that uses formal packsizes of 25 and 100, the velocity will be determined from
the actual number of 25-packs and 100-packs that were sold. If the number of units sold
totals 6025, but 1001 packs of 25 and 40 packs of 100 were sold, the monthly velocity for
25-packs would be 101, and the monthly vel ocity of 100-packs would be 40.

• Potent
Potential
ial packsi
packsizes
zes picke
picked.
d. In this
this case,
case, the velo
velocity
city calc
calcula
ulation
tion is
is based
based the packs
packsizes
izes
which should 
which should  have
 have been picked, assuming an algorithm that judges the largest formal
 packsizes to be the most efficient. The velocity calculation takes the total number of units
 picked and divides it by the most efficient packsizes, from largest to smallest. Thus, for
example, if the packsizes are 25 and 100, and 6025 units were sold, the monthly velocity
for 25-packs would be 1, and the monthly velocity of 100-packs would be 60.

Once the monthly velocity


monthly velocity for each packsize has been calculated, the daily velocity is then
obtained by simply dividing by 30. For example, if the monthly velocity of 100-packs should
 be 60, the daily velocity is 2 packs per day.
day. Finally, the number of expected
expected days on hand for
each packsize is calculated by examining the current inventory of each packsize and dividing
this quantity by the daily velocity. For example, if 2 packs of 100 are expected to be s old every
day, and there are currently 50 packs of 100 in inventory, then the expected number of days on
hand for this packsize is 25.

C RE AT IN G P AC KA GI NG O RD ER S 1 63
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Based on the days-on-hand values that you specify, the Packaging Report generates a list of all
 products in overstock that could be candidates for repackaging into each formal packsize. For
each product, the Packaging Report also identifies the quantity of packs required in order to
meet the expected demand for the current month. When you generate the Packaging Report,
you can limit the products/packsizes according to those with less than a specific number of
days’ worth of inventory, and/or to those stored in a particular zone.

Once you have generated the Packaging Report, you can also view the Multi-Pack Packaging
Report, which lists a subset of the candidates found in the Packaging Report, by limiting the
display to only the products that have packaging candidates in more than one packsize.

> To generate the Packaging Report:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Inven
Inventor
tory
y tab to displ
display
ay the Inve
Invento
ntory
ry Report
Reportss screen.
screen.

3. Next to the Packaging Report selection, in the Days on Hand field, optionally enter the
maximum number of days for which product should be available in a given packsize. For
example, if you only want to list products/packsizes that have less than 10 days’ worth of
inventory,
inventory, enter 10. If you want to list all packaging items, regardless of their inventory
levels, leave the field blank.

4. Opti
Optio
onall
nally
y, in
in the
the Replenishment Zones field, enter each zone (containing overstock
 bins) from which you would like to allocate product for packaging. To To enter more than one
zone, simply enter each letter
let ter representing each zone (do not leave any spaces). To list
 products that are stored in all zones, leave the field blank.

5. If you
you want
want to generate
generate a new report,
report, based on the
the latest
latest velocity
velocity calculations,
calculations, select the
Create New Report checkbox. If you simply want to display the last-generated report,
leave the box unchecked.

1 6 4 C H A P T E R 4 P R O C E S S I N G P A C K A G I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

6. When
When read
ready
y to
to gene
generat
ratee the
the repo
report,
rt, click
click Go. The candidates for packaging table is
displayed, based on the criteria you specified.

Pivot by number of days on hand or by


velocity (per month).

7. Optionally
Optionally,, select an
an alternate
alternate pivot,
pivot, or apply
apply a filter,
filter, if any
any are defined
defined for
for your
your system.
For information on using pivots and filters, see “Using the Orders Summary Screens” on
 page 14
14..

8. Select the packagin


packagingg candidates
candidates you want
want to see in detail by clicking
clicking on the underlined
underlined
number corresponding to the desired number of days on hand, or desired velocity level.
The list of packaging candidates is displayed.

9. Optionally
Optionally,, to view
view only
only the items that
that have
have packaging
packaging candidates
candidates in more than one
one
 packsize, exit the Packaging Report, and from the Inventory Reports screen, next to the
Multi-Pack Packaging Report selection, click Go.

C RE AT IN G P AC KA GI NG O RD ER S 1 65
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The packaging candidates list in both the Packaging and Multi-Pack Packaging Reports
consists of the following parameters:

Parameter Explanation
Units_PVE The total number of units available for packaging in the
selected zone(s).
Pack
ackages
ages Availa
ilable The number of packs alre
lready pack
ackaged into the indicated
ted
formal packsize, that are available (unallocated) in the
warehouse.
Units Total The total number of units available for packaging in the
warehouse (the packageable units in the selected zone, plus
the available units already packaged in the warehouse).
Days on Hand The number of days for which the system expects there to be
inventory available in this packsize, based on the product
velocity.
Velocity The number of packs in this packsize that are expected to be
sold this month.
Can Build The total number of packs in this packsize, that can be built
from units available in the selected zone(s).
Pull Eaches The number of units remaining to be packaged, in order to
meet the velocity requirements for this packsize, after the
total number of units in the selected zone(s) are packaged.
 Note: If this number is negative, it means that there are
already more packages available in this packsize than are
actually needed to meet this month’s velocity requirements.

1 6 6 C H A P T E R 4 P R O C E S S I N G P A C K A G I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GENERATING THE PACKAGING ORDERS

Once you have generated the list of items/packsizes that are appropriate for packaging at this
time, you can further select the items from t he list in either the Packaging Report or Multi-Pack
Packaging Report to generate the actual packaging orders. When you create a packaging order,
the following occurs:

• The orde
orderr is creat
created
ed with
with the status
status PKG
PKG - READY
READY TOTO PRINT
PRINT,, and assig
assigned
ned a four
four-di
-digit
git
number in sequence, with the prefix defined in your configuration, e.g. PACK0004.
PACK0004.

• A new work
work area
area matchi
matching
ng the
the order
order numbe
numberr is autom
automatic
atically
ally created
created and
and assig
assigned
ned to the
the
order.

• The inve
invento
ntory
ry is allo
allocate
cated
d from
from the select
selected
ed zone,
zone, and
and reple
replenish
nishmen
mentt requests
requests are
are
generated.

> To generate a packaging order or group of packaging orders:

1. From the Packaging or Multi-Pack Packaging report screen, select the item(s)  you want to
 package. For procedures for selecting items/orders, see “General Procedures for
Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page
page 44
44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Package. The Package Settings window is displayed.

3. Optionally
Optionally,, modify
modify the packaging
packaging options
options for the
the item(s)
item(s) you are packagin
packaging.
g. More
More
information about these options are provided in “Understanding and Modifying Package
Options”
Options” on page 168
168..

4. Click Submit, and refresh the display in


display  in the Orders summary screen. For procedures, see
“General
“Gener al Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 4444.. When all items have been
 processed, the orders should appear, with the status PKG - READY TO PRINT.
PRINT.

5. If necessary
necessary,, unallocate
unallocate and re-alloc
re-allocate
ate the
the order(s)
order(s) as appropri
appropriate.
ate.

C RE AT IN G P AC KA GI NG O RD ER S 1 67
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING PACKAGE OPTIONS

When you use the Package action, the Package Settings window is displayed.

The options in this screen may be populated with default values that have been configured for
your implementation. However, you can modify the default settings for particular orders or
groups of orders, i f necessary.

Option Use to...


Maximum # Days Specify the maximum number of days’ worth of inventory
that should be built for this packsize, based on the packsize’s
velocity. For example, if the monthly velocity of the product/
 packsize is 18, specifying 30 in this field will order 18
18 packs
of the product; specifying 15 in this field, will order 9 packs
of the product, and specifying 60 days in this field will order
36 packs of this product.
Quantity Override Specify the total number of units which
units which you want to
repackage, regardless of the packsize, velocity, or days on
hand of the item indicated in the candidate record. Normally
you will only use this option in exceptional circumstances.

1 6 8 C H A P T E R 4 P R O C E S S I N G P A C K A G I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING THE PACKAGING ORDER PACKSLIP SCREEN

Once you have generated a packaging order, the Packslip Report screen provides details about
the order and the options you selected when creating it. In addition to the Assembly Info,
which shows you the status of components in the work area (for information, see
“Understanding Work
Work Order Assembly Info”
Info” on page 145
145),), the line details describe the criteria
 by which the order quantities were determined.

Line number  Order information

Packaging item Product to be packaged

Since a packaging order cannot be created unless the product to be packaged is actually
available in the required quantities, the product lines always show the overstock bins from
which the product is to be replenished, in blue. A series of comment lines display t he following
order information:

Line Description Explanation


Number
.001 Days On Hand The number of days the product is expected to be on
hand in this packsize, based on the current velocity
calculations.

C RE AT IN G P AC KA GI NG O RD ER S 1 69
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Line Description Explanation


Number
.002 Velocity The number of packs in this packsize that are expected
to be sold in the current month, based on the current
velocity calculations.
.003 On Hand The current number of packs in inventory in this
 packsize.
.004 Max Days On Hand The number of days onon hand you selected when you
generated the order.
.005 # Cartons The number of packs that are required in this packsize to
meet the current month’s demand. This value is obtained
 by multiplying the daily velocity for this packsize by the
maximum number of days on hand you sel ected, and
then subtracting the of packs in this packsize already
existing in inventory.
inventory.
.007 Total Quantity-To- The number of packs to build (this is the # Cartons
Build value rounded up to the nearest integer).

1 7 0 C H A P T E R 4 P R O C E S S I N G P A C K A G I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

5 PROCESSING PURCHASE
ORDERS AND RETURNS

ABOUT PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS


Receiving details and report screens allow you to process purchase orders, transfer purchase
orders and non-P.O. receipts by applying actions to
actions to them. These actions take the orders through
the processing cycle described throughout “The Warehouse Process Cycle” in
Cycle”  in Overview of
 RADIO BEACON WMS . You You may wish to review that
t hat chapter before continuing.

The following sections provide conceptual background information on working with purchase
orders:

• “Understanding Purchase Order Actions and Statuses”


Statuses” on page 172
172..

• “Understanding the Purchase Order Report Screen” on page 173


173..

• “Understanding Types
Types of Purchase Orders” on page 175
175..

• “Additional Purchase Order Processing Functions” on page 176


176..

1 7 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING PURCHASE ORDER ACTIONS AND STATUSES

The actions that appear on the pop-up menu in the Receiving details and report screens are
used to process purchase orders and move them through the warehouse cycle:

• Release Order 

• Complete PO

• Delete PO

Note: The actions that are actually available to you will depend on your permissions.

The following sections provide an overview of the actions that you can apply to purchase
orders, the stage in the processing cycle at which you normally perform them, and the sections
in this chapter in which they are described. For an overview of purchase order process steps,
see “Under
“Understandin
standingg Process Steps” on page 26
26..

ABOUT THE RELEASE ORDER ACTION

You use the Release Order action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
O/E If your system is configured to require APPROVED “Releasing Purchase
it, release purchase orders you have Orders” on page
page 177
177..
entered through Web Dispatch for
receipt into the warehouse.

172 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE COMPLETE PO ACTION

You use the Complete PO action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Close purchase orders and
orders and upload the BEING RECEIVED “Closing Purchase
receipt confirmations to the host Orders” on page
page 178
178..
system.

ABOUT THE DELETE PO ACTION

You use the Delete PO action to do the following:

Use to... Apply to orders in Described in...


this status...
Cancel a purchase order  and
 and delete it any “Cancelling or
from the database. Expediting Purchase
Orders” on page
page 179
179..
Expedite an order by bypassing any “Cancelling or
normal processing steps. Expediting Purchase
Orders” on page
page 179
179..

UNDERSTANDING THE PURCHASE ORDER REPORT SCREEN

The PO/Manifest Report screen tells you all the details about an order, and is helpful for
monitoring and troubleshooting a purchase order from the moment it is downloaded, to the
time when you or a receiver need to close it.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G P UR CH AS E O RD ER S 1 73
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

In addition to order statuses, the lines on purchase orders are also marked with statuses, which
are displayed on PO Report screens once the orders begin to be processed. If you are closing
 purchase orders in Web
Web Dispatch, you will want to view the line results, so that you can see if
the purchase orders have been completely received or not.

Line number  Product ordered for that line Line status

Depending on your configuration, line statuses may be marked with the following codes:

Status Explanation
Indicator
none The line has not yet been received.
S The line has been received complete or the line has been received short,
 but has been marked as complete by the receiver or by the dispatcher with
the Delete PO action (see “Understanding and Modifying Unreceived
Goods Options”
Options” on
on page 181
181).
).
I The line has been received short and has been marked as incomplete by the
receiver or by the dispatcher with the Delete PO action.
B The line has been received short and has been marked as requiring the
missing items to be back ordered by the receiver or by the dispatcher with
the Delete PO action.

 Note that, if you have the appropriate permissions, you can also directly add, delete, and edit an
order line from
line  from this screen, if changes need to be made to the order since it was downloaded.
For information on editing orders, see “Editing or Deleting Purchase Order Line Details” on
 page 265
265..

174 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UNDERSTANDING TYPES OF PURCHASE ORDERS

Because not all purchase orders are processed in the same way
w ay,, it is helpful to
t o recognize the
different types of sales orders that are supported by R ADIO BEACON and managed in Web
Dispatch. These include:

• Purcha
Purchase
se orde
orders
rs issue
issued
d by the host
host system
system and downlo
downloade
aded
d into
into R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS.
These follow any numbering convention determined by your setup. They will show vendor
information in the PO Report.

• Back
Back orders
orders autom
automatic
aticall
ally
y create
created
d by the
the host
host system.
system. These
These foll
follow
ow the
the number
numbering
ing
convention determined by your host system.

• Back
Back orde
orders
rs that
that are
are autom
automati
atica
cally
lly crea
created
ted by R ADIO
ADIO BEACON for previous purchase orders
that were received short. These are numbered in the same way as the original orders from
which they are generated, with the extension -n where n indicates the number of the back
order (e.g. 1, 2, etc.).

• Purcha
Purchase
se orders
orders enter
entered
ed throug
through
h the Web
Web Dispat
Dispatch
ch Order
Order Entry
Entry funct
function
ion.. These
These are
O/E automatically numbered in sequence, with 10 digits, starting with 0000000001, or they
may be numbered by the user at order entry. Depending on your configuration, you may
need to release these
release these orders before they can be received.

• Return
Return mater
materials
ials auth
authori
orizati
zations
ons (RMA
(RMAs)
s) downl
download
oaded
ed from
from the
the host
host system.
system. Thes
Thesee may
follow any numbering convention determined by your set up.

• RMAs
RMAs entered
entered throu
through
gh the Web
Web Dispatch
Dispatch.. These
These are automa
automatica
tically
lly numbe
numbered
red in seque
sequence
nce,,
RMA with 6 digits, starting with 000001, and prefixed with an “R”. The PO Report screen for
these orders also displays the original sales order number against which the items were
shipped, the customer, reasons for the return, and various other handling information.

• Non-PO
Non-PO receip
receipts.
ts. If your
your wareh
warehous
ousee allows
allows non-PO
non-PO receiv
receiving
ing,, these
these orders
orders are
are number
numbered
ed
 by the user at receiving. The PO Report screen for these receipts will not show any vendor
information, but will show the miscellaneous adjustments that were created for each
 product received, as this is how these receipts are actually processed. Each adjustment is
identified with the code “RV” indicating that it was a non-PO receipt, and the inventory
adjustment listed as a “plus”, indicating that the inventory was increased by the displayed
quantity.

A BO UT P RO CE SS IN G P UR CH AS E O RD ER S 1 75
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• Transf
Transfer
er purch
purchase
ase order
orderss are used
used to receiv
receivee goods
goods into the
the destina
destination
tion ware
warehou
house,
se, when
when
using the warehouse transfer function to transfer products from one warehouse site to
LOC
another, via a transit site. Transfer purchase orders are, for the most part, processed
identically to regular purchase orders from the perspective of the dispatcher and the
warehouse staff. These orders are easy to distinguish in Web Dispatch by the TRANS
 prefix for all process steps.

ADDITIONAL PURCHASE ORDER PROCESSING FUNCTIONS

Additional functions that are available in Web Dispatch for processing purchase orders include:
RECV

• Creatin
Creating
g contain
container
er refere
reference
ncess for multip
multiple
le purcha
purchase
se orders.
orders. For
For inform
informatio
ation,
n, see “Creating
Container
Contain er References”
References” on page 182
182..

RMA • Enterin
Entering
g returne
returned
d material
materialss authori
authorizat
zation
ionss (RMAs)
(RMAs) against
against uplo
uploade
aded
d sales
sales orders.
orders. For
For
information, see “Enter
“Entering
ing RMAs” on on page 186
186..

• ‘Receiv
‘Receive’
e’ purcha
purchase
se orders
orders or conta
container
inerss with Web
Web Dispatc
Dispatch
h rather
rather than
than using
using the handhe
handheld.
ld.
For information, see “‘Receiving’ a Purchase Order in Web
Web Dispatch” on page 188 188..

• Create
Create a Transf
Transferer Purcha
Purchase
se Order
Order in Web
Web Dispatc
Dispatchh against
against a purchas
purchasee order/c
order/cont
ontain
ainer
er..
LOC When creating a transfer purchase order, you specify a transit warehouse, instead of
specific bins, into which products are to be received. For information, see “Creating
Transfer Purchase Orders in Web Dispatch” on page 190 190..

176 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

RELEASING PURCHASE ORDERS


If you create purchase orders in Web Dispatch’s Order Entry function (for information, see
O/E “Entering
“Enteri ng Purchase Orders”
Orders” on page 297
297),
), your system may be configured to initially assign
them the status APPROVED If this is the case, before these orders can actually be received by
warehouse staff, the dispatcher must release them.

When you release purchase orders, the following occurs:

• Orde
Orders
rs are
are plac
placed
ed int
into
o the
the statu
statuss of NOT
NOT RECE
RECEIV
IVED
ED..

• Orde
Orders
rs are
are made
made availa
availabl
blee to ware
wareho
hous
usee staff
staff for
for rece
receip
ipt.
t.

The process for releasing orders consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to release. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Release Order . The Release Order Settings window is displayed.

3. Optionally
Optionally,, to print
print a Crystal Report
Report of the purchase
purchase order,
order, enable
enable the Print Report check
 box.

4. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, ente
enterr a handle for
handle for the order(s) you are releasing.

5. Perf
Perfor
orm
m the
the rele
releas
ase,
e, and
and refresh the display in
display in the Receiving summary screen. For
 procedures, see “Genera
“Generall Procedures
Procedures for Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44
44.. When all orders
have been processed, they should be updated with the status of NOT RECEIVED.

R EL EA SI NG P UR CH AS E O RD ER S 1 77
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CLOSING PURCHASE ORDERS


Your warehouse will have a policy
p olicy on who should close purchase
purchas e orders once they have been
received: the dispatcher or the receivers. In many warehouses, receivers will simply close
 purchase orders as they receive them. In other warehouses, it may be the dispatcher’s job to
close all the purchase orders in a batch at the end of the day.

When you close purchase orders, the following occurs:

• Receip
Receiptt conf
confir
irma
matio
tions
ns are
are uplo
upload
aded
ed to
to the
the host
host syste
system.
m.

• The orde
orders
rs are
are made
made unavai
unavailab
lable
le to ware
warehou
house
se staff
staff for furt
further
her proc
processi
essing.
ng.

Note: Be sure that all lines on a purchase order with the status BEING RECEIVED have
 been received before closing it. To verify the receipt of all line items, simply view the
report screen for the purchase order, and
order,  and be sure that all lines have a status recorded
for them (see “Understanding the Purchase Order Report Screen” on page 173 173).). You
may also wish to run one of the various Receiving reports to
reports  to quickly see the status of
POs; for information, see “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221 221..

> To close purchase orders:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to release. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Complete PO. The Complete PO Settings window is displayed.

3. Perfo
Perform
rm the
the comp
comple
letio
tion,
n, and
and refresh the display in
display in the Receiving summary screen. For
 procedures, see “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44.. When all orders
have been processed, they should be removed from the display (or marked with the status
READY TO UPLOAD, if your system is not configured to automatically upload receipts
to the host).

178 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CANCELLING OR EXPEDITING PURCHASE ORDERS


 Deleting  a
 a purchase order is an exceptional way of handling a purchase order in Web Dispatch
at any point. Deleting can actually accomplish two different functions for different
circumstances:

• The first
first impl
impleme
ementat
ntation
ion of
of “delete
“delete”” cancels
cancels the
the purch
purchase
ase orde
orderr and remo
removes
ves it from
from
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS; it is used in the case where you want to cancel a purchase order
and it is too late or inefficient to cancel it from the host system.

• The secon
second d implemen
implementat
tation
ion of “del
“delete”
ete” actu
actually
ally expe
expedite
ditess the purch
purchase
ase order
order by
by bypassi
bypassing
ng
all of the normal R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS process
 WMS process steps, and reporting the quantity of
 product received to the host system. You
You may want to use this option to process rush or
urgent items for immediate outbound shipment, or to handle any purchase orders manually
rather than by having them pass through the normal receiving and putty steps.

Note: Your system will have configured the Delete action


acti on to either cancel or expedite orders
 by default. If you need to handle an order differently,
differently, be sure to modify the
appropriate deletion options, as described below.

When you delete purchase orders, the following occurs:

• Depend
Depending
ing on
on the optio
options
ns you
you select,
select, purc
purchas
hasee orders
orders are
are receive
received
d and mark
marked
ed READY
READY
TO UPLOAD (in most implementations, this status is not displayed, as receipt
confirmations are automatically uploaded to the host system), or orders are cancelled and
deleted from R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS and removed from the Web Dispatch display.

C A NC E LL IN G O R E X PE D IT I NG P U RC H AS E O RD E RS 1 7 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The general process for cancelling or expediting consists of the following steps:

1. Select the order(s) you


order(s)  you want to release. For procedures for selecting orders, see “General
Procedures
Proced ures for Processing
Processing Orders”
Orders” on page 44 44..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select
Delete PO. The Delete PO Settings window is displayed.

3. Opt
Option
ionally,
ly, modify deletion options for
options  for the order(s). More information about these options
are provided in “Understanding and Modifying Delete Options” on page 180 180..

4. Perf
Perfor
orm
m the
the del
delet
etio
ion,
n, and
and refresh the display in
display  in the Receiving summary screen. For
 procedures, see “General Procedures for Processing Orders” on page 44 44.. When all orders
have been processed, they should be removed from the display (or marked with the status
READY TO UPLOAD, if your system is not configured to automatically upload receipts
to the host).

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING DELETE OPTIONS

When you use the Delete PO action, the Delete PO Settings window is displayed.

The options in this screen will be populated with default values that have been configured for
your implementation. However, you can modify any of the default settings for particular orders
or groups of orders, if necessary.

180 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

All the options available in this screen are discussed in the following sections:

• “Understanding and Modifying Host System Reporting Options” on page 181


181..

• “Understanding and Modifying Unreceived Goods Options” on page 181


181..

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING HOST SYSTEM


REPORTING OPTIONS

You use the Report to Host options to determine how the order(s) will be uploaded to the host
system. If you want to completely cancel the order(s), you will normally want to delete the
order(s) from R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS. If you want to expedite the order(s), you will normally
want to upload receipt confirmations to the host system.

Option Use to...


Upload Pass the actual quantities received to the host system.
Delete Completely remove this order from R ADIO
ADIO BEACON
WMS and do not report anything to the host system.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING UNRECEIVED GOODS OPTIONS

You use the Unreceived Goods options to determine how unreceived items on the order(s) are
to be handled. If you want to completely cancel the order(s), you will normally want to simply
mark all goods as complete. If you are expediting the order(s), you will normally want to mark
the unreceived goods according to the appropriate handling method used by your warehouse.

Option Use to...


Mark as Complete Mark the order as complete. No further processing is needed.
Mark as Incomplete Mark the order as incomplete, but do not automatically issue a
 back order. Unreceived goods will be handled manually.
manually.
Mark as Backordered Automatically create a back order for unreceived goods.
 Note: Your
Your system must be configured to allow R ADIO
ADIO BEACON
WMS to create back orders for your warehouse.
Receive and Add Receive the unreceived goods into inventory.

C A NC E LL IN G O R E X PE D IT I NG P U RC H AS E O RD E RS 1 8 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CREATING CONTAINER REFERENCES


Many warehouses normally receive goods by containers containing multiple purchase orders.
RECV Often the container reference number will be included i n the purchase orders downloaded from
the host system. However, you can also use Web
Web Dispatch to create a container reference
number for multiple orders. This will allow receivers to receive all of these orders in a wave,
according to the container reference number, rather than according to each individual purchase
order number.

When you create a container, you can add orders from different vendors t o the same container.
You do not need to add all lines or all quantities on a selected purchase order to the container.
Instead, you can create containers consisting of only selected lines and even partial quantities
from selected purchase orders. If you or your receiving staff close purchase orders that are still
awaiting receipt of remaining lines on other containers, a back order for the remaining lines
will automatically be created and downloaded to R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS for receipt.

Note: If you add the same lines or quantities from one purchase order to multiple containers,
the lines are only actually added to the last container to which you add them and will
automatically be removed from containers to which you added them previously.

> To create a container reference:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Recei
Receivin
ving
g tab to displa
display
y the Recei
Receivin
ving
g Reports
Reports scree
screen.
n.

182 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Next to the Create a Container  selection,


 selection, click Go. The Create a Container screen is
displayed.

4. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, in
in the
the Container  field,
 field, enter a number for this container, or leave the field
 blank to have R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS automatically create the container number for you.

5. Option
Optionally
ally enter
enter any
any requi
required
red info
informa
rmatio
tion
n in the
the Vessel No, Date Left Port, Status and
Est. Arrive Date fields.

6. From the Vendor  drop-down


 drop-down list, select a vendor from which you want to select purchase
orders. When you select a vendor, the Available Orders field is displayed, containing a
drop-down list of purchase orders for the selected vendor.

C RE AT IN G C ON TA IN ER R EF ER EN CE S 1 83
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

7. From the Available Orders drop-down list, select a purchase order containing the line(s)
you want to add to the container. The order details display.

Any previously received quantities display in the Qty Received field.

8. To select
select lines
lines to add to the
the container
container,, do one of
of the following:
following:

• To selec
selectt all
all line
liness and
and quan
quantiti
tities
es for
for this
this order
order,, click
click Select All.

• To sele
select
ct a par
partia
tiall qua
quanti
ntity
ty of a lin
line,
e, in the
the Qty Split field, enter the quantity you want.
To deselect a line, in the Qty Split field, enter 0.

184 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

9. When
When you areare ready
ready to add the
the selecte
selected
d lines
lines to the conta
containe
iner,
r, click
click Add Selected. The
selected line items appear in the Result portion of the screen.

10.
10. Repe
Repeat
at steps
steps 6 to 9 to select additional vendors, orders and/or line items to add to the
container.

11. Click Create Container . If you left the Container Number  field


 field blank, you are prompted
to confirm whether you want R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS to create the container number for
you. Click OK.

The container is created, the container reference number and contents of the container are
displayed.

> To view information for a container you have created:

1. In the Reports
Reports module,
module, click
click the
the Receiving
Receiving tab
tab to display the Receiving
Receiving Reports
Reports screen.
screen.

C RE AT IN G C ON TA IN ER R EF ER EN CE S 1 85
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• Next to the View Container  selection,


 selection, in the Container  field,
 field, enter the container
number, and click Go.

• Next to the Container Lookup selection, in the PO or Vendor  fields,


 fields, enter the PO
and/or vendor number, respectively,
respectively, for the container you want to
t o look up, and click
Go. A list of containers for the selected vendor or PO is displayed.

The container information is displayed, as described in “View Container Report” on


 page 228
228..

ENTERING RMAS
If your warehouse uses returned materials authorizations (RMAs) to allow customers to return
RMA  products, you can use the RMA feature to automatically generate purchase orders for the
returned items, with the appropriate RMA codes. You can only create RMAs against sales
orders that have already been uploaded.

Your configuration will include a number


n umber of reason codes for which an RM A may be issued,
such as product damage, defects, and so on. Each of these reasons will also determine
additional options, such as whether a restocking charge applies, the customer should be
credited, replacement items should be shipped, and whether the customer should be re-
invoiced.

186 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To enter an RMA:

1. To open the
the Packslip
Packslip Report
Report screen
screen for the uploaded
uploaded sales order
order for
for which you want
want to
create the RMA, do any of the following:

• In the
the Report
Reportss module,
module, click
click the Pick
Picking
ing tab
tab to displa
display
y the Pick
Picking
ing Repo
Reports
rts scree
screen,
n,
and next to the Packslip Report entry, in the Packslip field, enter the number of the
sales order, and click Go.

• In the
the Report
Reportss module,
module, click
click the Pick
Picking
ing tab
tab to displa
display
y the Pick
Picking
ing Repo
Reports
rts scree
screen,
n,
and next to the Uploaded Shipments entry, enter the date on which the order was
shipped in the Start Date and End Date fields, and click Go. From the Uploaded
Shipments Reports screen, click the order number.

• From
From the Custo
Customer
mer Repo
Report
rt scree
screen,
n, in the list
list of comp
complete
leted
d orders
orders,, under
under the
the Packslip
heading, click the order number.

2. In the
the Packs
Packslip
lip Rep
Repor
ortt scree
screen,
n, clic
click
k the RMA button. The RMA Issue screen is displayed,
with the line items from the sales order, and the original quantities shipped.

E N T E R I N G R M A S 1 8 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Next
Next to each
each line
line contain
containing
ing prod
product
uct to
to be retur
returned
ned,, from
from the Reason drop-down list,
select a reason for which the product is being returned. The Restock Fee, Credit Now, and
Re-Invoice fields are automatically populated, according t o the defaults that are defined in
your configuration for each reason.

Note: Any lines for which you do not provide a reason are not included in the RMA.

4. Optionally
Optionally,, if the quantity
quantity to be return
returned
ed for any
any line is less than
than the original
original quantity
quantity
ordered, in the Qty to Return field, enter the actual quantity to be returned.

5. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, if you need
need to
to modi
modify
fy the Restock Fee, Credit Now, and Re-invoice fields,
enter the appropriate values next to the appropriate lines.

6. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, if new
new items
items need
need to
to be ship
shipped
ped,, in the
the Re-ship Qty field, enter the quantity to
 be shipped next to the appropriate lines.

7. In the Return Properties section, optionally, enter any special instructions for this order
and any of the payment on delivery or shipping and handling options.

8. Click Confirm to complete the order. A new purchase order is created and displayed. The
order is also displayed in the Receiving summary screen with the status NOT RECEIVED.

‘RECEIVING’ A PURCHASE ORDER IN


WEB DISPATCH
The Quick Purchase Order Completion function allows you to ‘receive’ products on a purchase
order or container with Web Dispatch, rather than using the handheld. This may be useful in
situations where handhelds are not available. After the purchase order/container is received
manually, use Quick Purchase Order Completion to record the bins t o which the products and
quantities were received. Each line in the purchase order must be received to a single bin, i.e.,
you can’t split the quantity received into different bins using Quick Purchase Order
Completion.

188 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

You can complete purchase orders that are in NOT RECEIVED or BEING RECEIVED status.

> To receive a transfer purchase order/contai ner in Web Dispatch:

1. Go to the Repo
Reports
rts modu
module
le and
and click
click the
the Receiv
Receiving
ing tab.
tab.

2. Next to the Quick Purchase Order Completion selection do one of the following:

• In the PO field, enter the purchase order number, or 

RECV • In the Container field enter the container number of a container reference created
with the Create a Container function (or downloaded from the host).

3. Click Go. The Quick Purchase Order Completion screen for the order is displayed.

Any items were previously received are displayed in the Qty Received field.

4. In the Packsize field, enter the packsize in which the product arrived.

5. In the Qty Received field, enter the actual quantity


quantit y you want to receive now. You
You can
receive a partial quantity or over-receive a quantity greater than the ordered quantity.

‘ R EC E IV I NG ’ A P U RC H AS E O R DE R I N W EB D I SP A TC H 1 8 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

6. In the Bin Label field, enter the bin into which the product was received. Your
Your system may
have been pre-configured with a default for this bin.

7. Click Confirm when you are satisfied that the information you entered is correct.

When you click Confirm, the purchase order is completed. Receipt confirmations (or stock
move transaction in the case of transfer purchase orders) are uploaded to the host system, and
the order is unavailable to warehouse staff for further processing. The purchase order is
removed from the display (or marked with the status READY TO UPLOAD, if your system is
not configured to automatically upload receipts to the host).

CREATING TRANSFER PURCHASE ORDERS IN


WEB DISPATCH
Quick Purchase Order Completion can be used to ‘receive’ the products in a purchase order or
LOC container to a ‘transit’ warehouse, rather than to specific bins in the warehouse. When you use
Quick Purchase Order Completion in this way, it creates a transfer purchase order, against
which the products can be received later in detail, without creating duplicate receipt
confirmations for the host.

You can create transfer purchase orders for purchase orders that are in NOT RECEIVED or
BEING RECEIVED status.

> To create a transfer purchase:

1. Go to the
the Repor
Reports
ts modul
modulee and click
click the
the Receiv
Receiving
ing tab.
tab.

2. Next to the Quick Purchase Order Completion selection do one of the following:

• In the PO field, enter the purchase order number, or 

RECV • In the Container field enter the container number of a container reference created
with the Create a Container function (or downloaded from the host).

190 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Click Go. The Quick Purchase Order Completion screen for the order is displayed.

4. In the Packsize field, enter the packsize in which the product arrived.

5. The Qty Received field, the actual quantity you want to receive now. You can receive a
 partial quantity or over-receive a quantity greater than the ordered quantity.
quantity.

6. Leave the Bin Label field empty.

7. Select the Create Transfer PO checkbox.

8. In the To Warehouse field, enter the destination warehouse.

9. Click Confirm when you are satisfied that the information you entered is correct

When you click Confirm, the original purchase order(s) is ready to be uploaded to the host. A
new transfer purchase order is created and displays in the Receiving module in TRANSNOT
RECEIVED status.

C R EA TI N G T R AN S FE R P U RC H AS E O R DE RS I N W E B D I SP A TC H 1 91
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

192 C H A P T E R 5 PROCESSING PURCHASE ORDERS AND RETURNS


U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

6 USING INCIDENTS

ABOUT INCIDENTS
 Incidents are
 Incidents are used as communication
communicati on tools within the warehouse to notify Web Dispatch users
of any issue regarding a customer or order, to alert them to problems, or assign them tasks
which must be followed up on. Typically, incidents are used by customer service
representatives or other “front-office” users to communicate with the Web dispatcher. In a
warehouse with several dispatchers, they may be used by one dispatcher to assign tasks to
another. Creating incidents is discussed in “Creat
“Creating
ing and Assigning Incidents”
Incidents” on page 193
193..

Once an incident has been assigned to a dispatcher, it is automatically displayed in his/her


instance of Web Dispatch, and will remain displayed until s/he deals with it in an appropriate
manner, by re-assigning it, resolving it, or closing it. Handling incidents is discussed in
“Viewing and Responding to Incidents” on page 196 196..

CREATING AND ASSIGNING INCIDENTS


You use the Incidents module to create incidents for orders, customers, vendors, and even
 products, if necessary. You
You can only assign an incident to one user at a time; the user must be
configured by the system to be assigned incidents. The user who is assigned the incident must
address it or re-assign it
i t to another user. To
To create an incident, follow the procedure in
“Creating
“Creating an Incident”
Incident” on page 194
194..

You can also use the Incidents module to view a lis t of all incidents you have created and
assigned; follow the procedure in “Viewing Incidents
Incidents You
You Have Assigned” on page 195 195..

1 9 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CREATING AN INCIDENT

> To create and assign an incident:

1. From
From the
the nav
navig
igati
ation
on bar
bar, clic
click
k Incidents to open the Incidents module.

2. From
From the Incid
Inciden
ents
ts summ
summar
ary
y, click
click New Incident. A new incident is opened in the Incident
Editor, with the status OPEN.

1 9 4 C H A P T E R 6 U S I N G I N C I D E N T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Enter
Enter inform
informatio
ation
n in any or all
all of the
the followin
following
g option
optional
al fields:
fields:

Field Enter...
Product The product name or number, if relevant.
Customer The customer number, if not already populated.
Number 
Vendor The vendor number, if not already populated.
Number 
Packslip The sales order number, if not already populated.
PO# The purchase order number, if not already populated.
Description A brief description of the issue.
Notes A more detailed description of the issue.
Client Name The client/company to which this incident applies (only used for
multi-company or 3PL implementations).
Priority Text or code identifying the priority of the incident, e.g. “high”, “1”,
etc.

4. From the Assigned To drop-down list, select the name of the user to whom you want to
assign the incident.

5. Click Submit to save and assign the incident. A unique number is assigned to the incident.
Your user name is automatically populated in the Opened by field and current date is the
Created On date in the History field.

The incident will be displayed


displa yed on the addressee’s Orders and Receiving summary screens
when they log on to Web Dispatch.

VIEWING INCIDENTS YOU HAVE ASSIGNED


AS SIGNED

> To list all open incidents you have assigned:

1. Go to
to the Inci
Inciden
dents
ts modu
module
le,, and
and from
from the
the List Incidents drop-down list, select List
Created Incidents. A list of all the open incidents you have assigned is displayed.

2. To view details
details for
for an incident,
incident, click
click the incident
incident number
number of the incident
incident you want
want to view
view..

C RE AT IN G A ND A SS IG NI NG I NC ID EN TS 1 95
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

VIEWING AND RESPONDING TO INCIDENTS


To view the incidents t hat have been assigned to you, follow the procedure in “Viewing
Incidents Assigned to You”
You” on page 196
196..

To respond to incidents that have been assigned to


t o you, follow the procedure in “Responding to
an Incident”
Incident” on page 197
197..

VIEWING INCIDENTS ASSIGNED TO YOU

A list of all open incidents assigned to you is always displayed on the Orders and Receiving
summary screens. Lists of open incidents that pertain to a specific sales/work/transfer sales
order, purchase order, customer,
customer, vendor, or product are also displayed on th e relevant Packslip,
Purchase Order, Customer, Vendor,
Vendor, or Product Report screens.

> To view details of an incident assigned to you:

1. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, go to the
the Incide
Incidents
nts modu
module,
le, and
and from
from the
the List Incidents drop-down list, select
Assigned Incidents. A list of all open incidents assigned to you is displayed.

2. From the
the list of incidents
incidents in the Incidents
Incidents module,
module, the Orders
Orders or
or Receiving
Receiving summary
screen, or a Packslip, Purchase Order, Vendor,
Vendor, Customer, or Product Report screen, click
the number of the incident you want to view.

3. To respond
respond to
to the incid
incident
ent,, use any
any of the
the options
options descr
described
ibed in
in “Responding to an Incident”
on page
page 19
197
7.

1 9 6 C H A P T E R 6 U S I N G I N C I D E N T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

RESPONDING TO AN INCIDENT

To respond to an incident, you have several options:

• Simply
Simply add
add a comme
comment nt to it. When
When you upda
update
te the
the incide
incident,
nt, the
the new
new commen
commentt will
will be
displayed in the Incident Report.

• Reassig
Reassignn it to anoth
another
er user
user.. When
When you upda
update
te the
the incide
incident,
nt, the
the record
record will
will be remo
removed
ved
from your display and from your list of assigned incidents. The incident will appear in the
display for the user to whom you reassigned it.

• Resolv
Resolvee it. When
When you
you update
update the
the incid
incident,
ent, the
the recor
record
d will be
be display
displayed
ed with
with the
the status
status of
RESOLVED.

• Close
Close it. When
When you
you updat
updatee the incid
incident
ent,, the recor
record
d will be
be remove
removed
d from
from your
your display
display and
and
from that of the person who assigned it.

Your warehouse policy should determine who may exercise which actions,
actions , and when it is
appropriate to close incidents once they have been dealt with.

All of the options for handling an incident are described in the following procedure.

V IE WI NG A ND R ES PO ND IN G T O I NC ID EN TS 1 97
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To respond to an incident:

1. From the
the list of incidents
incidents in the Incidents
Incidents module,
module, the Orders
Orders or
or Receiving
Receiving summary
screen, or a Packslip, Purchase Order, Vendor,
Vendor, Customer, or Product Report screen, click
the number of the incident you want to process. Incident Editor is displayed.

2. In the Notes field, enter a comment describing how you have resolved, or will resolve the
 problem. When you submit the incident, the previous notes will display in the History
section as Old Notes.

3. If you
you need
need to modi
modify
fy the
the descri
descripti
ption,
on, you
you may
may do so in the Description field. When you
submit the incident, the previous description will display in the History section as Old
Description.

1 9 8 C H A P T E R 6 U S I N G I N C I D E N T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. Do any
any of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To mark
mark the incide
incident
nt as RESO
RESOLLVED, and allow
allow it to remain
remain visib
visible
le in the
the Web
Web
Dispatch display, from the Status drop-down list, select Resolved.

• To close
close the inciden
incident,
t, and
and remove
remove it from
from the system,
system, from
from the
the Status drop-down list,
select Closed. In the Date Closed field, enter the date, in MM/DD/YYYY format.

• To rea
reass
ssig
ign
n the
the inci
incide
dent
nt,, fro
from
m the
the Assigned To field, select the user ID of the person
to whom you want to re-assign the incident.

5. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Submit. The incident will be updated according to the options you
selected, and all changes are documented in the History section.

V IE WI NG A ND R ES PO ND IN G T O I NC ID EN TS 1 99
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2 0 0 C H A P T E R 6 U S I N G I N C I D E N T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

7 GENERATING REPORTS

ABOUT REPORTS, MONITORS, AND LOGS


The Reports module in Web Dispatch provides you with several tools for monitoring current
warehouse activity and gathering historical and statistical data.

2 0 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The Reports module is divided into seven screens, as follows:

• Picking —
Picking — provides access to reports and functions related to sales orders.

• Receiving —
Receiving — Provides access to reports and functions related to purchase orders.

• Inventory —
Inventory — provides access to reports and functions related to products, license plates
and warehouse locations.

FCAST • Forecasting — If this is enabled for your system, provides access to reports and functions
related to forecasting and inventory management. These reports are discussed in a separate
document called “ Demand Forecasting ”. ”.

• Performance —
Performance  — provides access to reports related to warehouse operations.

• Miscellaneous —
Miscellaneous  — Provides access to reports related to system maintenance and reporting,
inventory management, and functions related to product maintenance.

O/E • Order
Order Entry
Entry — If this
this is enab
enabled
led for
for your
your syste
system,
m, provid
provides
es access
access to orde
orderr entry
entry funct
function
ion..
Described in Chapter 9, “Entering Orders”.

• Custom
Custom — provid
provides
es the abilit
ability
y to genera
generate
te report
reportss that have
have been
been define
defined
d specifi
specifical
cally
ly for
your warehouse in your system setup.

• Crystal
Crystal — Prov
Provide
idess access
access to repor
reports
ts genera
generated
ted by
by the Crys
Crystal
tal Repo
Reports
rts appl
applicat
ication
ion..

• Waiting
aiting — Lists
Lists all
all Cryst
Crystal
al repo
reports
rts that
that have
have been
been gener
generated
ated..

Note: The reports discussed in this chapter represent most of the commonly used reports in
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS. The actual lists of reports that you see depends on your
 permissions, configuration and site customizations.

2 0 2 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ABOUT THE STANDARD REPORTS

The standard reports that are generated through the Picking, Receiving, Inventory,
Performance, and Miscellaneous screens are of several types:

• Summary re
reports

These reports list groups of entities according to a selected criterion, such as a specific
date or period of time; provide overview information for each entity; and typically let you
link to other, more detailed reports. Summary-type reports are only available from the
Reports module. Examples of summary reports include the Order Consolidation Report,
which lists customers with multiple open orders; the Empty Bin Report, which lists bins
that are currently empty; or the Uploaded Shipment Report, which lists sales orders that
were uploaded on a given date.

• Detailed reports

These reports provide in-depth information for an individual order, product, location,
customer, and vendor reports, and allow you to link to various other reports. These
comprise the Packslip,
Packs lip, Purchase Order,
O rder, Vendor,
Vendor, Customer,
Customer, Bin and Product reports, all of
which are also linked to from the Orders and Receiving modules.

• Statistical rep
reports

Statistical reports show calculated totals or averages for various operations, to provide data
on your warehouse’s performance. Statistical-type reports are only available from the
Reports module, and typically do not link to other reports. Examples of statistical reports
include the Employee Statistics Report, which shows total transactions and transactions
 per hour for all users on a selected date, for a given activity; the Cycle Time Report, which
shows total numbers of orders shipped within a particular number of days, for a selected
month; or the Activity Report, which shows the number of transactions per user for each
half-hour for a selected date, for a selected activity.

A BO UT R EP OR TS , M ON IT OR S, A ND L OG S 2 03
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

In addition to the Reports function, the following functionality provides real-time reporting of
WMS activity:

• Monitors

Monitors show statistical data for all warehouse activities for each half hour for a selected
date. Historical monitors are only available from the Reports module, and include the
Activity Monitor Report, which displays totals for all activities in the warehouse, and the
Activity Report, which displays totals for a selected activity. The real-time activity
monitor for the current date is also available from the Monitor module, accessible from the
Web Dispatch navigation bar. Both are described in “Monitoring Warehouse Activities” on
 page 250
250..

• Logs

Log reports show every transaction recorded in the R ADIO


ADIO BEACON WMS log files, and
are very useful for troubleshooting purposes. They are described in detail in Chapter 11,
“Troublesh
“Tr oubleshooting
ooting”” on page 311
311..

The following provide a listing, by screen, of all the reports available, and the sections in this
chapter in which they are described.

PICKING REPORTS

Report Description
Exception See “Releasin
“Releasing
g Orders with Held
Held Lines” on page
page 85
Packslip See “Managi
“Managing
ng Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211
Quick Order Completion See “‘Pickin
“‘Picking’
g’ a Sales Order”
Order” on page 128
Customer See “Managi
“Managing
ng Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211
Order
Order Conso
Consolid
lidatio
ation
n Oppor
Opportun
tunitie
itiess See “Managi
“Managing
ng Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211
Uploaded Shipments See “Managi
“Managing
ng Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211
Short Products See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Truck Route See “Managi
“Managing
ng Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211
Shipment Lookup See “Managi
“Managing
ng Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211
Daily Shipping See “Managi
“Managing
ng Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211

2 0 4 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Report Description
Manifest Report See “Manag
“Managing
ing Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 21
211
1
Held Orders with Items Received See “Manag
“Managing
ing Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 21
211
1
Today
Create a Delivery See “Creating Deliveries In RADIO BEACON” on
 page 130

RECEIVING REPORTS

Report Description
Purchase Order See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Quick
Quick Purchas
Purchasee Order
Order Comple
Completion
tion See “‘Receiving’ a Purchase Order in Web
Web Dispatch” on
 page 188
Vendor See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Vendor Product List See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Uploaded Receipts See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Receiving by PO See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Shortage See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Daily Receiving See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Create a Requisition See “ Demand Forecasting ” document
Create a Container See “Creat
“Creating
ing Container
Container References”
References” on page 182
RECV View Container  See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
Container Lookup See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221
RMA Rush Products See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
RMA Issued See “Manag
“Managing
ing Purchasing
Purchasing and Receiving”
Receiving” on page 221

A BO UT R EP OR TS , M ON IT OR S, A ND L OG S 2 05
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

INVENTORY REPORTS

Report Description
Products See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Product See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Product Inventory See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Reserved Stock  See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
License Plate See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Bin Detail See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Bin Inventory See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Empty Bin See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Incremental Slotting See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Replenishment See “Managi
“Managing
ng Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
REPLEN Adva
Advanc
ncee Reple
Repleni
nish
shme
ment
nt See
See “Running the Advance Replenishment Function” on
 page 305
PACK Packaging See “Proces
“Processing
sing Packaging
Packaging Orders” on page 159
Multi Pack See “Proces
“Processing
sing Packaging
Packaging Orders” on page 159

PERFORMANCE REPORTS

Report Description
Cycle Count See “Manag
“Managing
ing Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Cycle Count Accuracy See “Measuring Warehouse
Warehouse Performance” on page 251
Activity See “Measuring Warehouse
Warehouse Performance” on page 251
Activity Monitor See “Monitoring Warehouse
Warehouse Activities” on page 250
Picker Activity See “Measuring Warehouse
Warehouse Performance” on page 251
Employee Statistics See “Measuring Warehouse
Warehouse Performance” on page 251
Velocity by Bin See “Manag
“Managing
ing Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Top 100 See “Manag
“Managing
ing Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231

2 0 6 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MISCELLANEOUS REPORTS

KIT Report Description


Assemblies Manager See “Mainta
“Maintaining
ining Kits”
Kits” on page 269
SHIP BOL See“Generating
See“Generating Bills of Lading and Manifests”
Manifests” on page 125
Ad-Hoc SQL See“Gener
“Generating
ating Custom
Custom Reports” on page 255
Shipping Errors See “Manag
“Managing
ing Sales and Shipments”
Shipments” on page 211
Errors on Date Chapter 11, “Tr
“Troublesh
oubleshootin
ooting”
g” on page 31
311
1
Adjustments See “Manag
“Managing
ing Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Cycle Time See “Measuring Warehouse
Warehouse Performance” on page 251
PACK Packaging Manger See “Mainta
“Maintaining
ining Packaging
Packaging Items” on page 276
Picke
Picked,
d, Unsh
Unship
ippe
ped
d Inve
Invent
ntor
ory
y See “Manag
“Managing
ing Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
LOC Open Warehouse Transits See “Manag
“Managing
ing Inventory”
Inventory” on page 231
Daily Receipts See “Managing Purchasing
Purchasing and
and R eceiving”
eceiving” on page 221
Daily Sales See “Managing Inventory
Invent ory”” on page
page 231
Log Lookup Chapter 11, “Tr
“Troublesh
oubleshootin
ooting”
g” on page 31
311
1

ADDITIONAL FUNCTIONS

The Reports module provides access to other functions, such as product maintenance, advance
replenishment, and so on. A summary of these is provided in the following table, which also
indicates the chapter in this manual in which they are described.

Report Screen Use to... Described in...


Quick Order Picking “Pick” an order from “‘Picking’ a Sales Order” on
Completion Web Dispatch.
D ispatch.  page 128
128 of
 of Chapter
Chap ter 2,
“Processing Sales Orders”.
Orders”.
Export Picking Export shipment “‘Picking’ a Sales Order” on
Manifest information to a text file  page 128
128 of
 of Chapter 2,
SHIP that can be e-mailed to “Processing Sales Orders”.
Orders”.
ATS, a Canadian LTL
carrier.

A BO UT R EP OR TS , M ON IT OR S, A ND L OG S 2 07
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Report Screen Use to... Described in...


Create Receiving Create a container “Creating Container
RECV Container  reference for multiple References”
Referen ces” on page 182
182 of
 of
POs expected to arrive Chapter 5, “Processing
together. Purchase Orders and
Returns”.
Returns”.
Create a Picking Include partial or “Creating Deliveries In
Delivery complete lines from RADIO BEACON” on
multiple sales orders  page 130
130 of
 of Chapter 2,
into a single delivery for “Processing Sales Orders”.
Orders”.
a specific customer and
ship-to address.
REPLEN Replenishment Inventory View and generate Chapter 10, “Using Advance
Report advance replenishment Replenishment”
Replenishment” on page
page 303
303..
requests.
Assemblies Misce
Miscella
llane
neou
ouss View,
iew, cre
creat
ate,
e, and
and edi
editt kit
kit “Maintaining Kits” on
KIT Manger  assemblies.  page 269
269 of
 of Chapter 8,
“Editing Orders and
Warehouse Data”
Dat a”..
Packaging Misc
Miscel
ella
lane
neou
ouss View
iew, crea
create
te,, and
and edit
edit “Maintaining Packaging
Manger   packaging items Items”
Items” on page
page 276
276 of
 of
PACK “Editing Orders and
Warehouse Data”
Dat a”..
BOL Re
Report Miscellaneous View an
and ed
edit bi
bills of
of “Generating Bills of Lading
SHIP lading/manifests that and Manifests”
Manifests” on
on page 125
iyou have already of Chapter 2, “Processing
created in Web Dispatch. Sales Orders”.
Orders”.
PACK Packaging Inventory Generate pa
packaging Chapter 4, “Processing
Report orders based on product/ Packaging Orders” on
 packsize velocity or  page 159
159..
days on hand.
Multi-Pack Inventory Generate pa
packaging Chapter 4, “Processing
PACK Packaging orders based on product/ Packaging Orders” on
Report  packsize velocity or  page 159
159..
days on hand.

2 0 8 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GENERAL PROCEDURES FOR GENERATING REPORTS

If your system is a multi-company or third-party logistics operation, many reports show client-
3PL specific information. If your user ID restricts you to viewing data for a specific client only, the
reports will only display data for that client. If your user ID allows you to access data for all
clients, you have the option of filtering the report to view data for a specific client only.

> To generate a report:

1. From
From the
the nav
navig
igati
ation
on bar
bar, cli
click
ck Reports to open the Reports module.

2. In the Reports
Reports screen,
screen, click
click the tab listing
listing the
the report
report you
you want to view
view.

3. Do any
any of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• For repo
reports
rts that
that displ
display
ay a single
single field
field in whic
which
h you must
must ente
enterr an ident
identify
ifying
ing numb
number
er,,
enter the appropriate identifier. For example, to generate a Packsli p Report for sales
order number 197, enter 197 in the Packslip field.

• For
For repor
eports
ts that
that disp
displa
lay
y a Date field, enter the date for which you want to view data, or
leave the field blank to select today’s date. For example, to generate an Activity
Report for August 5, 2002, enter 08/05/2002  in the Date field.

• For re
reports th
that di
displ
splay Starting Date and Ending Date fields, enter the appropriate
dates to specify a period of time for which you want to view data, or leave the fields
 blank to select today’s date.

• For repo
reports
rts that
that displa
display
y multip
multiple
le fields
fields that
that allow
allow you
you to narr
narrow
ow select
selection
ion crit
criteri
eriaa or
specify a range of items, enter the relevant values, or leave them blank to simply
select all items in the system. For example, to generate a Replenishment Report for
zones D and G only, enter DG in the Zone field.

A BO UT R EP OR TS , M ON IT OR S, A ND L OG S 2 09
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

• For repor
reports
ts that
that display
display a drop-
drop-dow
downn list, sele
select
ct the appro
appropri
priate
ate crite
criterio
rion
n or catego
category
ry
from the list (these are described for individual reports in the relevant sections of this
chapter). For example, to generate a Log Lookup Report according to user ID, select
User ID from the drop-down list.

• If you
you are a mult
multi-c
i-clien
lient/co
t/compa
mpanyny system
system,, and your
your user
user ID allo
allows
ws you to filter
filter data
data
3PL  by client, for reports that display the Client field, optionally enter the client name/
number to view the data for a single client only.

Tip: You can select, delete, cut, copy,


copy, and/or paste values from field to field, by right-
clicking in any field to display a pop-up menu from which you can select the desired
action. You
You can also select a recently-entered value, by clicking on the field, and
selecting the appropriate value from the drop-down list that appears.

4. When
When rea
ready
dy to
to disp
display
lay the rep
repor
ort,
t, clic
click
k Go next to the report you are generating.

Once a report screen is displayed, you can click on column headings to sort records by that
category.
category. In many reports, you can also click available links to access Packslip,
P ackslip, PO, Customer,
Vendor, Product, and Bin reports.

2 1 0 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MANAGING SALES AND SHIPMENTS


This section describes all reports available pertaining to customers, sales orders, picking,
shipping, and truck route management.

The following report provides information on customers:

Report Overview
Customer  Provides customer information and displays open and closed sales orders
for a selected customer.
Described in “Custom
“Customer
er Report”
Report” on page 213
213..

The following reports provide information on sales orders:

Report Overview
Packslip Provides details and statuses for a selected order.
Described in “Packsli
“Packslip
p Report”
Report” on page
page 214
214..
Order Lists customers with multiple open orders that may be consolidated.
Consolidation
Described in “Order Consolidation Opportunities Report” on page 215
215..
Opportunities

Held Orders Displays all the ‘held short’ orders for which products were received
with Items today. You
You can select whether to include orders with H ELD SHORT,
Received HELDSHORT and HELDFORMAT or all HELD Orders including
Today HELDR EPLENIS
EPLENIS status in the report. The report can help the dispatcher
decide which orders to process next.

M AN AG IN G S AL ES A ND S HI PM EN TS 2 11
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following reports provide information on shipments, truck routes, and closed/uploaded
sales orders. Some of these reports can help you plan shipping capacities, and troubleshoot
shipments.

Report Overview
Shipping
Shipping Errors
Errors Lists all errors
errors returned
returned by an
an integrated
integrated shipping
shipping system
system when pre-ratin
pre-rating
g
or rating of order cartons fails.
Described in “Shipp
“Shipping
ing Errors Report”
Report” on page 216
216..
Truck Route Lists truck routes and stops for warehouse-managed deliveries.
Described in “Tr
“Truck
uck Route Report”
Report” on page 217
217..
Uploaded Lists orders that have been completed and uploaded for a selected period
Shipments of time.
Described in “Upload
“Uploaded
ed Shipments
Shipments Report” on page 218
218..
Daily Shipping Provides shipping information for completed and uploaded orders for a
selected date.
Described in “Daily Shipping
Shipping Report”
Report” on page
page 219
219..
Shipment Lists all orders that were shipped together for a selected shipment/
Lookup manifest/track-trace
manifest/track-trace number .
Described in “Shipme
“Shipment
nt Lookup Report”
Report” on page 220
220..
Manifest Lists all manifests that have been exported to a text file for processing by
ATS.
Described in “Manife
“Manifest
st Report”
Report” on page
page 220
220..

2 1 2 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CUSTOMER REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed Search by customer number, billing name, billing city, billing postal/zip code, email
for: address, shipping name, shipping city or shipping postal/zip code
Description: Displays general customer information and all outstanding and shipped sales orders for
the selected customer.
Example:

Additional Edit customer information.


information . (Only available for users with the appropriate permissions.)
functions For more information, see “Modif
“Modifying
ying Customer
Customer Information”
Information” on page 282
282..
available:
Open your e-mail program and send an e-mail to a customer contact, by clicking the e-
mail address link.
Process an order or group of orders . (Only available if open orders are listed, and you
have the appropriate permissions.) For more information, see Chapter 2, “Processing
Sales Orders”
Orders” on page
page 49
49..

M AN AG IN G S AL ES A ND S HI PM EN TS 2 13
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PACKSLIP REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed Sales, work or transfer sales order number.
for:
Description: Provides a detailed history of the
t he activities performed for a single
s ingle sales or work order.
This report is useful as a diagnostic tool, and is described in de tail in “Understanding the
Packslip Report Screen” in
Screen”  in Chapter 2, “Processing Sales Orders”.
Orders” .
Example:

2 1 4 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Additional Edit general order information.


information . (Only available for non-uploaded orders, for users with
functions the appropriate permissions.) For more information, see “Editing Sales/Work/T
Sales/Work/Transfer/
ransfer/
available: Packaging
Packag ing Order Information”
Information” on page 261
261..
Edit order details.
details . (Only available for non-uploaded orders, for users with the
appropriate permissions.) For more information, see “Editing Sales/Work/T
Sales/Work/Transfer/
ransfer/
Packaging
Packag ing Order Line Details”
Details” on page 262
262..
Process the order . (Only available for users with the appropriate permissions.) For more
information, see Chapter 2, “Proces
“Processing
sing Sales Orders”
Orders” on page 49
49..
Add the order to a bill of lading/manifest . (Only available for non-uploaded orders.) For
more information, see “Generating Bills of Lading and Manifests” on page 125 125..
View the log for the order. (Only available for users with the appropriate permissions.)
For more information, Chapter 11, “Tr
“Troubles
oubleshootin
hooting”
g” on page 311
311..
Create an RMA for
RMA for the order. (Only available for uploaded orders.) For more
information, see “Enter
“Entering
ing RMAs” on
on page 186
186 of
 of Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase
Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .

ORDER CONSOLIDATION OPPORTUNITIES REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed All customers.
for:
Description: Lists customers that have multiple orders currently in the warehouse, that may
 potentially be grouped or consolidated for shipment by the dispatcher. For more
information, see “Understanding and Modifying Shipment Consolidation Options” on
 page 95
95 and
 and “Conso
“Consolidatin
lidating
g Orders” on page 109
109 of
 of Chapter 2, “Processing Sales
Orders”.
Orders”.
Example:

M AN AG IN G S AL ES A ND S HI PM EN TS 2 15
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

SHIPPING ERRORS REPORT

Report Miscellaneous
Screen:
Displayed All errors.
for:
Description: Displays all errors that have been encountered by a fully integrated shipping system,
such as ClipperShip or NeoPost, during the shipment rating and manifesting process.
The report shows the cause of the error and all shipping information for each carton in
an order that can not be rated. Shipping errors must be cleared before an order can be re-
rated and processed any further. For more information, see “Handling Wait Pre-Rate
Orders”” on page 87
Orders 87 and
 and “Clear
“Clearing
ing Shipping
Shipping Errors” on page 11
1166 , and “Handling
Shipping Errors” in
Errors”  in Using RADIO BEACON Handheld Functions.
Functions .
Example:

2 1 6 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

TRUCK ROUTE
R OUTE REPORT
RE PORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed All truck routes.
for:
Description: Shows truck routes and stops for orders assigned to truck routes, for warehouses that
manage their own trucks and deliveries. The report also shows customers with orders
not assigned to any truck route (in left column). Weight and cube information can help
 plan the space needed for orders, and the sequence in which shipping containers should
 be loaded on to trucks.
Example:

M AN AG IN G S AL ES A ND S HI PM EN TS 2 17
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

UPLOADED SHIPMENTS REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed Selected time period, or current date.
for:
Description: Displays all orders that have been uploaded during a specified time period. The report
lists the order number, customer, lines, and number of cartons for each order uploaded.
Example:

2 1 8 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

DAILY SHIPPING REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed Selected date, or current date.
for:
Description: Shows all shipments for a selected date. For each shipment, the shipment number, order
number, customer, number of cartons, and total weight are displayed.
Example:

M AN AG IN G S AL ES A ND S HI PM EN TS 2 19
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

SHIPMENT LOOKUP REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed  Shipment number.
for:
Description: Shows shipment information for a selected shipment, including shipping address,
shipment date, and order number(s).
Example:

MANIFEST REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed All manifests that have been exported to ATS in the last seven days. For information on
for: exporting manifest information and generating the report, see “‘Picking’ a Sales Order”
on pag
pagee 128
128..
Description: Shows shipment information for a selected shipment, including shipping address, order
number(s), and carton information.
Example:

2 2 0 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MANAGING PURCHASING AND RECEIVING


This section describes all reports that pertain to vendors, receiving, and purchasing decision-
making.

You can use the following reports to view information on vendors, and their products:

Report Overview
Vendor  Provides vendor information, and displays open and closed purchase
orders for the selected
s elected vendor.
Described in “V
“Vendor
endor Report”
Report” on page 222
222..
Vendor Product List Lists all products for a selected vendor.
Described in “V
“Vendor
endor Product List” on page 224
224..
 Shortage Lists suppliers of products that are currently unavailable in the
warehouse to fill open sales orders.
Described in “Shor
“Shortage
tage Report”
Report” on page 225
225..

The following reports provide information on purchase orders:

Report Overview
Purchase Order  Shows details and statuses for a selected PO.
Described in “Purcha
“Purchase
se Order Report”
Report” on page
page 226
226..
Receiving by PO Displays summary information of a selected PO, and indicates whether
it is open or already received.
Described in “Receiv
“Receiving
ing Report
Report by PO” on page 227
227..

RECV View Container  Lists the POs in a container for a selected container reference number.
Described in “V
“View
iew Container
Container Report” on page 228
228..
Container Lookup same as above
RMA RMA Issued Lists all purchase orders generated by RMA issues, with returned
 product information, for a selected date.
Described in “RMA Issued
Issued Report”
Report” on page
page 230
230..

M AN AG IN G P UR CH AS IN G A ND R EC EI VI NG 2 21
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following reports provide information on purchase orders that have already been received
in the warehouse:

Report Overview
Uploaded Lists uploaded POs for a selected upload date.
Receipts
Described in “Uploa
“Uploaded
ded Receipts
Receipts Report” on page 228
228..
Daily Lists all POs received during a selected period of time.
Receiving
Described in “Daily Receiving
Receiving Report”
Report” on page 229
229..
Daily Receipts Similar to Receiving Report by PO, but lists all POs received on a selected
date.
Described in “Daily Receipts
Receipts Report”
Report” on page 230
230..

VENDOR REPORT
REPOR T

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed Vendor number.
for:
Description: Displays general vendor information and all outstanding and closed purchase orders for
the selected vendor.
Additional Edit vendor information. (Only available if you have the appropriate permissions.) For
functions more information, see “Maintaining Vendors”
Vendors” on page 283
283..
available:

2 2 2 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Example:

Additional Edit vendor information.


information . (Only available for users with the appropriate permissions.)
functions For more information, see “Modifying Vendor
Vendor Information” on on page 284
284..
available:
Open your e-mail program and send an e-mail to a customer contact, by clicking the e-
mail address link.

M AN AG IN G P UR CH AS IN G A ND R EC EI VI NG 2 23
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

VENDOR PRODUCT LIST

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed Vendor number.
for:
Description: Displays a list of products for the selected vendor, total quantities in the warehouse, and
quantities allocated to sales orders.
Example:

2 2 4 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

SHORTAGE REPORT

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed All short products.
for:
Description: Lists vendors that supply products that are currently short for outstanding sales orders.
The report also shows the total number of lines on all orders held short, for each vendor.
This report may be helpful in determining the suppliers from whom products should be
re-ordered immediately
immediate ly..
Example:

M AN AG IN G P UR CH AS IN G A ND R EC EI VI NG 2 25
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PURCHASE ORDER REPORT

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed PO number.
for:
Description: Provides detailed information on a selected purchase order, such as the number of lines
and units. Described in detail in “Understanding the Purchase Order Report Screen” on
 page 173
173 of
 of Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .
Example:

2 2 6 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Additional Process the order.


order. (Only available for non-uploaded orders.) For more information, see
functions Chapter 5, “Proce
“Processing
ssing Purchase
Purchase Orders and Returns”
Returns” on page 171
171..
available:
Edit general PO information.
information . (Only available for non-uploaded orders, for users with the
appropriate permissions.) For more information, see “Editing Purchase Order
Information”
Information” on page
page 264
264..
Edit order details by
details  by adding a new line tto
o the order, or editing or deleting an existing
line. (Only available for non-uploaded orders, for users with the appropriate
 permissions.) For more information, see “Editing or Deleting Purchase Order Line
Details” on page
page 265
265..
View the log for the order. (Only available for users with the appropriate permissions.)
For more information, see Chapter 11, “Tr
“Trouble
oubleshootin
shooting”
g” on page 311
311..

RECEIVING REPORT BY PO

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed PO number.
for:
Description: Displays summary information for the selected PO, and indicates whether the products
on the PO are still on order, or have been received.
Example:

M AN AG IN G P UR CH AS IN G A ND R EC EI VI NG 2 27
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

VIEW CONTAINER REPORT

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed Container number. To
To generate the report, see the procedure in “Creating Container
for: References”
References” on
on page 182
182 of
 of Chapter 5, “Processing Purchase Orders and Returns”.
Returns” .
Description: Lists purchase orders, lines and quantities associated with a selected container.
Example:

UPLOADED RECEIPTS REPORT

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed Selected upload date, or current date.
for:
Description: Lists POs closed and uploaded to the host system on a selected date.
Example:

2 2 8 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

DAILY RECEIVING REPORT

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed Time period, or current date.
for:
Description: Lists partially-received POs, the products and quantities received so far, and the bins to
which products were put away.
Example:

M AN AG IN G P UR CH AS IN G A ND R EC EI VI NG 2 29
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

DAILY RECEIPTS REPORT


Report Miscellaneous
Screen:
Displayed for: Time period, or current date.
Description: Displays summary information for all POs closed and uploaded on a selected date.
Example:

RMA ISSUED REPORT

Report Screen: Receiving


Displayed for: All RMA-generated purchase orders for a selected date.
Description: Lists PO numbers, original sales orders, and product return information for RMA-
generated purchase orders.
Example:

2 3 0 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MANAGING INVENTORY
This section describes all reports available for managing products, bins, and inventory in the
warehouse. The following reports provide detailed information on products, bins, and current
inventory levels:

Report Overview
Products A summary screen of stock in the warehouse, similar to the Orders and
Receiving summary screens.
Described in “Produ
“Products
cts Report”
Report” on page 234
234..
Product Provides detailed information for a selected product, including inventory,
current bin locations, and open purchase and sales orders on which the
 product appears.
Described in “Produ
“Product
ct Report”
Report” on page 235
235 and
 and “Product Inventory
Report”
Report” on page 236
236..
Product Lists total inventory for all products in the system.
Inventory
Described in “Produ
“Product
ct Inventory
Inventory Report” on page 236
236..
Bin Detail Displays properties of a selected bin or system location, and the inventory
located in it.
Described in “Bin Detail
Detail Report”
Report” on page
page 237
237..
Bin Inventory Displays packsizes, quantities, and sales values of all products, for a range
of bins.
Described in “Bin Inventory
Inventory Report”
Report” on page 238
238..
Licens
Licensee Plate
Plate Display
Displayss license
license plate
plate conte
content
nt and
and bin
bin assoc
associati
iation
on for
for the
the selec
selected
ted licen
license
se
 plate.
Described in “License Plate
Plate Report”
Report” on page 239
239..
Empty Bi
Bin Lists cu
currently empty bi
bins.
Described in “Cycle Count
Count Report”
Report” on page 240
240..
Cycle Count Lists cycle counting transactions and adjustments made during a selected
 period of time.
Described in “Cycle Count
Count Report”
Report” on page 240
240..

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 3 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following reports provide information on products that are allocated, reserved, or required
for open or closed sales orders. Many of these reports may be helpful for determining the status
of products needed to fill sales outstanding sales orders.

Report Overview
Short Products Lists products that are short for orders, for a sele cted order allocation date.
Described in “Short Products
Products Report”
Report” on page
page 242
242..
Rush Products Lists short items on a selected PO.
Described in “Rush Products
Products Report”
Report” on page
page 243
243..
Replenishment Lists outstanding Let Down and
Down and Fill Bin requests
Bin requests in the system.
Described in “Reple
“Replenishmen
nishmentt Report” on page 244
244 and
 and “Running the
Advancee Replenishment
Advanc Replenishment Function”
Function” on page 305
305..
Reserved Stock  Displays information on inventory that has been reserved by
reserved by a handheld
user through the Direct Move function.
Move function.
Described in “Reser
“Reserved
ved Stock Report”
Report” on page 245
245..
Open Displays warehouse/site transfers in progress.
LOC Warehouse
Described in “Open Warehouse
Warehouse Transits Report” on page 246
Transits
Picked, Lists products and quantities that have been picked but not shipped.
Unshipped
Described in “Picked, Unshipped Inventory Report”
Report” on page 247
247..
Inventory
Daily Sales Lists products that were received on POs and shipped in sales orders on the
same day.
Described in “Daily Sales
Sales Report”
Report” on page 247
247..
Adjustm
Adjustments
ents Provide
Providess deta
details
ils on all invento
inventory
ry adjustme
adjustments
nts made
made durin
during
g a specifi
specified
ed time
 period.
Described in “Adjust
“Adjustments
ments Report”
Report” on page 241

2 3 2 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

The following reports provide statistical information that can help you to determine optimal
stock rotation and placement strategies according to faster- and slower-moving products:

Report Overview
Top 100 Lists the 100 top-selling products, defined by the number of lines, and
quantities ordered, in open sales orders.
Described in “T
“Top
op 100 Report”
Report” on page 248
248..
Velocity by Bin Shows velocity and
velocity  and forecast number of days of inventory for each product,
for a selected range of bins.
Described in “V
“Velocity
elocity by Bin Report” on page 249
249..
Incremental Shows where products should be placed in the warehouse.
Slotting
Described in “Incre
“Incremental
mental Slotting
Slotting Report” on page 249

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 3 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PRODUCTS REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed for: All stock in the warehouse.
Description: Provides a summary of warehouse stock statistics.
Example:

Additional Functionality similar to Orders and Receiving Summary screen, with links to Product
functions Details screens and product reports. See “Using the Orders Summary Screens” on
available:  page 14
14..

2 3 4 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PRODUCT REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed for: Product number.
Description: Provides detailed information on a selected product, including product characteristics,
inventory,
inventory, and bin locations. The report also provides information on all open sales or
 purchase orders in which the product appears.
Example:

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 3 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Additional View order history for the product. For more information, see “Product Inventory
functions Report”
Report” on page 236
236..
available:
Edit product information.
information . (Only available if you have the appropriate permissions.) For
more information, see “Mainta
“Maintaining
ining Products”
Products” on page 266
266..
View the log for the product. (Only available if you have the appropriate permissions.)
For more information, see Chapter 11, “Tr
“Troubles
oubleshootin
hooting”
g” on page 31
311
1.
Process open sales orders.
orders . (Only available if you have the appropriate permissions.) For
more information, see Chapter 2, “Proces
“Processing
sing Sales Orders”
Orders” on page 4949..

PRODUCT INVENTORY REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed All products.
for:
Description: Lists the total on-hand quantities of all products in the warehouse.
Example:

2 3 6 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

BIN DETAIL REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed Bin number, virtual location, or system location.
for:
Description: Indicates the type, zone, and status of a selected bin, and provides a summary of
 packsizes, total quantities, and unallocated quantities (if any), of products stored in the
 bin.
Example:

Additional View the log for the bin. (Only available if you have the appropriate permissions.) For
functions more information, see Chapter 11, “Tr
“Troublesh
oubleshooting
ooting”” on page 31
311
1.
available:

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 3 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

BIN INVENTORY REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed Selected range of bins.
for:
Description: Provides detailed product and inventory information for a selected range of bins.
Example:

EMPTY BIN REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed All empty bins.
for:
Description: Lists bins that are currently empty. This report can be useful for searching for
homes for new products in the warehouse, especially if your warehouse uses
sticky bins.
Example:

2 3 8 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

LICENSE PLATE REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed License plate number
for:
Description: Displays license plate information and contents.
Example:

Additional View the log for the license plate (Only available if you have the appropriate
functions  permissions.) For more information, see Chapter 11, “Tr“Troubles
oubleshootin
hooting”
g” on page 311
311..
available:

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 3 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CYCLE COUNT REPORT

Report Performance
Screen:
Displayed Selected time period, or current date.
for:
Description: Shows all cycle counting transactions, and the adjustments that were made for each
 product counted, for a selected period of time. A negative quantity indicates that the
quantity was adjusted out of the bin during counting.
 Note: You
You can also generate a statistical report that displays the accuracy of cycle
counting over a selected period of time. See “Cycle Count Accuracy Report” on
 page 251
251..
Example:

2 4 0 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADJUSTMENTS REPORT

Report Miscellaneous
Screen:
Displayed Selected time period, or current date.
for:
Description: Provides details on all inventory adjustments made during a specified time period. The
report provides details on the type of adjustment made, the date, time, and user for the
adjustment, the products and quantities adjusted, and any PO numbers that were
associated with non-PO receipts.
receipts. Adjustments of inventory into the warehouse are
represented by a positive number; adjustments out of the warehouse are represented by a
negative number.
Example:

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 4 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

SHORT PRODUCTS REPORT

Report Picking
Screen:
Displayed Selected allocation date, or current date.
for:
Description: Indicates all the products that are short for sales orders that have been run through the
allocation process. For each product, the report also indicates quantities required to fill
outstanding sales or work orders. This report may be helpful in determining the products
that need to be re-ordered from suppliers.
Example:

2 4 2 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

RUSH PRODUCTS REPORT

Report Receiving
Screen:
Displayed A selected purchase order that has been received, or a pallet number.
for:
Description: Lists products and quantities that are short for open sales orders and have been received
on the selected purchase order. This report may be helpful for determining when orders
held short may be re-allocated, as it shows the short items that have since been received
into the warehouse.
Example:

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 4 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

REPLENISHMENT REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed Selected picking zone ( Zone selection), replenishment group (
group  (Group selection), or all
for: zones and groups.
Description: Lists open Let Down and/or
Down and/or Fill Bin requests.
Bin requests. The report lists the overstock bins from
which the required stock should be let down, and the pick bins to which the required
stock should be moved. Kit replenishment requests are identified by the work order
number that generated them; by default, advance replenishment requests
replenishment requests are identified
 by the group ADVANCE
ADVANCE (unless the dispatcher has assigned them to other groups).
This report is primarily used to monitor when replenishment processes have been
completed, so that held for replenishment orders may be re-allocated.
Example:

Additional Generate and view an advance replenishment report,


report , and issue advance replenishment
functions requests.
requests. (Only available for users with the appropriate permissions.) For more
available: information, see Chapter 10, “Using Advance
Advance Replenishment”
Replenishment” on page 303
303..

2 4 4 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

RESERVED STOCK REPORT

Report Inventory
Screen:
Displayed All reserved inventory.
inventory.
for:
Description: Shows reserved stock, its bin location,
locati on, the user who reserved it, the user ’s comment, and
the date it was reserved. Note that stock can only be unreserved from the handheld. For
more information, see “Reserving and Unreserving Inventory”  in Using RADIO
 BEACON Handheld Functions.
Functions .
Example:

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 4 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

OPEN WAREHOUSE TRANSITS


TRANSITS REPORT
REP ORT

Report Miscellaneous
Screen:
Displayed Displays warehouse/site transfers in progress. Displays all warehouse transfers that have
for: open transfer sales/purchase orders in R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS.

Description: Shows packslip, transit location, original warehouse, destination warehouse and transit
warehouse.
Example:

2 4 6 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PICKED, UNSHIPPED INVENTORY REPORT

Report Miscellaneous
Screen:
Displayed Current month.
for:
Description: Lists quantities and sales values of products that have been picked but not yet shipped,
for the current month.
Example:

DAILY SALES REPORT

Report Miscellaneous
Screen:
Displayed Selected date, or current date.
for:
Description: Displays summary information for all products that were received and shipped on sales
orders in the same day.

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 4 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

TOP 100 REPORT

Report Performance
Screen:
Displayed All products on open sales orders.
for:
Description: Lists the top 100 products on outstanding sales orders in the warehouse, according to
 both the total number lines appearing on sales orders, and the total quantities ordered.
This report may be useful for identifying
i dentifying products that may be put in forward
(temporary) pick bins or pallet pick bins to increase productivity for the most
frequently-picked products.
Example:

2 4 8 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

VELOCITY BY BIN REPORT

Report Screen: Performance


Displayed for: Selected range of bins.
Description: Shows the average number of picks per day and forecast number of days of
inventory available for each product in a selected range of bins.
 Note: The Calculate Demand Requirements function
Requirements  function must have been run in RFBase
for velocity records to be generated, and there must have been picks for the
standard packsizes in the bin(s) selected.
Example:

INCREMENTAL SLOTTING REPORT

Report Screen: Inventory


Displayed for: Selected bin range
Description: This report is important in determining where products should be placed in the
warehouse. The highest and lowest moving products in each zone are reported. The
highest and lowest are determined by the average number of picks for each product.

M A N AG I NG I NV E NT OR Y 2 4 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MONITORING WAREHOUSE
WAREHOUSE ACTIVITIES
ACTIV ITIES
The Monitor displays total numbers of all warehouse transactions, broken down by activity, for
each half hour, for the current date.The Activity Monitor  displays
 displays total numbers of all
warehouse transactions, broken down by act ivity, for each half hour,
hour, for a selected date.

ACTIVITY MONITOR REPORT


Report Screen: Performance
Displayed for: Selected date, or current date. You can also access the real-time activity monitor for
the current date by accessing the Monitor module from the navigation bar. This will
update the Activity Monitor each half-hour during the day.
Description: Shows total numbers of orders and transactions processed in the warehouse for each
half-hour for a selected date.
 Note: You
You can also generate an Activity Report that displays total numbers of units/
lines picked, received and moved, and bins counted for each user in the wa rehouse for
each half-hour of a selected date. For information, see “Activi
“Activity
ty Report”
Report” on page 252
252..
Example:

2 5 0 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MEASURING WAREHOUSE PERFORMANCE


This section describes reports that provide statistical information on the productivity and
efficiency of your warehouse processes, including the following:

Report Overview
Cycle Count Displays total numbers of cycle counting transactions and accuracy
Accuracy  percentage for a selected period of time.
Described in “Cycle Count
Count Accuracy Report”
Report” on page 251
251..
Activity Displays total numbers of transactions for each user, for a selected date,
for a selected activity.
Described in “Activit
“Activity
y Report”
Report” on page
page 252
252..
Picker Activity Lists users with warehouse activity,
a ctivity, and the number of picks accomplished
in a specified number of minutes, for a selected date.
Described in “Picker Activity
Activity Report”
Report” on page 253
253..
Employee Displays total numbers of transactions and transactions per hour for all
Statistics users, for a selected activity, for a selected date.
Described in “Employ
“Employee
ee Statistics
Statistics Report” on page
page 253
253..
Cycle Time Shows percentage of orders shipped on the same day, second day, and
third day, for a selected month.
Described in “Cycle Time
Time Report”
Report” on page 254
254..

CYCLE COUNT ACCURACY REPORT

Report Performance
Screen:
Displayed Selected time period, or current date.
for:
Description: Shows statistics for cycle counting transactions, including the total number of bins
counted, and the percentage accuracy rate, for a selected period of time.

M EA SU RI NG W AR EH OU SE P ER FO RM AN CE 2 51
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ACTIVITY REPORT

Report Screen Performance


Displayed for: Selected date.
Description: Shows the total number of transactions for each half-hour on a selected date for each
user in the warehouse, for the selected activity, including the following:
PICKORDR — orders picked.
PICKLINE — lines picked.
RECVCODE — purchase orders opened or completed and product units received.
CYCL_CPL — bins cycle counted and product units counted.
CYCL_ADJ — adjustments made to
t o inventory through cycle counting and product units
adjusted.
ADJUST — adjustments made to inventory by all methods (cycle counting,
miscellaneous adjustments, non-PO receipts,
receipts, etc.)
SHIPPED — orders shipped and product units shipped.
DNLOAD — sales, work and purchase orders downloaded.
REPLENIS — hot replenishment requests
replenishment requests issued and product units requested.
 NEWLABEL — new carton labels generated.
ADV-REPL — advance replenishment requests
replenishment  requests issued and product units requested.
MOVE-IN — moves in by Direct Move, Move, Fill Bins,
Bins, Misc Adjusts, Cycle Counts, and
receipts, and product units handled.
MOVE-OUT — moves out by Direct Move, Letdown,
Letdown, Misc Adjusts, Cycle Counts, and
 picks, and product units handled.
Example:

2 5 2 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

PICKER ACTIVITY REPORT

Report Performance
Screen:
Displayed All users for a specified number of minutes, on a selected date.
for:
Description: Shows the average number of picks,
pic ks, i.e. the number of different bins to whic h the picker
was directed for each product, in the specified time period.
Example:

EMPLOYEE STATISTICS REPORT

Report Performance
Screen:
Displayed Selected time period.
for:
Description: Shows productivity statistics for all users in t he warehouse, for a selected period of time,
 by showing the total number of units handled, the total number of hours on task, and the
number of units processed per hour. Specifically, it displays statistics for the following
activities:
Picking — units and lines picked.
Receiving — units and lines received.
Material Handling — units and moves.
Cycle Counting — bins counted.
Example:

M EA SU RI NG W AR EH OU SE P ER FO RM AN CE 2 53
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CYCLE TIME REPORT

Report Miscellaneous
Screen:
Displayed Selected month.
for:
Description: Shows the total number of sales orders downloaded for each day of the month, and the
 percentage of orders shipped within the same day, 2 days, 3 days, and more
more than 3 days.
Example:

2 5 4 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GENERATING
GENERATING CUSTOM REPORTS
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS offers the facility to create custom-defined reports that allow you to
query the entire database to search for specific data.

Report Overview
Custom Allow you to call custom-defined SQL scripts. To set up these reports, the
SQL scripts must be accessible on the network to the central RFBase
server, and identified in the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS setup. For more
information on configuring these reports, contact your system
administrator or Radio Beacon representative.
Ad-Hoc SQL Allows you to create SQL statements and query the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS
database to generate custom reports on-the-fly.
Described in “Ad Hoc SQL Report”
Report” on
on page 255
255..

AD HOC SQL REPORT

This report, available from the Miscellaneous screen, allows you to define SQL statements to
query the most commonly accessed R ADIOADIO BEACON WMS database tables, and format the
results in a standard
sta ndard Web
Web Dispatch report.

 Note that running this report requires not only knowledge of the SQL language, but also some
familiarity with the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS database and the kinds of data that each table
contains. For assistance, contact a system administrator or your Radio Beacon representative.

G EN ER AT IN G C US TO M R EP OR TS 2 55
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Here is a basic summary of the tables that may be queried:

Table Contains...
ADJUSTS Miscellaneous adjustment records.
ASNDE
SNDET
TL Carton content lin
line deta
etails
ils as spe
specified on ASN label.
ASNHEAD ASN carton label general information.
ASSEMBLY Definitions of kit assemblies.
AVAILA
AILABL
BL Inve
Invent
ntor
ory
y avai
availa
labl
blee from
from a vend
vendor
or (qua
(quant
ntit
itie
iess in vend
vendor’
or’ss ware
wareho
hous
use)
e)..
BACKRD Hist
istorical li
line de
detail re
records for
for upload
loadeed (c
(closed
sed) pu
purchase orders.
BACK
BACKRH
RH Hist
Histor
oric
ical
al gene
genera
rall data
data reco
record
rdss for
for uplo
upload
aded
ed (clos
closed
ed)) purc
purcha
hase
se order
rders.
s.
BCODEREF Barcode re
reference nu
numbers fo
for pr
products.
BINMSTR Bin records.
BINLOCAT Inventory (product location) records.
BOL Bill of lading records for BOLs created in Web Dispatch.
CARR
CARRIE
IER
RS Rule
Ruless and
and ser
service
vice defin
efinit
itio
ions
ns for
for shi
shipp
ppin
ing
g car
carri
rier
erss use
used
d by
by the
the
warehouse.
CONFIG
FIG All
All con
configuration sett
etting
ings othe
ther than those spe
specified in the RULES
LES,
CARRIERS, LOCATION, PERMISS, PROCALRT, SHIPPING, and
PRODCLAS tables.
CUSTMSTR Customer records.
DNLOAD Records downloaded from host systems to RADIO
  DIO BEACON WMS and
A
not yet processed.
INCIDENT Records fo
for in
incidents cr
created in We
Web Di
Dispatch.
LOC
LOCATION
TION Def
Definit
initio
ions
ns of loca
locati
tion
onss (for
(for mult
multi-
i-si
site
te ware
wareho
hous
uses
es).
).
PERMISS Definitions of
of user pr
privilege le
levels.
PICKHE
KHEAD Gen
General da
data re
records fo
for ac
active (o
(open)
en) sa
sales or
orders.
PICK
PICKDE
DETL
TL Gene
Genera
rall line
line deta
detail
il reco
ecords
rds for
for acti
active
ve (ope
(open)
n) sale
saless orde
orders
rs..
PICKLOC Pick location records for allocated orders.
PROC
PROCAL
ALR
RT Defi
Defini
niti
tion
onss of
of cus
custo
tom-
m-de
defi
fine
ned
d piv
pivot
ots,
s, aler
alerts
ts,, and
and filt
filter
erss use
used
d in
in Web
Web
Dispatch.
PRODCLAS Definitions of
of pr
product cl
classes (i
(if us
used).

2 5 6 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Table Contains...
PRODMSTR Product records.
RECVH
ECVHEA
EAD
D Gene
Genera
rall dat
dataa rec
recor
ords
ds for
for act
activ
ivee (op
(open
en)) pur
purch
chas
asee ord
order
ers.
s.
RECVD
ECVDET
ETL
L Line
Line deta
detail
il recor
ecords
ds for acti
active
ve (ope
(open)
n) purch
urchas
asee orde
orders
rs..
RECVDET2 General an
and line de
detail re
records fo
for non-PO receipts.
receipts.
RFLOG Log re
records fo
for al
all wa
warehouse tr
transactions an
and sy
system me
messages.
REPLENIS Replenishment request records.
RULES Definitions of bin types and rules.
SHIP
SHIPDE
DETL
TL Hist
Histo
orica
ricall shi
shipm
pmen
entt car
carto
ton
n co
conten
ntents
ts reco
recorrds for
for upl
uploa
oade
ded
d (cl
(clos
osed
ed))
sales orders.
SHIP
SHIPMS
MSTR
TR Hist
Histo
orica
ricall ship
shipme
ment
nt car
carto
ton
n reco
record
rdss for
for uplo
upload
aded
ed (cl
(clo
osed)
sed) sale
saless orde
orders
rs..
SHIP
SHIPHI
HIST
ST Hist
Histo
orica
ricall gene
generral data
data reco
record
rdss for
for uplo
upload
aded
ed (clo
closed)
sed) sale
saless order
rders.
s.
SHIP
SHIPLI
LINE
NE Hist
Histo
orica
ricall lin
line deta
detail
il reco
record
rdss for
for uplo
ploaded
aded (clo
(close
sed)
d) sale
saless order
rders.
s.
SHIP
SHIPPI
PING
NG Defi
Defini
niti
tion
onss and
and tran
transl
slat
atio
ion
ns of ship
shippi
ping
ng code
codess used
used by ship
shippi
ping
ng
systems for use by host systems.
SUB
SUBSTIT
STITUT
UTE
E Subs
Substi
titu
tute
te prod
produc
uctt reco
record
rdss (if
(if used
used).
).
TOTED
OTEDET
ETL
L Ship
Shipme
men
nt car
carto
ton
n con
conte
tent
ntss rec
recor
ords
ds for
for act
activ
ivee (op
(open
en)) sal
sales
es order
rders.
s.
TOTMA
OTMAST
STR
R Ship
Shipme
men
nt car
carto
ton
n rec
recor
ords
ds for
for act
activ
ivee (op
(open
en)) sal
sales
es orde
orders
rs..
TRANSL
ANSLO
OG Log recor
cords for all warehouse transac
sactio
tions
TRANSF
NSFER Transfer
sfer (uploa
load) to
to ho
host confirmatio
tion re
records.
ds.
UPLOAD Records uploaded from RADIO
   BEACON WMS to host systems and not
yet processed by host systems.
VENDMSTR Vendor records.

G EN ER AT IN G C US TO M R EP OR TS 2 57
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To run an SQL report:

1. In the Select, Where, Group by, and Order by fields, enter the components of the desired
SQL statement that will generate the appropriate results.

Tip: To select all records from the desired table, simply enter * in the Select field.

2. From the From drop-down list, select the database table against which you want to run the
query.

3. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, enab
enable
le Evaluate Only, and click Submit to run the query and return the
number of results.

4. If necessary
necessary,, modify
modify your
your SQL statement
statement to further
further refine
refine the search criteria.
criteria.

5. When
When satisfie
satisfied
d with the
the numbe
numberr of result
resultss returne
returned,
d, enable
enable Evaluate & Display, and click
Submit to display the results.

The following example submitted a query to return all records from the RULES table , which is
the table that defines bin rules in the warehouse.

2 5 8 C H A P T E R 7 G E N E R A T I N G R E P O R T S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

8 EDITING ORDERS AND


WAREHOUSE DATA
This chapter discusses the following functions, which allow users with the appropriate
 permissions to update the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON database directly from Web Dispatch:

• Editin
Editing
g sales
sales orde
orders,
rs, transfer
transfer sales
sales orders
orders or work
work orders—
orders—des
descri
cribed
bed in “Editing Sales,
Work, Packaging and Transfer
Transfer Sales Orders” on page 260
260..

• Editin
Editing
g purch
purchase
ase orders
orders or transfer
transfer purchas
purchasee order
orders—de
s—descri
scribed
bed in “Editing Purchase
Orders and Transfer
Transfer Purchase Orders” on page 263263..

• Upda
Updatin
ting
g and
and addi
adding
ng new
new pro
produ
duct
cts—d
s—desc
escri
ribe
bed
d in
in “Mainta
“Maintaining
ining Products”
Products” on page 266
266..

KIT • Updatin
Updating
g and
and adding
adding new kits
kits and
and co-pro
co-produc
ducts—d
ts—desc
escrib
ribed
ed in “Maintaining Kits” on
 page 269
269..

PACK • Upda
Updatin
ting
g and
and addi
adding
ng new
new pack
packag
agin
ing
g items
items—de
—descr
scribe
ibed
d in “Maintaining Packaging Items”
on pag
pagee 276
276..

• Upda
Updatin
ting
g and
and addi
adding
ng new
new cus
custo
tome
mers
rs—de
—descr
scribe
ibed
d in “Maintaining Customers” on
 page 281
281..

• Upda
Updatin
ting
g and
and adding
adding new
new ven
vendo
dors
rs—de
—desc
scri
ribed
bed in “Maintaining Vendors”
Vendors” on page 283
283..

Note: Any changes you make in Web Dispatch do not update your host system. Therefore, if
you are using a host system,
system , you should only edit data in Web Dispatch in exceptional
circumstances.

2 5 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING SALES, WORK, PACKAGING AND


TRANSFER SALES
SA LES ORDERS
If you have the appropriate permissions, you can directly edit a sales/work/transfer sales/
 packaging order in Web
Web Dispatch. There are two different screens you access to edit sales
orders: the first contains general order information, including the order description, and
shipping information (representing data contained in the PICKHEAD database table); the
second contains order line detail information (representing data contained in the PICKDETL
database table). If you want to edit general information in a sales or work order, follow the
instructions in “Editing Sales/Work/Transfer/Packaging
Sales/Work/Transfer/Packaging Order Information” on page 261 261.. If
you need to edit a line in a sales or work order, follow the instructions in “Editing Sales/Wor
Sales/Work/k/
Transfer/Packaging Order
Order Line Details” on page 262
262..

 Note that you can only edit an order as long as it is “open”, that is, in any status except READY
TO UPLOAD. Once it has been marked as “shipped” and ready to upload, it can no longer be
modified.

 Note also that you can only edit a very limited number of fields; fields that may not be edited
are greyed out.

2 6 0 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING SALES/WORK/TRANSFER/PACK
SALES/WORK/TRANSFER/PACKAGING
AGING
ORDER INFORMATION

> To edit general sales, transfer sales or work order i nformation:

1. Display the Packslip


Packslip Report
Report for the desired
desired order,
order, using
using any
any method.
method.

2. Click the Edit button. The SO Editor screen is displayed.

3. Edit any of the fields


fields for
for which
which you want
want to update
update informati
information.
on. Click
Click the tabs
tabs to access
access
additional fields to edit. For more information on many of the fields, see the descri ption of
PH records in the document Host
document Host Interchange Transactions
Transactions,, available at http://
at http://
002.radiobeacon.com/resources/downloads/Host/host_interchange_transactions.pdf ..
002.radiobeacon.com/resources/downloads/Host/host_interchange_transactions.pdf 

4. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Submit to save your changes, or Close to cancel. You are returned to
t o the
Packslip Report screen.

E D I T IN G S A L ES , W O R K , P A C K AG I N G A N D T R A N SF E R S A L ES O R D E RS 261
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING SALES/WORK/TRANSFER/PACK
SALES/WORK/TRANSFER/PACKAGING
AGING ORDER LINE
DETAILS

If you want to edit line details for a sales, transfer sales or work order, you must open the SO
Details screen for each line you want to edit.

> To edit a line in an existing sales/transfer sales/work order:

1. Display the Packslip


Packslip Report
Report for the
the desired
desired sales/transf
sales/transfer
er sales/work
sales/work order,
order, using
using any
method.

2. In the Packslip Details section, under the Edit Column column heading, click the Edit
link next to the line you wish to edit. The SO detail screen is displayed.

2 6 2 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Edit any
any of the fields.
fields. Click
Click the
the tabs to access
access additional
additional fields to edit.
edit. For more
information on many of the fields, see the description of PD records in the document  Host
 Interchange Transactions
Transactions available
 available at http://002.radiobeacon.com/resources/downloads/
Host/host_interchange_transactions.pdf .

4. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Submit to save your changes, or Close to cancel. You are returned to
t o the
Packslip Order Report screen.

5. Repeat the procedu


procedure
re for
for all lines you want
want to
to edit
edit for this order
order..

EDITING PURCHASE ORDERS AND TRANSFER


PURCHASE ORDERS
If you have the appropriate permissions, you can directly edit a purchase order or transfer
 purchase order in Web
Web Dispatch. There are two different screens you access to edit purchase
orders: the first contains general purchase order information, including the purchase order
description, and shipping instructions (representing data contained in the RECVHEAD
database table); the second contains purchase order line detail information (representing data
contained in the RECVDETL database table). If you want to edit general information in a
 purchase order, follow the instructions in “Editin
“Editing
g Purchase Order Information”
Information” on page 264
264..
If you need to add, edit or delete a line in a purchase order, follow the instructions in “Editing
or Deleting Purchase
Purchase Order
Order Line Details” on page 265
265..

 Note that you can only edit a purchase order as long as it is “open”, that is, in the statuses of
 NOT RECEIVED or BEING RECEIVED. Purchase orders created using Web Order entry in
O/E Web Dispatch can also be edited in APPROVED status, if your system is configured for the
dispatcher to release orders to the warehouse floor.

Once a purchase has been marked as “closed” and ready to upload, it can no longer be
modified.

E D I T IN G P U R C H AS E O R D E RS A N D T R A N SF E R P U R C H AS E O R D E RS 263
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING PURCHASE ORDER INFORMATION

> To edit general purchase order information:

1. Display the Purchase


Purchase Order Report
Report for the desired
desired purcha
purchase
se order
order or transfer
transfer purchase
purchase
order, using any method.

2. Click the Edit button. The PO Editor screen is displayed.

3. Edit any of the fields for


for which
which you want
want to update
update informat
information.
ion. For
For more inform
information
ation on
many of the fields, see the description of RH records in the document  Host Interchange
Transactions,
Transactions, available at http://002.radiobeacon.com/resources/downloads/Host/
host_interchange_transactions.pdf .

4. When
When done
done,, clic
click
k Submit to save your changes, or Close to cancel. You are returned to the
Purchase Order Report screen.

2 6 4 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING OR DELETING PURCHASE ORDER LINE DETAILS

If you want to edit line details for a purchase order, you must open the PO Detail Information
screen for each line you want to edit. Depending on your configuration, you may be able to:

• Edit an existing line —follow the instructions in “Editing Lines in a Purchase Order”.


Order” .

• Delete an existing line —follow the instructions in “Deleting Lines from a Purchase Order”
on pag
pagee 266
266..

EDITING LINES IN A PURCHASE ORDER 

> To edit a line in a purchase order:

1. Display the Purchase


Purchase Order
Order Report
Report for the
the desired
desired purchase
purchase order,
order, using any method.
method.

2. Under the PO Line Edit column heading, click the Edit link next to the line you wish to
edit. The PO Detail screen is displayed.

E D I T IN G P U R C H AS E O R D E RS A N D T R A N SF E R P U R C H AS E O R D E RS 265
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Edit any
any of the relevant
relevant fields. For more
more informati
information
on on many of
of the fields,
fields, see the
description of RD records in the document Host
document  Host Interchange Transactions
Transactions,, available at
http://002.radiobeacon.com/resources/downloads/Host/host_interchange_transactions.pdf ..
http://002.radiobeacon.com/resources/downloads/Host/host_interchange_transactions.pdf 

4. When
When done
done,, clic
click
k Submit to save your changes, or  Close
 Close to cancel. You are returned to the
Purchase Order Report screen.

5. Repeat the procedu


procedure
re for
for all lines
lines you
you want to edit in this
this purchase
purchase order
order..

DELETING LINES FROM A PURCHASE ORDER 

You can delete lines from purchase


p urchase orders if your system is configured to allow it.

> To delete a line from a purchase order:

1. Display the Purchase


Purchase Order Report
Report for the
the desired
desired purchase
purchase order,
order, using any method.
method.

2. Under the Delete column heading, click the Delete link next to the line you wish to delete.
You are prompted to confirm the deletion.

3. Click Delete to delete the item (or Cancel to cancel). You are returned to the Purchase
Order Report screen, and the selected line is removed from the report.

MAINTAINING PRODUCTS
If you need to update product information in Web
Web Dispatch, you can modify existing products,
or even add new products to the system, provided you have the appropriate permissions to do
so. To modify existing product information, follow the instructions in “Modifying Product
Information” below.
Information” below. To create a new product, follow the instructions in “Adding a New
Product”
Produ ct” on page 269
269..

2 6 6 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MODIFYING PRODUCT INFORMATION

> To edit product information:

1. Display the Product


Product Report
Report screen
screen for the desired
desired product,
product, by using any method.
method.

2. Click the Edit button. The Product Editor screen is displayed.

M AI NT AI NI NG P RO DU CT S 2 67
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Click the Additional tab to see additional product fields.

4. Edit any of the fields on either


either of these
these tabs for which
which you want
want to update
update informa
information.
tion.

5. For more
more information
information about most
most of the
the fields
fields on either
either of these
these tabs,
tabs, consult
consult the section
section
on Vendor Availability (VA) records in the document  Host Interchange Transactions
Transactions,,
available at http://002.radiobeacon.com/resources/downloads/Host/
host_interchange_transactions.pdf .

6. When
When done
done,, clic
click
k Submit to save your changes, or Close to cancel. You are returned to the
Product Report screen.

2 6 8 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADDING A NEW PRODUCT

If your system is configured to allow you to add new products from the Web, you can do so
from the Reports module in Web Dispatch.

> To create a product:

1. Go to the Reports
Reports module,
module, and select the
the Inventory
Inventory tab
tab to display
display the
the Inventory
Inventory Reports
Reports
screen.

2. Next to the Product selection, in the Product field, enter a number for the new product,
and click Go. The Product Editor screen is
i s displayed, with the new product number.

3. In the Description field, enter a description or name of the product.

4. In the Item Type field, if the product you are adding is to be a kit, enter F; if the product
you are adding is to be a packaging item, enter P.

5. Enter information
information in any other relevant
relevant fields
fields on either
either tab, as
as described
described in
in “Modifying
Productt Information”
Produc Information” on page 267
267..

6. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Submit to create the product (or Close to cancel). The Product Report
screen is displayed for the new product.

MAINTAINING
MAINTAINING KITS
KIT You can use Web Dispatch to modify existing kits and co-products, and even add new kits,
 provided that they are already defined as products in the R ADIO BEACON WMS database.

To edit an existing kit, see “Editin


“Editing
g an Existing
Existing Kit” on page 270
270..

To add a new kit, see “Addin


“Adding
g a Kit” on
on page 274
274..

To delete a kit, see “Deleti


“Deleting
ng a Kit” on page
page 275
275..

M AI NT AI NI NG K IT S 2 69
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING AN EXISTING KIT

You can edit a kit by adding, editing or deleting components or service items from the ‘recipe’
of the kit. Although a service item usually represents a non-tangible, such as labour, it must be
defined as a product in the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON database before you can add the ite m to a kit. To
define a service item as a product, follow the instructions in “Adding a New Product” on
 page 269
269..

> To edit a kit:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Miscell
Miscellane
aneous
ous tab to displa
display
y the Miscella
Miscellaneo
neous
us Report
Reportss screen.
screen.

3. Next to the Assemblies Manager  selection,


 selection, click Go. Any existing kits are displayed.

4. Clic
Clickk the
the link
link unde
underr the
the Assembly # heading for the kit you want to edit. The details of the
kit are displayed.

2 7 0 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

5. To edit
edit an existi
existing
ng kit,
kit, you can do
do any of
of the foll
followin
owing:
g:

• Add a component/service item to


item  to the kit. See “Adding a Component/Service Item to a
Kit” on page
page 271
271..

• Edit a component/service item of


item  of the kit. See “Editing a Component/Service Item” on
 page 273
273..

• Delete a component/service item from


item  from the kit. “Deleting a Component/Service Item
from a Kit” on page 273
273..

• Add a service item to


item to the kit. See “Adding a Component/Service Item to a Kit” on
 page 271
271..

• Edit
Edit a ser
servi
vice
ce item
item of the
the kit.
kit. See
See “Editin
“Editing
g a Compo
Component/Se
nent/Service
rvice Item” on page 273
273..

• Delete a service item from


item from a kit. See “Deleting a Component/Service Item from a Kit”
on pag
pagee 27
273
3.

ADDING A COMPONENT/SERVICE ITEM TO A KIT

When you create a new kit, you must immediately add at least one component to define the kit.
You can also add a component/service
component/servi ce item to an existing kit. Although a service item
ite m usually
represents a non-tangible, such as labour, it must be defined as a product in the R ADIO BEACON
WMS database before you can add the item to a kit.kit . To define a service item as a product,
follow the instructions in “Addin
“Addingg a New Product” on pagepage 269
269..

M AI NT AI NI NG K IT S 2 71
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To add a component/service item to a kit:

1. Foll
Follow
ow the
the pro
proce
cedu
dure
re in “Editin
“Editing
g an Existing
Existing Kit” on page 270
270 to
 to get to the kit details
screen.

2. Click the Add Component button. The Assembly Component Edit screen is displayed.

3. In the Product field, enter the product number of the product/service item to be added to
the kit.

4. In the Description field, enter the name of the product/service item you are adding.

5. In the Needed Quantity field, enter the quantity of this product/service item required to
 build the kit.

6. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, enter
enter other
other informa
information
tion in the
the relevan
relevantt fields.
fields.

7. When do
done, cl
click
ick Save. The new component is added to the kit.

2 7 2 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING A COMPONENT/SERVICE ITEM

> To edit a component:

1. Foll
Follow
ow the
the pro
proce
cedu
dure
re in “Editin
“Editing
g an Existing Kit”
Kit” on page 270
270 to
 to get to the kit details
screen.

2. Under the Edit heading, click the Edit link next to the component/service item you want to
edit. The Assembly Component Edit screen is displayed.

3. Edit
Edit the
the rel
relev
evan
antt fie
field
lds.
s.

4. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Save.

DELETING A COMPONENT/SERVICE ITEM FROM A KIT

> To delete a component from a kit:

1. Foll
Follow
ow the
the pro
proce
cedu
dure
re in “Editin
“Editing
g an Existing Kit”
Kit” on page 270
270 to
 to get to the kit details
screen.

2. Selec
Selectt the
the chec
checkb
kbox
ox unde
underr the
the Mark heading for each component/service item you want t o
delete.

3. Click the Delete Components button. You


You are asked to confirm the deletion.

4. Click OK. The component(s)/service item(s) are removed from the kit.

M AI NT AI NI NG K IT S 2 73
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADDING A KIT

You can create a kit in Web Dispatch, if the kit has already been defined as a product in the
R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS database, with an item type of “F”. To define a kit as a product, follow
the instructions in “Addin
“Adding
g a New Product” onon page 269
269..

> To create a kit:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Miscell
Miscellane
aneous
ous tab to displa
display
y the Miscella
Miscellaneo
neous
us Report
Reportss screen.
screen.

3. Next to the Assemblies Manager  selection,


 selection, click Go. Any existing kits are displayed.

2 7 4 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. Click the Add New Assembly button. The Create New Assembly screen is displayed.

5. In the Product field, enter the product number for the kit.

6. In the Description field, enter a description or name of the kit.

7. Optionally
Optionally,, enter
enter any other information
information in the
the relevan
relevantt fields.
fields.

8. When
When done
done,, clic
click
k Save. Your
Your kit has been created and displays in the Assemblies Manager
screen.

9. Clic
Click
k the
the link
link unde
underr the
the Assembly # heading for the new kit.

10. Define the compone


components/serv
nts/service
ice items needed
needed for the kit as described
described in “Adding a
Component/Se
Compo nent/Service
rvice Item to a Kit” on page 271
271..

DELETING A KIT

> To delete a kit:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click the Miscellaneous


Miscellaneous tab to
to display
display the Miscellaneous
Miscellaneous Reports
Reports screen.
screen.

3. Next to the Assemblies Manager  selection,


 selection, click Go. Any existing kits are displayed.

M AI NT AI NI NG K IT S 2 75
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. Selec
Selectt the
the chec
checkb
kbox
ox unde
underr the
the Mark heading for each kit you want to delete.

5. Click the Delete Assemblies button. You


You are asked to confirm the deletion.

6. Click OK. The kit(s) are deleted.

MAINTAINING PACKAGING ITEMS


PACK You can use Web Dispatch to modify existing packaging items, and even add new packaging
items, provided that they are already defined as products in the R ADIO BEACON WMS
database.

To add a new packaging item, see “Adding a Packaging


Packaging Item”
Item” on page 276
276..

To edit an existing packaging item, see “Editin


“Editing
g an Existing Packaging
Packaging item” on page 278
278..

To delete a packaging item, see “Deletin


“Deleting
g a Packaging Item”
Item” on page 281
281..

ADDING A PACKAGING ITEM

You can create a packaging item


ite m in Web
Web Dispatch, if the item has already been defined as a
 product in the R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS database, with wit h an item type of “P”. To define a packaging
item as a product, follow the instructions in “Addin
“Addingg a New Product”
Product” on page 269
269..

> To create a packaging item:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Miscell
Miscellane
aneous
ous tab to displa
display
y the Miscella
Miscellaneo
neous
us Report
Reportss screen.
screen.

2 7 6 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Next to the Packaging Manger  selection,


 selection, click Go. Any existing packaging items are
displayed.

4. Click the Add New Package button. The Create New Package screen is displayed.

5. In the Product field, enter the product number for the packaging item.

6. In the Description field, enter a description or name of the packaging item.

7. Optionally
Optionally,, enter
enter any other information
information in the
the relevan
relevantt fields.
fields.

8. When
When done
done,, clic
click
k Save. The new package item displays in the Packaging Manager screen.

9. To add components
components to
to the packaging
packaging item
item follow
follow the procedu
procedures
res in “Adding a Component
To a Packaging Item”
Item” on page 280
280..

M AI NT AI NI NG P AC KA GI NG I TE MS 2 77
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING AN EXISTING PACKAGING ITEM

To edit the product definition for a packaging item:

1. In the Reports
Reports module,
module, click
click the Miscellaneous
Miscellaneous tab to display the Miscellan
Miscellaneous
eous Reports
Reports
screen.

2. Next to the Packaging Manager  selection,


 selection, click Go. Any existing packaging items are
displayed.

3. Click
Click the
the pac
packa
kagi
ging
ng ite
item
m link
link unde
underr the
the Package # heading. The details of the packaging
item are displayed, showing a components list.

4. To edit
edit an existing
existing packaging
packaging item, you can do
do any of the
the following
following::

• Edit the compon


component
entss that
that are
are defi
defined
ned for the packag
packaging
ing item.
item. See
See “Editing Packaging Item
Components”..
Components”

• Add a com
compo
pone
nent
nt to the
the pac
packa
kagi
ging
ng item
item.. See
See “Adding a Component To a Packaging Item”
on page
page 28
280
0.

• Delet
Deletee a com
compo
pone
nent
nt from
from a pack
packag
agin
ing
g item
item.. See
See “Deleting a Text Line from a Packaging
Item”” on page
Item page 281
281..

2 7 8 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

EDITING PACKAGING ITEM COMPONENTS

> To edit the components that are defined for a packaging item:

1. Foll
Follow
ow the
the pro
proce
cedu
dure
re in “Editin
“Editing
g an Existing Packaging
Packaging item” on page 278
278 to
 to get to the
Components List in packaging items detail screen.

2. Click the Edit link under the Edit PKG Component heading for the component you want
to edit. The Package Component Edit screen is displayed.

3. Edit
Edit the
the rel
relev
evan
antt fie
field
lds.
s.

4. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Save.

M AI NT AI NI NG P AC KA GI NG I TE MS 2 79
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADDING A COMPONENT TO A PACKAGING ITEM

You can add a comment, or text line to an existing or new packaging item.

> To add a text line to a packaging item:

1. Foll
Follow
ow the
the pro
proce
cedu
dure
re in “Editin
“Editing
g an Existing Packaging
Packaging item” on page 278
278 to
 to get to the
 packaging items detail screen.

2. Click the Add Component button. The Package Component Edit screen is displayed.

3. In the Product field, enter the product number of the component to be added to the
 packaging item.

4. In the Description field, enter the name of the component you are adding.

5. In the Needed Quantity field, enter the quantity of this component required for the
 packaging item.

6. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, enter
enter other
other informa
informatio
tion
n in the relevan
relevantt fields.
fields.

7. When do
done, cl
click
ick Save. The new component is added to the packaging item.

2 8 0 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

DELETING A TEXT LINE FROM A PACKAGING ITEM

> To delete a text line from a packaging item:

1. Foll
Follow
ow the
the pro
proce
cedu
dure
re in “Editin
“Editing
g an Existing Packaging
Packaging item” on page 278
278 to
 to get to the
 packaging items detail screen.

2. Selec
Selectt the
the check
checkbo
box
x und
under
er the
the Mark heading for each component you want to delete.

3. Click the Delete Components button. You


You are asked to confirm the deletion.

4. Click OK. The component(s) are removed from the packaging item.

DELETING A PACKAGING ITEM

> To delete a packaging item:

1. In the Reports
Reports module,
module, click
click the Miscellaneous
Miscellaneous tab to display
display the Miscellaneous
Miscellaneous Reports
Reports
screen.

2. Next to the Packaging Manager  selection,


 selection, click Go. Any existing packaging items are
displayed.

3. Selec
Selectt the
the check
checkbo
box
x und
under
er the
the Mark heading for each packaging item you want to delete.

4. Click the Delete Packages button. You


You are asked to confirm the deletion.

5. Click OK. The packaging item(s) are deleted.

MAINTAINING
MAINTAINING CUSTOMERS
If you need to update customer information i n Web
Web Dispatch, you can modify existing
exis ting
customer data, or even add new customers to the system, provided you have the appropriate
 permissions. To modify existing customer information, follow the instructions in “Modifying
Customer
Custom er Information”
Information” on page 282
282 below.
 below. To
To create a new customer, follow the instructions
i nstructions
in “Adding a New Customer
Customer”” on page 283
283..

M AI NT AI NI NG C US TO ME RS 2 81
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MODIFYING CUSTOMER INFORMATION

> To edit customer information:

1. Display the Customer


Customer Report
Report screen
screen for the desired
desired customer,
customer, by using
using any method.
method.

2. Click the Edit button. The Customer Editor screen is displayed.

3. Edit any
any of the
the fields
fields for which you
you want to update
update informatio
information.
n. When
When done,
done, click
click Submit
to save your changes, or Close to cancel. You are returned to the Customer Report screen.

2 8 2 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADDING A NEW CUSTOMER 

> To create a customer:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the
the Picking
Picking tab
tab to displ
display
ay the
the Picking
Picking Repo
Reports
rts scre
screen.
en.

3. Next to the Customer  selection,


 selection, from the Search By drop-down list, select Customer
Number .

4. In the Customer  field,
 field, enter a new (unused) customer number, and click Go. A message
displays that the vendor is not found in the database.

5. Click the Create Customer  button.The


 button.The Customer Editor screen is displayed, with the new
customer number.

6. Enter
Enter inform
informatio
ation
n in the
the releva
relevant
nt fields
fields,, as descr
describe
ibed
d in “Modifying Customer
Information
Information”” on page 282
282..

7. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Submit to create the product (or Reset to cancel). The Customer Report
screen is displayed for the new customer.

MAINTAINING VENDORS
If need to update vendor information in Web Dispatch, you can modify existing vendor data, or
even add new vendors to the system,
s ystem, provided you have the appropriate permis sions. To
modify existing vendor information, follow the instructions in “Modifying Vendor
Information”
Information” on page
page 284
284 below.
 below. To
To create a new vendor, follow the instructions
inst ructions in “Adding a
 New Vendor”
Vendor” on page 285
285..

M AI NT AI NI NG V EN DO RS 2 83
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MODIFYING VENDOR INFORMATION

> To edit vendor information:

1. Display the
the Vendor
Vendor Report
Report screen for the
the desired
desired vendor,
vendor, by
by using any method.
method.

2. Click the Edit button. The Vendor Information screen is


i s displayed.

3. Edit any
any of the
the fields
fields for which you
you want to update
update informatio
information.
n. When
When done,
done, click
click Submit
to save your changes, or Close to cancel. You are returned to the
t he Vendor
Vendor Report screen.

2 8 4 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ADDING A NEW
NE W VENDOR 

> To create a vendor:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Recei
Receivin
ving
g tab to displ
display
ay the Rece
Receivin
iving
g Reports
Reports screen
screen..

3. In the Vendor  field,
 field, enter a new (unused) vendor number, and click Go. A message
displays that the vendor is not found in the database.

4. Click the Create Vendor  button.


 button. The Vendor Information screen is displayed, with the
new vendor number.

5. Enter
Enter inform
informatio
ation
n in the
the releva
relevant
nt fields
fields,, as descr
describe
ibed
d in “Modifying Vendor Information”
on pag
pagee 284
284..

6. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Submit to create the vendor (or Close to cancel). The Vendor
Vendor Report
screen is displayed for the new vendor.

M AI NT AI NI NG V EN DO RS 2 85
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2 8 6 C H A P T E R 8 E D I T I N G O R D E R S A N D W A R E H O U S E D A T A
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

9 ENTERING ORDERS
O/E

If your system is configured to allow Web order entry,


entry, you can create purchase orders, s ales
orders, transfer and packaging orders from t he Reports module in Web Dispatch. This chapter
discusses the following functions:

• Entering sales orders —described in “Enter


“Entering
ing Sales Orders”
Orders” on page 288
288..

• Entering purchase orders —described in “Enter


“Entering
ing Purchase
Purchase Orders” on page 297
297..

LOC • Ente
Enteri
ring
ng tra
trans
nsfe
ferr orde
orders
rs—d
—des
escr
crib
ibed
ed in
in “Enteri
“Entering
ng Transfer
Transfer Orders” on page 293
293..

• Enter
Entering
ing pack
packag
agin
ing
g orde
orders—
rs—de
desc
scri
ribe
bed
d in “Enter
“Entering
ing Packaging
Packaging Orders” on page
page 302
302..
PACK
Any orders created in Web Dispatch do not update a host system—except to the extent that
 pick /receipt confirmations or stock move transactions, as applicable, are uploaded to the host
system when a sales/transfer sales order is picked and shipped or a purchase order is received
and closed.

Note: For sales orders and purchase orders, Web order entry should only be used in
exceptional circumstances, or by warehouses that do not use a host system, since they
do not update the host.

2 8 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ENTERING SALES ORDERS


When you create a sales order in Web Dispatch, it must be allocated and processed in the usual
fashion.

Note: Before you can use the Order Entry function to create sales orders, customers and
 products must be assigned to order groups in your database. If you receive the
message that no products are available for the selected customer, this may because the
customer has not been assigned to an order group. For more information, contact your
system administrator or Radio Beacon Customer Support.

Entering a sales order involves the following steps:

1. Create a sales
sal es order. Follow
order. Follow the procedure in “Creating a Sales Order” below.
Order”  below.

2. Add lines to the order . Follow the procedure in “Adding Lines to a Sales Order” on
 page 289
289..

3. Opt
Option
ionally,
ly, edit or delete lines in
lines in the order. Follow the procedure in “Modifying or
Deleting a Line
Line in a Sales Order” on page
page 292
292..

4. Complete the order . Follow the procedure in “Comp


“Completing
leting a Sales Order”
Order” on page
page 290
290..

CREATING A SALES ORDER 

> To create a sales order:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Clic
Click
k the
the Orde
Orderr Ent
Entry
ry tab.
tab.

3. Next to the Sales Order Entry selection, in the Customer  field,


 field, enter the number of the
customer for whom you are creating the order.

2 8 8 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. Optionally
Optionally,, specify
specify an order number for this
this sales order by entering
entering it in the
the PKS# field, or
leave this field blank to let R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS generate the order number
automatically.

5. From
From the
the dro
drop-
p-do
down
wn list
list in the
the Warehouse field, optionally select a warehouse from
which to pick the order. The drop-down list displays the warehouses defined for your
system. The default is the first warehouse in the list. This field can be ignored if you have
only one logical warehouse in your system.

6. Click Go. The Sales Order Entry screen is displayed.

7. Add lines to the order  by


 by following the procedure in “Adding Lines to a Sales Order”
 below.

ADDING LINES TO A SALES ORDER 

> To add lines to a sales order:

1. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• In the Product field, enter the product number, and in the Qty field, enter the quantity
you want to order, and click Add. The line is added to the order.

• Depend
Depending
ing on
on your
your config
configura
uratio
tion,
n, you
you may be able
able to
to use the
the Looku
Lookupp functio
functionn to
display a list of all products the selected customer is set up to purchase, and the
availability of those products. Enter at least one character search criteria in the
Product field and click Lookup. To add a product from the list that displays, click
Add in the Get column for the product. Then enter the quantity you want to order in in
the Qty field.

• If you
you have prev
previous
iously
ly saved
saved ‘carts’
‘carts’ of
of items
items for that
that custom
customer
er,, you can
can select
select a cart
cart in
the Load Cart drop-down list, and click Load Cart.

E NT ER IN G S A LE S O RD ER S 2 89
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To add more
more produc
products/q
ts/quan
uantiti
tities
es to the order
order,, repeat
repeat this
this proc
procedu
edure.
re.

• To save
save the
the lines
lines to a ‘cart’
‘cart’ that
that can
can be
be retrie
retrieved
ved later
later,, click
click Save Cart.

• To comp
comple
lete
te the
the ord
order
er,, foll
follow
ow the
the pro
proce
cedu
dure
re in
in “Completing a Sales Order” below.
Order”  below.

• To modi
modify
fy or
or dele
delete
te a lin
line,
e, fol
follo
low
w the
the proc
procedu
edure
re in
in “Modifying or Deleting a Line in a
Sales Order”
Order” on page 292
292..

COMPLETING A SALES ORDER 

Once you have completed a sales


sal es order, you can still edit it, before ‘checking out’. Once you
have checked out of the order, you cannot modify it through the Order Entry screen, but must
edit the Packslip Report for
Report  for it; to do so, follow the procedures in “Editing Sales, Work,
Packaging
Packag ing and Transfer
Transfer Sales Orders” on page 260 260 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and
Warehouse Data”.
Data”.

2 9 0 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To complete a sales order:

1. From
From the
the Sales
Sales Ord
Orderer Ent
Entry
ry scr
scree
een,
n, clic
click
k Complete Order . The Customer Information
screen is displayed.

2. Option
Optionally
ally,, edit any
any of the fiel
fields
ds of custo
customer
mer infor
informat
mation
ion..

3. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, enter
enter instruc
instructio
tions
ns for the
the order
order in any
any of the Instruction fields.

4. When
When done,
one, clic
click
k Continue to Checkout. The Additional Order Information screen is
displayed.

E NT ER IN G S A LE S O RD ER S 2 91
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

5. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, in
in the
the Customer PO# field, enter the cust omer’s purchase order number for
this order.
order.

6. Opti
Optioonall
nally
y, in
in the
the Date Required field, enter the date the customer would like to receive
the order, in MM/DD/YYYY format.

7. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, enter
enter instruc
instruction
tionss for the
the order
order in any
any of the Instruction fields.

8. Do any
any of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To comp
comple
lete
te and
and sav
savee the
the orde
orderr, clic
click
k Continue to Checkout. A message appears,
confirming that the order has been entered. The order will automatically appear in the
Orders module as an unallocated sales order.

• To edi
editt any
any line
liness in the
the ord
order
er,, cli
click
ck Modify Cart. You are returned to the first Sales
Order Entry screen. Continue by following the procedures in “Modifying or Deleting
a Line in a Sales
Sales Order”
Order” on page 292 292..

MODIFYING OR DELETING A LINE IN A SALES ORDER 

You can only modify or delete lines in a sales order that has not yet been completed. If you
need to modify a line in an already-saved sales order, see the procedure in “Editing Sales/
Work/Transfer/Packaging Order Line Details” on page 262 262 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and
Warehouse Data”.
Data”.

> To modify or delete


delet e a line:

1. If you
you are on
on the Addi
Addition
tional
al Order
Order Infor
Informati
mation
on scree
screen,
n, click
click Modify Cart to return to the
first Sales Order entry screen.

2. In the
the line
line you want to edit
edit or delete, click the quantity
quantity link under the Quantity heading.
The following dialog box appears.

2 9 2 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To modi
modify
fy the quanti
quantity
ty ordere
ordered,
d, enter
enter the new quanti
quantity
ty..

• To dele
delete
te the
the line
line com
compl
plet
etel
ely
y, ente
enterr 0 as the quantity
quantit y.

4. Click OK. The line is updated or removed from the shopping cart.

ENTERING TRANSFER ORDERS


OR DERS
LOC The warehouse transfer functionality uses transfer sales orders followed
orders followed by transfer purchase
orders to
orders to request and track the transfer of products from one site to another, via a transit site.
This two-step transfer function mirrors the physical process of transferring product out  of
 of one
warehouse and into another
into another warehouse.

Transfer sales orders initiate the warehouse transfer. The Web order entry functionality in the
Reports module can be used to create transfer sales order and define the parameters of the
transfer operation including:

• the
the prod
produc
ucts
ts and
and quan
quanti
titi
ties
es to
to tran
transf
sfer 
er 

• the wa
warehou
house of
of or
origi
igin ( from warehouse)
 from warehouse)

• the
the dest
destin
inat
atio
ion
n ware
wareho
hou
use (to warehouse)
to warehouse)

• the tran
transit
sit wareh
warehouse
ouse (can
(can also
also be
be a site ‘en
‘en route
route’’ such as, ‘on
‘on the
the water’,
water’, ‘on the
the road’
road’,, or
in a temporary location)

The transfer sales order is used to pick and pack the items that will be shipped out of the  from
warehouse. Transfer sales orders created in Web Dispatch must be allocated and processed in
the same way as regular sales orders. Transfer sales orders can also be edited and viewed in the
same way as regular sales orders, except that in the Web Dispatch interface, their status is
 preceded with TRANS; for example TRANSUNALLOCATE,
TRANSUNALLOCATE, TRANSHELDSHORT , etc.

E NT ER IN G T RA NS FE R O RD ER S 2 93
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Entering a sales order involves the following steps:

1. Create a sales
sal es order. Follow
order. Follow the procedure in “Creating a Transfer Order” below.
Order”  below.

2. Add lines to the order . Follow the procedure in “Adding Lines to a Transfer Order” on
 page 295
295..

3. Opt
Option
ionally,
ly, edit or delete lines in
lines in the order. Follow the procedure in “Modifying or
Deleting a Line
Line in a Sales Order” on page
page 292
292..

4. Complete the order . Follow the procedure in “Comp


“Completing
leting a Sales Order”
Order” on page
page 290
290..

CREATING A TRANSFER
TRANSFER ORDER 

> To create a transfer sales order:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Clic
Click
k the
the Orde
Orderr Ent
Entry
ry tab.
tab.

3. Next to the Transfer Order Entry selection, in the From Warehouse field, select the
warehouse of origin from the drop-down list. The drop-down list displays the warehouses
defined for your system.

4. In the Transit Warehouse field, select the transit warehouse from the drop-down list. The
transit warehouse can also be a site ‘en route’ such as, ‘on the water’, ‘on the road’, or in
a temporary location. The drop-down list displays the warehouses defined for your system.

5. In the To Warehouse field, select the destination warehouse from the drop-down list. The
drop-down list displays the warehouses defined for your system.

2 9 4 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

6. Click Go. The Sales Order Entry screen is displayed.

7. Add lines to the order  by


 by following the procedure in “Adding Lines to a Transfer Order”
 below.

ADDING LINES TO A TRANSFER


TRANSFER ORDER 

Depending on your configuration, you may be able to display a list of all products that can be
transferred, by using the Lookup function. Product availability may also be indicated.

> To add lines to a transfer sales order:

1. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• In the Product field, enter the product number, and in the Qty field, enter the quantity
you want to order, and click Add. The line is added to the order.

• Depend
Depending
ing on
on your
your config
configura
uratio
tion,
n, you
you may be able
able to
to use the
the Looku
Lookupp functio
functionn to
display a list of all products that can be transferred, and the availability of those
 products. Enter at least one character search criteria in the Product field and click
Lookup. To add a product from the list that displays, c lick Add in the Get column for
the product. Then enter the quantity you want to order in the Qty field.

2. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To add
add more
more produc
products/q
ts/quan
uantiti
tities
es to the
the order
order,, repeat
repeat this
this proc
procedu
edure.
re.

• To comp
complet
letee the
the orde
orderr, follo
follow
w the
the proc
proced
edur
uree in “Completing a Transfer Order” below.
Order”  below.

• To modi
modify
fy or
or dele
delete
te a line
line,, follo
follow
w the
the proc
proced
edur
uree in “Modifying or Deleting a Line in a
Sales Order”
Order” on page
page 292
292..

E NT ER IN G T RA NS FE R O RD ER S 2 95
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

COMPLETING A TRANSFER
TRANSFER ORDER 

You can still edit a transfer sales before completing the order. Once completed, you cannot
modify it through the Order Entry screen, but must edit the Packslip Report for
Report for it; to do so,
follow the procedures in “Editing Sales, Work, Packaging and Transfer Sales Orders” on
 page 260
260 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and Warehouse Data”.
Data” .

> To complete a sales order:

1. From
From the
the Tran
Transfer
sfer Order
Order Entr
Entry
y scree
screen,
n, click
click Complete Order . You
You receive a message that
the transfer order is created.

MODIFYING OR DELETING A LINE IN A TRANSFER ORDER 

You can only modify or delete lines in


i n a transfer sales order that has not yet been completed. If
you need to modify a line in an already-saved transfer sales
sal es order, see the procedure in “Editing
Sales/Work/Transfer/Packaging
Sales/Work /Transfer/Packaging Order Line Details” on page 262 262 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders
and Warehouse Data”.
Data”.

> To modify or delete


delet e a line:

1. In the
the line
line you want to edit
edit or delete, click the quantity
quantity link under the Quantity heading.
The following dialog box appears.

2 9 6 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To modi
modify
fy the quanti
quantity
ty ordere
ordered,
d, enter
enter the new quanti
quantity
ty..

• To dele
delete
te the
the line
line com
compl
plet
etel
ely
y, ente
enterr 0 as the quantity
quantit y.

3. Click OK. The line is updated or removed from the order.

ENTERING PURCHASE ORDERS


When you create a purchase order in Web
Web Dispatch, it is received into the warehouse in the
usual fashion. However, depending on your configuration, the order may need to be released 
 before it can be received; for information on releasing purchase orders, see “Releasing
Purchasee Orders” on
Purchas on page 177
177..

Entering a purchase order involves the following steps:

1. Create a purchase order . Follow the procedure in “Creating a Purchase Order” below.


Order”  below.

2. Add lines to the order . Follow the procedure in “Adding Lines to a Purchase Order” on
 page 298
298..

3. Option
ionall
ally, edit or delete lines in
lines in the order. Follow the procedure in “Modifying or
Deleting
Deleting a Line in a Purcha
Purchasese Order” on page 301
301..

4. Complete the order . Follow the procedure in “Compl


“Completing
eting a Purchase
Purchase Order” on page 299
299..

CREATING A PURCHASE ORDER 

> To create a purchase order:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Clic
Click
k the
the Orde
Orderr Ent
Entry
ry tab.
tab.

E NT ER IN G P UR CH AS E O RD ER S 2 97
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3. Next to the Purchase Order Entry selection, in the Vendor  field,


 field, enter the number of the
vendor whose product you want to purchase.

4. Optionally
Optionally,, specify
specify a PO number
number for this purchase
purchase order
order by
by entering
entering it in
in the PO# field, or
leave this field blank to let R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS generate the PO number automatically.

5. Click Go. The Purchase Order Entry screen is displayed.

6. Add lines to the order  by


 by following the procedure in “Adding Lines to a Purchase Order”
 below.

ADDING LINES TO A PURCHASE ORDER 

Depending on your configuration, you may be able to display a list of all products for the
selected vendor, by using the Lookup function. Product availability m ay also be indicated. In
the following procedure, the Lookup function is not described.

> To add lines to a purchase order:

1. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• In the Product field, enter the product number, and in the Qty field, enter the quantity
you want to order, and click Add. The line is added to the order.

• Depend
Depending
ing on
on your
your config
configura
uratio
tion,
n, you
you may be be able to use the
the Looku
Lookup
p functio
function
n to
display a list of all products setup for the selected
s elected vendor, and the quantity of those
 products in stock in the warehouse. Enter at least one character search criteria in the
Product field and click Lookup. To add a product from the list that displays, click
Add in the Get column for the product. Then enter the quantity you want to order in
the Qty field.

• If you
you have
have previo
previously
usly saved
saved ‘carts
‘carts’’ of items
items for
for that
that vendor
vendor you
you can
can select
select a cart
cart in
the Load Cart drop-down list, and click Load Cart.

2 9 8 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

2. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To add
add more
more produc
products/q
ts/quan
uantiti
tities
es to the
the order
order,, repeat
repeat this
this proc
procedu
edure.
re.

• To save
save the
the lines
lines to a ‘cart’
‘cart’ that can be retr
retriev
ieved
ed later
later,, click
click Save Cart.

• To comp
complet
letee the
the orde
orderr, follo
follow
w the
the proc
proced
edur
uree in “Completing a Purchase Order” below.
Order”  below.

• To modi
modify
fy or
or dele
delete
te a line
line,, follo
follow
w the
the proc
proced
edur
uree in “Modifying or Deleting a Line in a
Purchase
Purchase Order”
Order” on page 301301..

COMPLETING A PURCHASE ORDER 

Once you have completed a purchase order, you can still edit it, before “checking out”. Once
you have checked out of the order, you cannot modify it through the O rder Entry screen, but
must edit the Purchase Order Report for
Report  for it; to do so, follow the procedures in “Editing Purchase
Orders and Transfer
Transfer Purchase Orders” on page
page 263
263 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and
Warehouse Data”
Da ta”..

E NT ER IN G P UR CH AS E O RD ER S 2 99
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To complete a purchase order:

1. From the Purchas


Purchasee Order
Order Entry
Entry screen,
screen, click
click Complete Order . The Additional Order
Information screen is displayed.

2. Opti
Optio
onall
nally
y, in
in the
the Due Date field, enter the date you would like to receive the order, in
MM/DD/YYYY format.

3. Optiona
Optionally
lly,, enter
enter instruc
instruction
tionss for the
the order
order in any
any of the Instruction fields.

4. Do any
any of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To comp
comple
lete
te and
and sav
savee the
the orde
orderr, clic
click
k Continue to Checkout. A message appears,
confirming that the order has been entered. The order will automatically appear in the
Receiving module as an unreceived purchase order.

• To edi
editt any
any lin
lines
es in the
the ord
order
er,, cli
click
ck Modify Cart. You
You are returned to the first Purchase
P urchase
Order Entry screen. Continue by following the procedures in “Modifying or Deleting
a Line in a Purchase Order” below.
Order”  below.

3 0 0 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

MODIFYING OR DELETING A LINE IN A PURCHASE ORDER 

You can only modify or delete lines in a p urchase order that has not yet been completed. If you
need to modify a line in an already-saved purchase order, see the procedure in “Editing or
Deleting Purchase
Purchase Order Line
Line Details” on page 265
265 of
 of Chapter 8, “Editing Orders and
Warehouse Data”
Da ta”..

> To modify or delete a line:

1. If you
you are on the
the Additio
Additional
nal Order
Order Info
Informa
rmation
tion scre
screen,
en, click
click Modify Cart to return to the
first Purchase Order entry screen.

2. In the
the line
line you want to
to edit
edit or delete, click the quantity
quantity link under the Quantity heading.
The following dialog box appears.

3. Do one
one of
of the
the foll
follow
owin
ing:
g:

• To modi
modify
fy the quanti
quantity
ty ordere
ordered,
d, enter
enter the new quanti
quantity
ty..

• To dele
delete
te the
the line
line com
compl
plet
etel
ely
y, ente
enterr 0 as the quantity.

4. Click OK. The line is updated or removed from the shopping cart.

E NT ER IN G P UR CH AS E O RD ER S 3 01
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

ENTERING PACKAGING ORDERS


If your warehouse uses packaging orders to repackage products into different packsizes, you
PACK can use the Web Order Entry feature to create packaging orders for any packaging item
defined, for any packsize and quantity you wish. Note that the inventory must be available in
an overstock (carton) bin in the quantity you need in order for the packaging order to be
successfully created.

When you create a packaging order, R ADIO


ADIO BEACON WMS automatically assignsass igns it a number,
 prefixed by the packaging identifier specified in your setup, and assigns a work area, numbered
identically to the work order number. Once the order is created, it is automatically allocated,
and replenishment requests are generated to move the product from overstock to the designated
work area.

> To create a packaging order:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Clic
Click
k the
the Orde
Orderr Ent
Entry
ry tab.
tab.

3. Next to the Packaging Order Entry selection, in the Product field, enter the number of
the product to be repackaged.

4. Opti
Optio onall
nally
y, in
in the
the Zone From field, enter the zone from which you want the stock to be
allocated. If you leave this field blank, stock will be allocated from the first zone in which
it is available in a carton bin.

5. In the Packsize To field, enter the packsize that is required for the product.

6. In the Quantity to Build  field, enter the number of packs that are required to be built.

7. Click Go. If there is not enough inventory in a carton bin in the zone you specified, the
message “Not enough units available” is displayed. Otherwise, a message is displayed that
the order has been successfully created.

8. Click OK to return to the Order Entry screen. The order automatically appears in the
Orders table, in the s tatus PKG - WAITING LETDOWN, and stock for the order can be
replenished immediately
immediatel y.

3 0 2 C H A P T E R 9 E N T E R I N G O R D E R S
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

10 USING ADVANCE
REPLEN
REPLENISHMENT

UNDERSTANDING ADVANCE REPLENISHMENT


Advance replenishment is a technique that allows you to request replenishment for pick bins in
advance of sales and work order requirements. By using advance replenishment, pick bins can
 be filled before orders are even issued, and orders can be successfully allocated the first time,
avoiding the need to issue “hot” replenishment requests for the necessary stock.

R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS supports two types of advance replenishment: min/max and
min/max and days on
hand . If you are using advance replenishment in your warehouse, your system will be
configured to use one or the other. For min/max replenishment, see “Min/Max Replenishment”
on page
page 30303
3 below. For days on hand replenishment, see “Days on Hand Replenishment” on
 page 304
304..

MIN/MAX REPLENISHMENT

In min/max replenishment,
min/max replenishment, replenishment requests are issued for products that have dropped
 below a defined minimum for specific bins/packsizes, or for all other pick bins in the
warehouse. The advance replenishment function compares the amount of inventory in bins
where a minimum has been defined for a specific packsize and a range of pick bins that you
specify (without a minimum defined for them), against the minimum
minim um amount, for one of the
five standard packsizes of a given product. If there is not enough inventory, a replenishment
request is created (assuming that bulk stock is available for replenishment). The quantities
requested are determined by a defined maximum quantity of product that can be stored for each
 product for specific bins, or for all bins in the warehouse.

3 0 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

To use this method, your warehouse must have already defined minimum and maximum levels
for each product/packsize or product/bin/packsize in the warehouse, through the Set Replen
Levels or Pickslots (if your warehouse uses sticky homes)
homes) functions on the handheld. For more
information, see “Setting or Modifying Replenishment Levels” or
Levels”  or “Setting or Modifying
Replenishment Levels for a Specific Bin” in
Bin”  in Using RADIO BEACON Handheld Functions.
Functions .

Note: If your warehouse does not use sticky homes, advance replenishment requests will not
 be issued for specific bins if there are no longer any quantities of the particular
 product in the bin for which the minimum level is defined.

DAYS ON HAND REPLENISHMENT

In this method, replenishment requests are issued for products which have less inventory in
 pick bins for the five standard packsizes than is estimated to be required, for each of those
sizes, to meet the demand for a time period you specify. The advance replenishment function
compares the amount of inventory in all of t he pick bins against the estimated
estimat ed amount required
to satisfy a given number of days of picking. If there is not enough stock, a replenishment
request is created (assuming that bulk storage is available to replenish from). By default, the
quantities requested are for only enough stock to bring the pick bins up to the given number of
days of picking; however, you can also specify a great er number of days, so that more product
than is needed to satisfy the estimated demand is actually replenished.

To use this method, the average daily quantity of picks must be maintained for each product.
This is done by the Calculate Demand Requirements function in RFBase, which may be run
daily and calculates the average
avera ge number of picks per day for each product for the previous
month, or for the previous 30 days (rolling), depending on your configuration. This average is
then used to estimate the quantities of products that are required on a daily basis.

3 0 4 C H A P T E R 1 0 U S I N G A D V A N C E R E P L E N I S H M E N T
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

RUNNING THE ADVANCE REPLENISHMENT


FUNCTION
Regardless of which type of advance replenishment your warehouse uses, you us e the Advance
Replenishment function from Web Dispatch to first generate an Advance Replenishment
Report, and then generate the actual replenishment requests that are used by warehouse staff to
 perform their replenishment tasks.

Note: If you run the advance replenishment function several times, the quantities to
replenish are incremented, even if products still already have outstanding
replenishment requests. Thus, it is recommended that you only run advance
replenishment after all of the existing requests have been fulfilled.

Running the Advance Replenishment function involves the following steps:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click
Click the Inve
Invento
ntory
ry tab to
to display
display the
the Invento
Inventory
ry Repor
Reports
ts screen.
screen.

3. Next to the Advance Replenishment Report selection, click Go.

or,

 Next to the Replenishment Report selection, click Go. Outstanding replenishment


requests, if any, are displayed. (You
(You should wait for these to be cleared before running
Advance Replenishment). Right-click anywhere in the screen, and from the pop-up menu
that is displayed, select Advance Replenishment.

R U NN IN G T H E A D VA N CE R EP L EN I SH ME N T F U NC T IO N 3 0 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

4. The Advance
Advance Repleni
Replenishment
shment Settings
Settings window
window is displayed
displayed,, for either min/max or days
days on
hand replenishment, according to your system configuration.

5. Opt
Option
ionally,
ly, modify advance replenishment options , according to the method you are usi ng.
Information about these options is provided in “Understanding and Modifying Advance
Replenishment
Replen ishment Options”
Options” on page 307
307..

6. Click Submit to run the Advance Replenishment Report before actually generating any
replenishment requests, for evaluation purposes. The Advance Replenishment Report is
displayed.

7. Revi
Review
ew the
the rep
repor
ort.
t.

3 0 6 C H A P T E R 1 0 U S I N G A D V A N C E R E P L E N I S H M E N T
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

8. Opti
Option
onal
ally
ly,, repe
repeat
at ste
steps
ps 3 to 7 to re-run the Advance Replenishment report, and modify
any settings, if necess ary.
ary.

9. When you
you are
are satisfied
satisfied with
with the results of the report
report and are ready
ready to
to generate
generate the
the
replenishment requests, right-click anywhere on the Advanced Replenishment report, and
from the pop-up menu that is displayed, select Issue Replenishment Request option. In
the box that displays click Submit. The replenishment requests are generated, and the
Replenishment Report is (re)displayed, including the requests that were generated for the
advance group.

UNDERSTANDING AND MODIFYING ADVANCE REPLENISHMENT


OPTIONS

For both types of advance replenishment, min/max and days on hand, you can modify the
following options:

Option Use to...


Location If R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS is managing multiple locations, specify
LOC the physical location(s) for which bins should be replenished. If
you leave the field blank, all locations will be included.
Starting Pick Bin Limit the range of pick bins for which
w hich R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS will
issue replenishment requests. Enter the starting pick bin. If you
leave this field blank, all bins in the zones included in your
system configuration will be included.

R U NN IN G T H E A D VA N CE R EP L EN I SH ME N T F U NC T IO N 3 0 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Option Use to...


Ending Pick Bin Limit the range of pick bins for which
w hich R ADIO
ADIO BEACON WMS will
issue replenishment requests. Enter the ending pick bin. If you
leave this field blank, all bins in the zones included in your
system configuration will be included.
Maximum # SKUs to Limit the number of products for which replenishment requests
Call For  should be generated, to control replenishers’ workloads. Only the
 products with the least amount of inventory will be replenished.
For example, if you enter 50, replenishment requests will only be
generated for the 50 products in your warehouse with the least
amount of inventory. If you leave this field blank, a default of 100
is used.
Include Replenish Include zones in which to search for available products to
ZONE Zones replenish pick bins. If you leave this field blank, all zones are
searched.
Replenishment Group Assign a name to the group of replenishment requests that will be
issued. This name appears in the Letdown Stock replenishment
function on the handheld (for information, see “Letting Down
Stock” in
Stock”  in Using RADIO BEACON Handheld Functions).
Functions ). By
using a meaningful name, you can indicate to replenishers the
urgency or priority of the replenishment request, or a destination
to which the stock should be brought.
If you do not specify a replenishment group name, the issued
replenishment requests will
wil l be assigned to the group ADVANCE
ADVANCE
 by default.

3 0 8 C H A P T E R 1 0 U S I N G A D V A N C E R E P L E N I S H M E N T
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

For days on hand replenishment, you can modify the following additional options:

Option Use to...


Minimum # of Days Specify the minimum number of days’ worth of products that
Trigger  should be in pick bins. Any products that do not have inventory to
fulfill orders for this number of days will be replenished. The
default is 1 (i.e. any products with less than one day’s worth of
stock on hand will be replenished). If you modify the default, you
may also need to enter a value greater than the quantity you
specify here in the Replenish # of Days field (see below).
Replenish # of Days Specify the number of days’ worth of product that should be
replenished to pick bins. The default is 15 (i.e. 15 days worth of
stock will be requested for replenishment). Be sure that the
quantity here is greater than that specified in the Minimum # of
Days field (see above).

R U NN IN G T H E A D VA N CE R EP L EN I SH ME N T F U NC T IO N 3 0 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

3 1 0 C H A P T E R 1 0 U S I N G A D V A N C E R E P L E N I S H M E N T
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

11 TROUBLESHOOTING
Web Dispatch offers several mechanisms for troubleshooting warehouse processes in R ADIO
BEACON WMS:

• Log repo
reports
rts — Log
Log report
reportss can help
help you
you or Radio
Radio Beacon
Beacon supp
support
ort staff
staff trac
tracee the histor
history
y of
a problem you may be encountering. Described in “Using the Log
Log Reports”
Reports” on page 311 311..

• Test databa
database
se — The Create
Create Test
Test Databa
Database
se functi
function
on allows
allows you
you to genera
generate
te a snapsho
snapshott of
your actual database in its current state, which can then be sent to Radio Beacon support
staff for analysis. Described in “Creati
“Creating
ng a Test Order Database”
Database” on page 316
316..

USING THE LOG REPORTS


Log reports are of three types:

• Log Look
Lookup
up Repor
Report—sh
t—shows
ows all
all log
log entries
entries on
on a selecte
selected
d date
date sorted
sorted by
by users,
users, activ
activitie
ities,
s,
 bins, orders, or products. This report is only available from the Reports module.

• Log repor
reportt for a selecte
selected
d produc
product,
t, bin,
bin, sales
sales order
order, or purcha
purchase
se order—
order—sho
shows
ws cumulati
cumulative
ve
entries since the last time the database was purged (this is determined by your system
configuration). These reports are only accessible with the Log button on the Product, Bin,
Packslip, and Purchase Order Report screens, for users with the required permissions.

• Error
Error Repor
Report—ac
t—access
cessible
ible from
from the
the Reports
Reports modul
module,
e, this
this report
report displ
displays
ays error
errorss that may
may
have been generated during a particular action, and can help Radio Beacon support staff
identify the cause of a software failure.

These reports are described in the sections following.

3 1 1
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GENERATING THE LOG LOOKUP REPORT

This report shows all log entries for a selected date, sorted by user ID, action, bin, product,
sales, work, or purchase order. Each report shows the action that wa s performed, the result, and
any error messages, if applicable.

Note: The dates available for selection are determined by your configuration. The default is
within the last 6 months. If you would like to view an extended, historical log report
for a product, bin, sales, purchase order, or bin, see “Generating the Log Reports” on
 page 314
314..

3 1 2 C H A P T E R 1 1 T R O U B L E S H O O T I N G
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

> To generate a log lookup report:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click the Miscellaneous


Miscellaneous tab to
to display
display the Miscellaneous
Miscellaneous Reports
Reports screen.
screen.

3. Next to the Log Lookup selection, in the Date field, enter the date for which you want to
view data, or leave the field
fiel d blank to select today’s date.

4. From the Action drop-down box, select any of the following:

• User ID — Sorts the report according to user ID.

• Extended — Sorts the report according to extended product number.

• Binlabel — Sorts the report according to bin number.

• Action — Sorts the report according to the


t he type of action that was performed, such as
move in, move out, replenishment, allocation, and so on.

• Packslip — Sorts the report according to order number (sales, purchase, or work
orders are included).

5. When
When rea
ready
dy to
to disp
display
lay the
the rep
repor
ort,
t, clic
click
k Go.

U S I NG T HE L OG R EP OR TS 3 1 3
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GENERATING THE LOG REPORTS

Log reports show all log entries for the previous number of months specified in your
configuration. (The default is six months.) The number of records disp layed is also determined
 by your configuration; the default is the 2000 most recent records. You
You can also filter the
reports to show only the log entries for a selected product, order, or bin, or any combination
thereof.
Each report shows the action that was performed, the result, and any error messages, if
applicable. These reports are helpful for troubleshooting problems with orders, debugging
allocation failures due to wrong formats, and so on.
The example shown below is the log report for sales order 1000002.

> To generate a log report for a selected product, bin, or order:

In the Product, Packslip, Purchase Order or Bin Detail report screens, click the Log button.

3 1 4 C H A P T E R 1 1 T R O U B L E S H O O T I N G
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

GENERATING THE ERRORS REPORT

The Error Report shows any run-time errors and warnings returned by the software when any
function was accessed on the date specified for the report. This report may be used to help
Radio Beacon support or development staff troubleshoot software problems that you may be
encountering.

> To generate an error report:

1. Go to the
the Rep
Repor
orts
ts modu
module
le..

2. Click the Miscellaneous


Miscellaneous tab to
to display
display the Miscellaneous
Miscellaneous Reports
Reports screen.
screen.

3. Next to the Errors on date selection, in the Date field, enter the date for which you want
to view errors and warnings, or leave the field blank to select
s elect today’s date.

4. Click Go.

U S I NG T HE L OG R EP OR TS 3 1 5
  U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

CREATING A TEST ORDER DATABASE


If you need to report an incident to Radio Beacon Technical Support personnel, and would like
to submit a snapshot of your database, you can create a “test” order database for selected
orders, provided that the RBTest database has already been created on your SQL Server (for
information, contact your system administrator). All the rel evant data for the orders you select,
including product, customer, vendor, and order information, as well as your entire
configuration (including users, bins, and all selected options) will automatically be included.
The test order database will be updated on your SQL Server, and a system administrator can
 back up the database to a disk file that can be submitted to Radio Beacon.

1. Select the order(s) for


order(s)  for which you want to create a test database. For procedures for
selecting orders, see “General Procedures for
for Processing Orders” on page 4444..

2. Right-click
Right-click anywher
anywheree on the screen
screen you
you are using, and from
from the
the pop-up
pop-up menu,
menu, select
select Test
Order Database. The Test Order Database window is displayed.

3. Click Submit. When the test database is created, a message is displayed.

3 1 6 C H A P T E R 1 1 T R O U B L E S H O O T I N G
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

INDEX

NUMERICS Advance Replenishment options  307


Ending Pick Bin  308
100% Fill 75
Include Replenish Zones  308
Location 307
Maximum# SKUs to Call For  308 308
A Minimum# of Days Trigger  309
 309
Activity Monitor Report 250 Replenish# of Days  309
Activity Report  252 Replenishment Group  308
Ad Hoc SQL Report  255 Starting Pick Bin  307
Add Assembly 274, 276 Advance Replenishment Report  305
Add ServItem 271 alert 23
Add Subcomponent  271 Allocate options
Add Text Line 280 100% Fill 75
adding Allocate To 72, 73, 151
customers 283 Assembly Label Printing 153
kits 274 Assume Infinite Stock  75
 75
lines to purchase orders  266, 298 Attribute/Expiry/Packsize  74, 152
lines to sales orders  289 Auto Short All  75
lines to transfer sales orders  295 Auto Short Non-Stocks  75
orders to bills of lading  126 By Zone Sequence  78, 153
orders to manifests  126 Days to Expiry 74, 152
 packaging item 276 Deplete Smaller Packsize 71, 151
 products 269 Exclude Zones  73
service items to kits 271 Fair Share 73
vendors 285 FIFO 71, 151
Adjustments Report 241 Fifty Rule 72
administrative functions 3 General 71, 150
advance replenishment 303 Hold for Replenishment  76
days on hand  304 Hold for Shorts  75
min/max 303 Include Zones  73, 77

3 1 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Include Zones for Kitting  153 assembly info 145


LIFO 71, 151 Assembly Label Printing option  153
Location 73, 151 assembly label, printing  153
Optimize 78, 153 ASSEMBLY-BEING BUILT status  30
Quantity Ordered 72, 73, 151 ASSEMBLY-COMPLETE status 30
Quantity to Pick  72,
 72, 73, 151 ASSEMBLY-READY status 29, 154
Replenishment  76 ASSEMBLY-SHORT status 29, 154
Replenishment Group  77 ASSEMBLY-UNALLOCATED status 29
Reserve Minimum 72, 151 ASSEMBLY-WAIT REPLEN status 29, 154
Short if not Ready  76 Assign Next BOL Number option  96
Shorts 75 Assign Work options  102
Stock Method 71, 151 Exclude Zones 103
Allocate To options  72, 151 Include Zones 103
Fair Share 73 assigning 95
Fifty Rule 72 BOL/manifest numbers to orders  96
Quantity Ordered 72 consolidation numbers to orders  96
Quantity to Pick  72
 72 incidents to users  194
Reserve Minimum 72, 151 next BOL number to orders  96
allocating replenishment groups  77, 308
sales orders 67 Assume Infinite Stock option  75
work orders 147 ATS 137
allocation results attribute
sales order  78
 78 mixing in allocation  74, 152
work order  154
 154 Attribute/Expiry/Packsize Allocation option  74,
Already Picked Goods options  122, 157 152
Return to Stock  122
 122 Auto Short All option  75
Return to TRANSIT  122 Auto Short Non-Stocks option  75
Ship 122, 157
APPROVED status 31
assembly B
adding 274, 276 Backorder options
adding service items to  271 Cancel Remainder  124 124
adding subcomponents to  271 OK to Backorder  124
 124
deleting 275  batch pick label, printing  105
deleting service items from  273 BEING PICKED status 28
deleting subcomponents from  273 BEING RECEIVED status 31
editing 273 BEING REPACKED status 28
editing service items 273

3 1 8
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

 bill of lading 125 Clear Rating Errors option  116


adding orders to 126 client filter  24
 24
editing 128 clone picking 135
 printing 128 closing
viewing 128 incidents 197
 bill of lading number  95
 95  purchase orders  299
Bin Detail Report 237 completing
Bin Inventory Report  238  purchase orders  299
BOL 95, 125 sales orders 290
adding orders to 126 transfer sales orders  296
editing 128 component
 printing 128 adding to kits 271
viewing 128 deleting from kits  273
BOL number  95  95 editing 273
BOL Report 128 configuring
BOL/Manifest Number option  96 screens 9
configuring grids  9
Consolidate if Possible option 109
C consolidating orders  95, 109
Calculate Demand Requirements function  163, consolidation number  96
 96
304 Consolidation Number option  96
Cancel & Unallocate option  123, 157 Container Lookup  228
Cancel Remainder function  124 Container Report  228
Cancelling 156 container, creating 182
cancelling Cost of Shipping  117
 purchase orders  179 Create a Delivery Report  130
sales order  120
 120 Create Container  182
 182
work order  156
 156 creating
Capture Barcode option  97 containers 182
Carrier Label 94 customers 283
Carrier Service option  92 deliveries from sales orders  130
Carton Contents Label option  94 incidents 194
Carton Ship option  114 kits 274
carton statuses 63  packaging item  276
Change Payment Method option  92  packaging order  162,
 162, 302
changing  products 269
carrier/service 92  purchase orders  297
 payment method  92 sales orders 287
choosing printers  107, 153 test order database  316

3 1 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

transfer purchase order in Web Dispatch  190 Delete Unused Labels option 112
transfer sales orders 293 deleting
vendors 285 kits 275
Crystal Pick Ticket option  106 lines from purchase orders  266, 301
customer  lines from sales orders  292
adding 283 lines from transfer sales orders  296
maintenance 282  packaging item  281
modifying 282  purchase orders  179
Customer Label sales order  120
 120
Ship option 93 service items from kits  273
Wave option 105, 106 subcomponents from kits  273
Customer Report  213 text line from packaging item  281
Cycle Count Accuracy Report  251 work order  156
 156
Cycle Count Report  240 Delivery Report  130
Cycle Time Report  254 delivery, from sales orders  130
details screen 15
Dispatcher Settings Report 46
D Display Hold Message option 97
Daily Receipts Report  230
Daily Receiving Report  229
Daily Sales Report 247 E
Daily Shipping Report  219 editing
database tables 256 BOLs 128
database, creating test  316 customer information 282
Date Shipped option 117 default settings 46
days on hand replenishment  304 incidents 197
Minimum# of Days Trigger  309
 309 lines in purchase orders  265, 301
Replenish# of Days  309 lines in sales orders  292
Days to Expiry option  74, 152 lines in sales/work orders 262
default settings, editing  46 lines in transfer sales orders  296
Delete PO 179 manifests 128
Delete PO options 180  packaging item  278
Delete 181  product information  267
Mark as Backordered  181  purchase orders  263
Mark as Complete  181 sales/work orders 259
Mark as Incomplete  181 service items in kits 273
Report to Host  181 subcomponents in kits  273
Unreceived Goods  181 vendor information  284
Upload 181 Employee Statistics Report 253

3 2 0
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Empty Bin Report  238 filtering


End of Line data in columns  10
Ship option 93 orders by client  24
Wave option 103 orders by location 25
Ending Pick Bin option  308 orders by product  24
end-of-line 59, 93, 103 orders by warehouse  24
entering
 packaging order  162,
 162, 302
 purchase orders  297
G
sales orders 287 grid configuration  9
transfer sales orders 293
error, clearing shipping  116 H
Exception Report  85
handle 25
Exclude Zones
handling 87
Allocate option 73
HELD FORMAT orders  83
Wave option 103
short orders  81
exiting Web Dispatch  48
WAIT PRE-RATE orders  87
expediting sales order  120
 120 HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT status  27, 79
expiry date
HELD FORMAT orders, handling  83
allocating 74, 152
HELD FORMAT status 27, 80
mixing in allocation  74, 152
held order, handling  85
exporting manifest  137
HELD SHORT status 26, 79
EXTERNAL status 28, 124
Hold for Packing Slip option  123
Hold for Replenishment option  76
Hold for Shorts option  75
F
Fair Share option 73
FIFO 71, 151 I
allocation 71, 151 Ignore Required Date option  116
Fifty Rule option 72 incident 17
filter  22
 22 assigning 194
clear  12
 12 closing 197
client 24 creating 194
location 25 editing 197
 product 24 options 195
warehouse 24 overview 193
re-assigning 197
resolving 197
viewing assigned 195, 196

3 2 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Include Replenish Zones option  308 Labels options


Include Scanned Orders option  116 Crystal Pick Ticket 106
Include Shipped Orders option  116 Customer Label 106
Include Unscanned Orders option  116 Labels Per Order  105,
 105, 108
Include Zones Packing Planner  106
 106
Allocate option 73, 77 Pick Ticket 106
Wave option 103 Pre-Packslip 106
Include Zones for Kitting option  153 Sort Slapper Labels  107
Incremental Slotting Report  249 Start with 1 Label  105, 108
Inventory Reports  206 Use Calculated Qty 105, 108
Labels Per Order options
Start with 1 Label  105, 108
K  Use Calculated Qty 105, 108
kit launch bar  12
 12
adding 274 License Plate Report 239
adding service items to  271 LIFO 71, 151
adding subcomponents to  271 allocation 71, 151
deleting 275 Limit Wave Size options  102, 108
deleting service items from  273 Max# Lines 102
deleting subcomponents from  273 Max# Orders 102, 108
editing service items 273 Max# Units 102
editing subcomponents 273 limiting wave sizes 102
line
adding to purchase orders  266, 298
L adding to sales orders  289
label adding to transfer sales orders  295
deleting unused 112 deleting from purchase orders  266, 301
 printing batch pick  105
 105 deleting from sales orders  292
 printing carrier  94
 94 deleting from transfer sales orders  296
 printing carton contents  94 editing in purchase orders  265
 printing Crystal pick ticket  106 editing in sales/work orders  262
 printing customer  106
 106 statuses, purchase order  173
 173
 printing packing planner  106
 106 statuses, sales order  57
 57
 printing pick ticket  106 statuses, work order  144
 144
 printing pre-packslip  106 linked orders 108
List Assigned Incidents 196
List Created Incidents  195

3 2 2
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Location Maximum# SKUs to Call For option  308


Advance Replenishment option  307 min/max advance replenishment  303
Allocate option 73, 151 Minimum# of Days Trigger option  309
location filter  25
 25 Miscellaneous Reports 207
location, specifying for allocation  73, 151 modifying
LOCKED status 27 carrier/service 92
Log Lookup Report  312 customer information  282
Log Report  314 default settings 46
logging on  2 lines in purchase orders  265
lines in sales orders  292
lines in sales/work orders  262
M lines in transfer sales orders  296
maintaining  packaging item 276, 278
customer information  281  payment method  92
kits 269  product information  267
 packaging item 276  purchase orders  263
 products 266 sales/work orders 259
vendor information  283 service items in kits 273
manifest 95, 125 subcomponents in kits  273
adding orders to 126 vendor information  284
editing 128 Monitor module  250
exporting to text file  137 Multi-Pack Packaging Report 164
 printing 128
viewing 128
Manifest Report 137, 220 N
Mark as Backordered option  181 navigating Web Dispatch 7
Mark as Checked-In option  114  NOT RECEIVED status  31
Mark as Complete option  181  Notify ShipSys options
Mark as Incomplete option  181 Ignore Required Date  116
Mark as Shipped options Include Scanned Orders  116
Cost of Shipping option  117 Include Shipped Orders  116
Date Shipped 117 Include Unscanned Orders  116
Release for Upload  117  Nuke & Delete option  124, 158
Shipment Number  117 117  Nuke options
marking orders as shipped  117 Already Picked Goods  122, 157
Max# Lines option  102 Backorder  124,
 124, 158
Max# Orders option  102, 108 Cancel & Allocate  123, 157
Max# Units option 102 Cancel Remainder  124
 124
Maximum Days option 168 Hold for Packing Slip  123

3 2 3
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

 Nuke & Delete  124, 158 P


OK to Backorder  124
 124
Pack & Hold option  109
Packing Slip 123
PACK & HOLD status 27, 110
Pick & Relieve 123
Package options
Release Without 123
Maximum # Days  168
Report to Host  124, 158
Quantity Override 168
Report to Host options  124, 158
 packaging item
Return to Stock  122
 122
adding 276
Return to TRANSIT  122
adding text lines for  280
 280
sales order  121
 121
deleting 281
Ship 122, 157
deleting text line  281
Show Actual Qty 124, 158
editing 278
Unpicked Goods  123, 157
maintaining 276
work order  157
 157
velocity 163
nuking
Packaging Item List 276
results 124
 packaging order 
sales order  120
 120
creating 162
work order  156,
 156, 157
entering 302
PKG-BEING BUILT status 30
O PKG-READY TO PRINT status 30
PKG-WAITING LETDOWN status 30
OK to Backorder option  124
SHIPPED AND UPLOADED status 30
Open Warehouse Transits Report  246
types of  159
 159
Optimize options
Packaging Report  164
By Zone Sequence  78, 153
 packing and holding orders  109
Deplete Smaller Packsize 71, 151
Packing Planner option  106
order 
Packing Slip options
adding lines to  289, 295
Hold for Packing Slip  123
allocating 67
Release Without 123
editing 259
 packsize, mixing in allocation  74, 152
editing lines 262
Packslip Report 38, 56, 143, 169, 214
selecting 40
 palletize 108
Order Consolidation Opportunities Report  215
Performance Reports  206
Orders detail table 15
Pick & Relieve option  123
orders summary screen 14
Pick Ticket option  106
Picked, Unshipped Inventory Report  247
Picker Activity Report  253
Picking Reports 204

3 2 4
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

 picking sales order from Web Dispatch  128 BEING RECEIVED  31
 picking/shipping label, printing  106, 107 BEING REPACKED 28
 pivot 18 EXTERNAL 28, 124
Orders module 19 HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT 27, 79
Receiving module  21 HELD FORMAT 27, 80
PKG-BEING BUILT status 30 HELD SHORT 26, 79
PKG-READY TO PRINT status  30 LOCKED 27
PKG-WAITING LETDOWN status 30  NOT RECEIVED  31
PO/Manifest Report 38, 221 PACK & HOLD 27, 110
Pre-Packslip option 106 PKG-BEING BUILT 30
Pre-Rate option 98 PKG-READY TO PRINT 30
 pre-rating PKG-WAITING LETDOWN 30
sales orders 98  purchase orders, overview  30
skipping 87 RATING 28
Printer# Wave option  107 READY TO SHIP 28
 printers, selecting  107, 153 READY TO UPLOAD 29, 31, 124
 printing READY TO WAVE 27, 78, 110
assembly labels 153 RECORD SHIPMENT 28
 batch pick labels  105 REQUISTION 31
BOLs 128 sales orders, overview  26
carrier labels 94 SHIPPED AND UPLOADED 29, 30
carton contents labels  94 SUSPENDED 29, 79
Crystal pick tickets  106 transfer purchase orders, overview  30
customer labels 93, 106 UNALLOCATED  26, 79
manifests 128 UPLOADED 31
 packing planners  106 WAIT PRE-RATE 27, 80
 pick tickets 106 WAITING - SWOG  27, 79
 picking/shipping labels  106, 107 WAITING BOL# 28
 pre-packslip labels  106 WAVED 27
 process flag 59 work orders, overview  29, 30
 process step 26  product
APPROVED  31 adding 269
ASSEMBLY-BEING BUILT 30 modifying 267
ASSEMBLY-COMPLETE  30 velocity 163
ASSEMBLY-READY  29, 154  product filter  24
 24
ASSEMBLY-SHORT  29, 154 Product Inventory Report  81, 236
ASSEMBLY-UNALLOCATED  29 Product Report  235
ASSEMBLY-WAIT REPLEN 29, 154 Product Reports  234
BEING PICKED 28

3 2 5
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

 purchase order  READY TO SHIP status 28


adding lines to  266, 298 READY TO UPLOAD status 29, 31, 124
APPROVED status 31 READY TO WAVE status 27, 78, 110
BEING RECEIVED  31 re-allocating sales orders 67
cancelling 179 re-assigning incidents 197
completing  299 receiving by container  182
 182
creating 297 receiving purchase order in Web Dispatch  188
creating RMA 186 Receiving Report by PO  227
deleting lines from  266 Receiving Reports  205
editing 263 Recent drop-down list  26
editing lines 265, 301 RECORD SHIPMENT status 28
line statuses 173 Refresh 9
 NOT RECEIVED status  31 refresh, summary screen  34
READY TO UPLOAD status 31 Release for Ready-Wave option  88
receiving in Web Dispatch  188 Release for Upload option  117
REQUISITION status 31 Release Options
statuses 30 Consolidate if Possible 109
transfer purchase order  30
 30 Pack & Hold 109
UPLOADED status 31 Wait All Linked Orders 108
Purchase Order Report  221 releasing
held orders  85
SWOG orders 87
Q  Replenish# of Days option  309
Quantity Ordered 72 replenishing orders  76
Quantity Ordered option  72 Replenishment Group
Quantity Override option 168 Advance Replenishment option  308
Quantity to Pick  72
 72 Allocate option 77
Quantity to Pick option  72 replenishment group
quick launch bar  12
 12 assigning 308
Quick Order Completion  128 Replenishment options
Quick Purchase Order Completion  188, 190 Hold for Replenishment  76
Include Zones 77
Include Zones for Kitting  153
R  Replenishment Group 77
Radio Beacon Short if not Ready  76
contact info  xiv Replenishment Report  81, 244
Web site xiv replenishment, advance 303
RATING status 28

3 2 6
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

report Product Inventory  81, 236


Activity 252 Products 234
Activity Monitor  250
 250 Purchase Order  221
 221
Ad Hoc SQL  255 Quick Order Completion  128
Adjustments 241 Quick Purchase Order Completion  188, 190
Advance Replenishment 305 Receiving by PO 227
Bin Detail 237 Replenishment 81, 244
Bin Inventory  238 Reserved Stock  245
 245
BOL 128 RMA Issued 230
Container  228
 228 Rush Items 81
container  130
 130 Rush Products 243
Customer  213
 213 Shipment Lookup 220
Cycle Count  240 Shipping Errors  216
Cycle Count Accuracy  251 Short Products 81, 242
Cycle Time 254 Shortage 225
Daily Receipts 230 Top 100 248
Daily Receiving 229 Truck Route  217
Daily Sales 247 Uploaded Receipts 228
Daily Shipping 219 Uploaded Shipments 218
Delivery 130 Velocity by Bin 249
Dispatcher Settings 46 Vendor  222
 222
Employee Statistics 253 Vendor Product List  224
Empty Bin 238 Report to Host options
Exception 85  Nuke & Delete 124, 158
Incremental Slotting  249 Show Actual Qty 124, 158
License Plate 239 REQUISTION status 31
Log 314 Reserve Minimum option  72, 151
Log Lookup  312 Reserved Stock Report  245
Manifest 137, 220 resolving incidents 197
Multi-Pack Packaging 164 results
Open Warehouse Transits  246 nuking 124
Order Consolidation Opportunities  215 waving 110
Packaging 164 Return to Stock option  122
Packslip 38, 56, 143, 169, 214 Return to TRANSIT option  122
Picked, Unshipped Inventory  247 RMA Issued Report  230
Picker Activity 253 Rush Items Report  81
PO 38 Rush Products Report  243
Product 235

3 2 7
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

S RATING status 28
READY TO SHIP status 28
sales order 
READY TO UPLOAD status 29, 124
adding lines to  289
READY TO WAVE status  27, 78, 110
allocating 67
re-allocating 67
allocation results 78
RECORD SHIPMENT status 28
BEING PICKED status 28
releasing held orders  85
BEING REPACKED status 28
releasing SWOG 87
cancelling 120
replenishment  76
changing carrier/service  92
saving 290, 296
clone picking 135
SHIPPED AND UPLOADED status 29
completing  290
shorting 75, 76
consolidating multiple  109
statuses 26
consolidation  95
SUSPENDED status 29, 79
creating 287
SUSPENDED, handling 82
creating a delivery  130
suspending 118
deleting 120
transfer sales order  26
 26
deleting lines from  292
UNALLOCATED status 26, 79
editing 259
unallocating 88
editing lines 262, 292
unclone 137
entering 287
unsuspending 119
expediting 120
unwaving 111
EXTERNAL status 28, 124
WAIT PRE-RATE status 27, 80
HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT status 27, 79
WAIT PRE-RATE, handling  87
HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT, handling  81
WAITING - SWOG status  27, 79
HELD FORMAT status 27, 80
WAITING - SWOG, handling  87
HELD FORMAT, handling 83
WAITING BOL# status 28
HELD SHORT status 26, 79
WAVED status 27, 110
HELD SHORT, handling 81
waving 99
held, handling  85
saving
holding short  75
 purchase orders  299
line statuses 57
sales orders 290
linked 108
transfer sales orders 296
LOCKED status 27
screen, configuration  9
marking as shipped  117
selecting
PACK & HOLD status 27, 110
orders 40
 packing and holding  109
 printers 107, 153
 picking from Web Dispatch  128
 pre-rating 98

3 2 8
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

service item SHIPPED AND UPLOADED status 29, 30


adding to kits  271 shipping
deleting from kits  273 clearing errors  116
editing in kit  273 systems 115
settings, editing default 46 Shipping Check-In Actions  97
Ship options Capture Barcode  97
Assign Next BOL Number  96  96 Display Hold Message 97
BOL/Manifest Number  96  96 Shipping Controls options
Capture Barcode  97 Assign Next BOL Number  96  96
Carrier Label option  94 BOL/Manifest Number  96  96
Carrier Service  92 Consolidation Number  96
 96
Carton Contents Label  94 Shipping Errors Report  216
Carton Ship 114 Short if not Ready option  76
Change Payment Method  92 short order, handling  81
Clear Rating Errors  116 Short Products Report  81, 242
Consolidation Number  96
 96 Shortage Report  225
Cost of Shipping  117 shorting sales orders  75, 76
Customer Label 93, 94 Shorts options 75
Date Shipped 117 100% Fill 75
Display Hold Message 97 Assume Infinite Stock  75
 75
End of Line  93 Auto Short All  75
Ignore Required Date  116 Auto Short Non-Stocks  75
Include Scanned Orders  116 Hold for Shorts  75
Include Shipped Orders  116 Show Actual Qty option  124, 158
Include Unscanned Orders  116 site transfer  293
 293
Mark as Checked-In  114 Skip Pre-Rating option  87
Mark as Shipped  117 skipping pre-rating  87
 Notify Shipping System  115 Sort Slapper Labels 107
Pre-Rate 98 Starting Pick Bin option  307
Release for Ready-Wave  88 starting Web Dispatch 2
Release for Upload  117 status 79
Settings 92, 93, 94 APPROVED 31
Ship Options 92 ASSEMBLY-BEING BUILT 30
Shipment Number  117 117 ASSEMBLY-COMPLETE  30
Shipping Check-In Actions  97 ASSEMBLY-READY  29, 154
Shipping Controls  95, 96 ASSEMBLY-SHORT  29, 154
Skip Pre-Rating 87 ASSEMBLY-UNALLOCATED  29
Shipment Lookup Report  220 ASSEMBLY-WAIT REPLEN 29, 154
Shipment Number option  117 BEING PICKED 28

3 2 9
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

BEING RECEIVED  31 Stock Method options


BEING REPACKED 28 FIFO 71, 151
carton 63 LIFO 71, 151
EXTERNAL  28, 124 subcomponent
HELD FOR REPLENISHMENT 27, 79 adding to kits 271
HELD FORMAT 27, 80 deleting from kits  273
HELD SHORT 26, 79 editing in kits  273
line, purchase order  173
 173 subcomponents  273
line, sales order  57
 57 suspended order, handling  82
line, work order  144
 144 SUSPENDED status 29, 79
LOCKED 27 suspending sales order  118
 118
 NOT RECEIVED  31
PACK & HOLD 27, 110
PKG-BEING BUILT 30 T
PKG-READY TO PRINT 30 tables, database 256
PKG-WAITING LETDOWN 30 test order database, creating  316
 purchase order  30
 30 text line
RATING 28 adding to packaging items  280
READY TO SHIP 28 deleting 281
READY TO UPLOAD 29, 31, 124 Top 100 Report  248
READY TO WAVE 27, 78, 110 Total Support Web site  xiv
RECORD SHIPMENT 28 transfer purchase order  30
 30
REQUISITION  31 creating in Web Dispatch  190
sales order  26
 26 handling, SEE purchase order 
SHIPPED AND UPLOADED 29, 30  processing, SEE purchase order 
shipping 63 statuses 30
SUSPENDED  29, 79 transfer sales order 
transfer purchase order  30
 30 about 26
UNALLOCATED  26, 79 adding lines to 295
UPLOADED 31 completing 296
WAIT PRE-RATE 27, 80 creating 293
WAITING - SWOG  27, 79 deleting lines from  296
WAITING BOL# 28 editing lines 296
WAVED 27 entering 293
work order  29,
 29, 30 handling, SEE sales order 
status bar  12
 12  processing, SEE sales order 
statuses 26
transfer, warehouse transfer function  293
Truck Route Report  217

3 3 0
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

U View Container  228
 228
viewing
UNALLOCATED status 26, 79
assigned incidents 196
unallocating
BOLs 128
sales order  88
 88 created incidents 195
work orders  155
unclone 137
Unpicked Goods options  123, 157 W
Cancel & Unallocate 123, 157
Wait All Linked Orders  108
Pick & Relieve 123
Wait All Linked Orders option  108
Unreceived Goods options
WAIT PRE-RATE orders, handling  87
Mark as Backordered  181
WAIT PRE-RATE status 27, 80
Mark as Complete  181
WAITING - SWOG orders  87
Mark as Incomplete  181
WAITING - SWOG status  27, 79
unsuspending sales order  119
 119
WAITING BOL# status 28
Unwave option 112
warehouse filter  24
 24
unwaving sales order  111
 111
warehouse transfer  293
 293
updating
Wave Label option  105
customer information  281
Wave options
kits 269
Assign Work  102
 102
 packaging item 276
Consolidate if Possible 109
 products 266
Crystal Pick Ticket  106
 purchase orders  263
Customer Label 105, 106
sales/work orders 259
End of Line  103
vendor information  284
Exclude Zones  103
Uploaded Receipts Report  228
Include Zones  103
Uploaded Shipments Report  218
Labels 105, 106
UPLOADED status 31
Labels Per Order  105,
 105, 108
Limit Wave Size  102, 108
V Max# Lines 102
Max# Orders 102, 108
velocity 163
Max# Units 102
Velocity by Bin Report  249
Optimize Packing 103
vendor 
Pack & Hold 109
adding 285
Packing Planner  106
 106
maintenance 284
 palletize 108
modifying 284
Pick Ticket 106
Vendor Product List Report  224
Pre-Packslip 106
Vendor Report  222
Printer# 107

3 3 1
U S I N G R A D I O B E A C O N W E B D I S P A T C H

Release Options 108, 109 deleting 156


Sort Slapper Labels 107 editing 259
Wait All Linked Orders  108 editing lines 262
Wave Label 105 HELD FORMAT, handling 83
wave size, limiting 102, 108 HELD SHORT status 79
WAVED status 27, 110 line statuses 144
waving SHIPPED AND UPLOADED status 30
results 110 statuses 29, 30
sales order  99
 99 SUSPENDED status 29, 79
Web site, Total Support  xiv suspending 118
work order  types of  146
 146
allocation results 154
ASSEMBLY- BEING BUILT status 30
assembly info 145 Z
ASSEMBLY- READY status 29 zone
ASSEMBLY- SHORT status 154 excluding from allocation  73
ASSEMBLY-COMPLETE status 30 include for kitting  153
ASSEMBLY-READY status 154 include for replenishment  77
ASSEMBLY-SHORT status 29 including for advance replenishment  308
ASSEMBLY-UNALLOCATED status 29 including for allocation  73
ASSEMBLY-WAIT REPLEN status 29, 154 sequence for allocation 78, 153
cancelling 156

3 3 2

You might also like